diff options
596 files changed, 1095 insertions, 1333 deletions
@@ -34,6 +34,7 @@ E: magrawal@nortelnetworks.com D: Basic Interphase 5575 driver with UBR and ABR support. S: 75 Donald St, Apt 42 S: Weymouth, MA 02188 +S: USA N: Dave Airlie E: airlied@linux.ie @@ -202,6 +203,7 @@ S: MS42 S: Hewlett-Packard S: 3404 E Harmony Rd S: Fort Collins, CO 80525 +S: USA N: Arindam Banerji E: axb@cse.nd.edu @@ -444,6 +446,7 @@ E: rbradetich@uswest.net D: Linux/PA-RISC hacker S: 1200 Goldenrod Dr. S: Nampa, Idaho 83686 +S: USA N: Derrick J. Brashear E: shadow@dementia.org @@ -633,6 +636,7 @@ E: scole@lanl.gov E: elenstev@mesatop.com D: Various build fixes and kernel documentation. S: Los Alamos, New Mexico +S: USA N: Hamish Coleman E: hamish@zot.apana.org.au @@ -2009,6 +2013,7 @@ W: http://www.mathematik.uni-stuttgart.de/~floeff D: Busmaster driver for HP 10/100 Mbit Network Adapters S: University of Stuttgart, Germany and S: Ecole Nationale Superieure des Telecommunications, Paris +S: France N: Jamie Lokier E: jamie@shareable.org @@ -2178,6 +2183,7 @@ S: Hewlett Packard S: MS 42 S: 3404 E. Harmony Road S: Fort Collins, CO 80528 +S: USA N: Torben Mathiasen E: torben.mathiasen@compaq.com @@ -3658,7 +3664,7 @@ S: Portland, OR S: USA N: Michal Wronski -E: Michal.Wronski@motorola.com +E: michal.wronski@gmail.com D: POSIX message queues fs (with K. Benedyczak) S: Krakow S: Poland diff --git a/Documentation/DMA-mapping.txt b/Documentation/DMA-mapping.txt index 63392c9..028614c 100644 --- a/Documentation/DMA-mapping.txt +++ b/Documentation/DMA-mapping.txt @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ The query is performed via a call to pci_set_dma_mask(): int pci_set_dma_mask(struct pci_dev *pdev, u64 device_mask); -The query for consistent allocations is performed via a a call to +The query for consistent allocations is performed via a call to pci_set_consistent_dma_mask(): int pci_set_consistent_dma_mask(struct pci_dev *pdev, u64 device_mask); @@ -117,7 +117,7 @@ device_mask is a bit mask describing which bits of a PCI address your device supports. It returns zero if your card can perform DMA properly on the machine given the address mask you provided. -If it returns non-zero, your device can not perform DMA properly on +If it returns non-zero, your device cannot perform DMA properly on this platform, and attempting to do so will result in undefined behavior. You must either use a different mask, or not use DMA. diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl index 065e8dc..c684abf 100644 --- a/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl +++ b/Documentation/DocBook/libata.tmpl @@ -1400,7 +1400,7 @@ and other resources, etc. <listitem> <para> When it's known that HBA is in ready state but ATA/ATAPI - device in in unknown state, reset only device. + device is in unknown state, reset only device. </para> </listitem> diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/usb.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/usb.tmpl index 3608472..143e5ff 100644 --- a/Documentation/DocBook/usb.tmpl +++ b/Documentation/DocBook/usb.tmpl @@ -314,8 +314,7 @@ <emphasis>usbdevfs</emphasis> although it wasn't solving what <emphasis>devfs</emphasis> was. Every USB device will appear in usbfs, regardless of whether or - not it has a kernel driver; but only devices with kernel drivers - show up in devfs. + not it has a kernel driver. </para> <sect1> @@ -741,7 +740,7 @@ usbdev_ioctl (int fd, int ifno, unsigned request, void *param) <title>Synchronous I/O Support</title> <para>Synchronous requests involve the kernel blocking - until until the user mode request completes, either by + until the user mode request completes, either by finishing successfully or by reporting an error. In most cases this is the simplest way to use usbfs, although as noted above it does prevent performing I/O diff --git a/Documentation/DocBook/writing_usb_driver.tmpl b/Documentation/DocBook/writing_usb_driver.tmpl index 008a341..07cd34c 100644 --- a/Documentation/DocBook/writing_usb_driver.tmpl +++ b/Documentation/DocBook/writing_usb_driver.tmpl @@ -224,13 +224,8 @@ static int skel_probe(struct usb_interface *interface, Conversely, when the device is removed from the USB bus, the disconnect function is called with the device pointer. The driver needs to clean any private data that has been allocated at this time and to shut down any - pending urbs that are in the USB system. The driver also unregisters - itself from the devfs subsystem with the call: + pending urbs that are in the USB system. </para> - <programlisting> -/* remove our devfs node */ -devfs_unregister(skel->devfs); - </programlisting> <para> Now that the device is plugged into the system and the driver is bound to the device, any of the functions in the file_operations structure that diff --git a/Documentation/IPMI.txt b/Documentation/IPMI.txt index 9f08d73..0e3924e 100644 --- a/Documentation/IPMI.txt +++ b/Documentation/IPMI.txt @@ -468,12 +468,12 @@ BMCs specified on the smb_addr line will be detected. Setting smb_dbg_probe to 1 will enable debugging of the probing and detection process for BMCs on the SMBusses. -Discovering the IPMI compilant BMC on the SMBus can cause devices +Discovering the IPMI compliant BMC on the SMBus can cause devices on the I2C bus to fail. The SMBus driver writes a "Get Device ID" IPMI message as a block write to the I2C bus and waits for a response. This action can be detrimental to some I2C devices. It is highly recommended that the known I2c address be given to the SMBus driver in the smb_addr -parameter. The default adrress range will not be used when a smb_addr +parameter. The default address range will not be used when a smb_addr parameter is provided. When compiled into the kernel, the addresses can be specified on the diff --git a/Documentation/MSI-HOWTO.txt b/Documentation/MSI-HOWTO.txt index 3ec6c72..c70306a 100644 --- a/Documentation/MSI-HOWTO.txt +++ b/Documentation/MSI-HOWTO.txt @@ -267,7 +267,7 @@ y = The number of MSI capable devices populated in the system. vector reserved to avoid the case where some MSI-X capable drivers may attempt to claim all available vector resources. -z = The number of MSI-X capable devices pupulated in the system. +z = The number of MSI-X capable devices populated in the system. This policy ensures that maximum (x - y) is distributed evenly among MSI-X capable devices. diff --git a/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt b/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt index 318df44..820fee2 100644 --- a/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt +++ b/Documentation/RCU/whatisRCU.txt @@ -582,7 +582,7 @@ The rcu_read_lock() and rcu_read_unlock() primitive read-acquire and release a global reader-writer lock. The synchronize_rcu() primitive write-acquires this same lock, then immediately releases it. This means that once synchronize_rcu() exits, all RCU read-side -critical sections that were in progress before synchonize_rcu() was +critical sections that were in progress before synchronize_rcu() was called are guaranteed to have completed -- there is no way that synchronize_rcu() would have been able to write-acquire the lock otherwise. @@ -750,7 +750,7 @@ Or, for those who prefer a side-by-side listing: Either way, the differences are quite small. Read-side locking moves to rcu_read_lock() and rcu_read_unlock, update-side locking moves from -from a reader-writer lock to a simple spinlock, and a synchronize_rcu() +a reader-writer lock to a simple spinlock, and a synchronize_rcu() precedes the kfree(). However, there is one potential catch: the read-side and update-side diff --git a/Documentation/aoe/todo.txt b/Documentation/aoe/todo.txt index 7fee1e1..c09dfad 100644 --- a/Documentation/aoe/todo.txt +++ b/Documentation/aoe/todo.txt @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ not been observed, but it would be nice to eliminate any potential for deadlock under memory pressure. Because ATA over Ethernet is not fragmented by the kernel's IP code, -the destructore member of the struct sk_buff is available to the aoe +the destructor member of the struct sk_buff is available to the aoe driver. By using a mempool for allocating all but the first few sk_buffs, and by registering a destructor, we should be able to efficiently allocate sk_buffs without introducing any potential for diff --git a/Documentation/arm/SA1100/serial_UART b/Documentation/arm/SA1100/serial_UART index aea2e91..a63966f 100644 --- a/Documentation/arm/SA1100/serial_UART +++ b/Documentation/arm/SA1100/serial_UART @@ -24,8 +24,8 @@ The SA1100 serial port had its major/minor numbers officially assigned: > 7 = /dev/cusa2 Callout device for ttySA2 > -If you're not using devfs, you must create those inodes in /dev -on the root filesystem used by your SA1100-based device: +You must create those inodes in /dev on the root filesystem used +by your SA1100-based device: mknod ttySA0 c 204 5 mknod ttySA1 c 204 6 diff --git a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/EB2410ITX.txt b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/EB2410ITX.txt index 000e3d7..26422f0 100644 --- a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/EB2410ITX.txt +++ b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/EB2410ITX.txt @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ MTD --- The NAND and NOR support has been merged from the linux-mtd project. - Any prolbems, see http://www.linux-mtd.infradead.org/ for more + Any problems, see http://www.linux-mtd.infradead.org/ for more information or up-to-date versions of linux-mtd. diff --git a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/GPIO.txt b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/GPIO.txt index 0822764..8caea8c 100644 --- a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/GPIO.txt +++ b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/GPIO.txt @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ Headers header include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/hardware.h which can be included by #include <asm/arch/hardware.h> - A useful ammount of documentation can be found in the hardware + A useful amount of documentation can be found in the hardware header on how the GPIO functions (and others) work. Whilst a number of these functions do make some checks on what diff --git a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/Overview.txt b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/Overview.txt index 3e46d2a..dda7ecd 100644 --- a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/Overview.txt +++ b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/Overview.txt @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ Machines Adding New Machines ------------------- - The archicture has been designed to support as many machines as can + The architecture has been designed to support as many machines as can be configured for it in one kernel build, and any future additions should keep this in mind before altering items outside of their own machine files. diff --git a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/S3C2412.txt b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/S3C2412.txt index cb82a7f..295d971 100644 --- a/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/S3C2412.txt +++ b/Documentation/arm/Samsung-S3C24XX/S3C2412.txt @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ RTC Watchdog -------- - The watchdog harware is the same as the S3C2410, and is supported by + The watchdog hardware is the same as the S3C2410, and is supported by the s3c2410_wdt driver. diff --git a/Documentation/block/as-iosched.txt b/Documentation/block/as-iosched.txt index 6f47332..e2a66f8 100644 --- a/Documentation/block/as-iosched.txt +++ b/Documentation/block/as-iosched.txt @@ -99,8 +99,8 @@ contrast, many write requests may be dispatched to the disk controller at a time during a write batch. It is this characteristic that can make the anticipatory scheduler perform anomalously with controllers supporting TCQ, or with hardware striped RAID devices. Setting the antic_expire -queue paramter (see below) to zero disables this behavior, and the anticipatory -scheduler behaves essentially like the deadline scheduler. +queue parameter (see below) to zero disables this behavior, and the +anticipatory scheduler behaves essentially like the deadline scheduler. When read anticipation is enabled (antic_expire is not zero), reads are dispatched to the disk controller one at a time. diff --git a/Documentation/block/barrier.txt b/Documentation/block/barrier.txt index 0397151..a272c3d 100644 --- a/Documentation/block/barrier.txt +++ b/Documentation/block/barrier.txt @@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ of the following three ways. i. For devices which have queue depth greater than 1 (TCQ devices) and support ordered tags, block layer can just issue the barrier as an ordered request and the lower level driver, controller and drive -itself are responsible for making sure that the ordering contraint is +itself are responsible for making sure that the ordering constraint is met. Most modern SCSI controllers/drives should support this. NOTE: SCSI ordered tag isn't currently used due to limitation in the @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ iii. Devices which have queue depth of 1. This is a degenerate case of ii. Just keeping issue order suffices. Ancient SCSI controllers/drives and IDE drives are in this category. -2. Forced flushing to physcial medium +2. Forced flushing to physical medium Again, if you're not gonna do synchronization with disk drives (dang, it sounds even more appealing now!), the reason you use I/O barriers @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ There are four cases, i. No write-back cache. Keeping requests ordered is enough. ii. Write-back cache but no flush operation. There's no way to -gurantee physical-medium commit order. This kind of devices can't to +guarantee physical-medium commit order. This kind of devices can't to I/O barriers. iii. Write-back cache and flush operation but no FUA (forced unit diff --git a/Documentation/block/biodoc.txt b/Documentation/block/biodoc.txt index f989a9e..34bf8f6 100644 --- a/Documentation/block/biodoc.txt +++ b/Documentation/block/biodoc.txt @@ -135,7 +135,7 @@ Some new queue property settings: Sets two variables that limit the size of the request. - The request queue's max_sectors, which is a soft size in - in units of 512 byte sectors, and could be dynamically varied + units of 512 byte sectors, and could be dynamically varied by the core kernel. - The request queue's max_hw_sectors, which is a hard limit @@ -783,7 +783,7 @@ all the outstanding requests. There's a third helper to do that: blk_queue_invalidate_tags(request_queue_t *q) - Clear the internal block tag queue and readd all the pending requests + Clear the internal block tag queue and re-add all the pending requests to the request queue. The driver will receive them again on the next request_fn run, just like it did the first time it encountered them. @@ -890,7 +890,7 @@ Aside: Kvec i/o: - Ben LaHaise's aio code uses a slighly different structure instead + Ben LaHaise's aio code uses a slightly different structure instead of kiobufs, called a kvec_cb. This contains an array of <page, offset, len> tuples (very much like the networking code), together with a callback function and data pointer. This is embedded into a brw_cb structure when passed @@ -988,7 +988,7 @@ elevator_exit_fn Allocate and free any elevator specific storage for a queue. 4.2 Request flows seen by I/O schedulers -All requests seens by I/O schedulers strictly follow one of the following three +All requests seen by I/O schedulers strictly follow one of the following three flows. set_req_fn -> @@ -1203,6 +1203,6 @@ temporarily map a bio into the virtual address space. and Linus' comments - Jan 2001) 9.2 Discussions about kiobuf and bh design on lkml between sct, linus, alan et al - Feb-March 2001 (many of the initial thoughts that led to bio were -brought up in this discusion thread) +brought up in this discussion thread) 9.3 Discussions on mempool on lkml - Dec 2001. diff --git a/Documentation/block/deadline-iosched.txt b/Documentation/block/deadline-iosched.txt index c918b3a..be08ffd 100644 --- a/Documentation/block/deadline-iosched.txt +++ b/Documentation/block/deadline-iosched.txt @@ -23,11 +23,11 @@ you can do so by typing: read_expire (in ms) ----------- -The goal of the deadline io scheduler is to attempt to guarentee a start +The goal of the deadline io scheduler is to attempt to guarantee a start service time for a request. As we focus mainly on read latencies, this is tunable. When a read request first enters the io scheduler, it is assigned a deadline that is the current time + the read_expire value in units of -miliseconds. +milliseconds. write_expire (in ms) diff --git a/Documentation/cciss.txt b/Documentation/cciss.txt index 9c629ff..f74affe 100644 --- a/Documentation/cciss.txt +++ b/Documentation/cciss.txt @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ the /proc filesystem entry which the "block" side of the driver creates as the SCSI core may not yet be initialized (because the driver is a block driver) and attempting to register it with the SCSI core in such a case would cause a hang. This is best done via an initialization script -(typically in /etc/init.d, but could vary depending on distibution). +(typically in /etc/init.d, but could vary depending on distribution). For example: for x in /proc/driver/cciss/cciss[0-9]* @@ -152,7 +152,7 @@ side during the SCSI error recovery process, the cciss driver only implements the first two of these actions, aborting the command, and resetting the device. Additionally, most tape drives will not oblige in aborting commands, and sometimes it appears they will not even -obey a reset coommand, though in most circumstances they will. In +obey a reset command, though in most circumstances they will. In the case that the command cannot be aborted and the device cannot be reset, the device will be set offline. diff --git a/Documentation/computone.txt b/Documentation/computone.txt index b1cf59b..5e2a0c7 100644 --- a/Documentation/computone.txt +++ b/Documentation/computone.txt @@ -199,30 +199,6 @@ boxes this will leave gaps in the sequence of device names. ip2mkdev uses Linux tty naming conventions: ttyF0 - ttyF255 for normal devices, and cuf0 - cuf255 for callout devices. -If you are using devfs, existing devices are automatically created within -the devfs name space. Normal devices will be tts/F0 - tts/F255 and callout -devices will be cua/F0 - cua/F255. With devfs installed, ip2mkdev will -create symbolic links in /dev from the old conventional names to the newer -devfs names as follows: - - /dev/ip2ipl[n] -> /dev/ip2/ipl[n] n = 0 - 3 - /dev/ip2stat[n] -> /dev/ip2/stat[n] n = 0 - 3 - /dev/ttyF[n] -> /dev/tts/F[n] n = 0 - 255 - /dev/cuf[n] -> /dev/cua/F[n] n = 0 - 255 - -Only devices for existing ports and boards will be created. - -IMPORTANT NOTE: The naming convention used for devfs by this driver -was changed from 1.2.12 to 1.2.13. The old naming convention was to -use ttf/%d for the tty device and cuf/%d for the cua device. That -has been changed to conform to an agreed-upon standard of placing -all the tty devices under tts. The device names are now tts/F%d for -the tty device and cua/F%d for the cua devices. If you were using -the older devfs names, you must update for the newer convention. - -You do not need to run ip2mkdev if you are using devfs and only want to -use the devfs native device names. - 4. USING THE DRIVERS @@ -256,57 +232,15 @@ cut out and run as "ip2mkdev" to create the necessary device files. To use the ip2mkdev script, you must have procfs enabled and the proc file system mounted on /proc. -You do not need to run ip2mkdev if you are using devfs and only want to -use the devfs native device names. - - -6. DEVFS - -DEVFS is the DEVice File System available as an add on package for the -2.2.x kernels and available as a configuration option in 2.3.46 and higher. -Devfs allows for the automatic creation and management of device names -under control of the device drivers themselves. The Devfs namespace is -hierarchical and reduces the clutter present in the normal flat /dev -namespace. Devfs names and conventional device names may be intermixed. -A userspace daemon, devfsd, exists to allow for automatic creation and -management of symbolic links from the devfs name space to the conventional -names. More details on devfs can be found on the DEVFS home site at -<http://www.atnf.csiro.au/~rgooch/linux/> or in the file kernel -documentation files, .../linux/Documentation/filesystems/devfs/README. - -If you are using devfs, existing devices are automatically created within -the devfs name space. Normal devices will be tts/F0 - tts/F255 and callout -devices will be cua/F0 - cua/F255. With devfs installed, ip2mkdev will -create symbolic links in /dev from the old conventional names to the newer -devfs names as follows: - - /dev/ip2ipl[n] -> /dev/ip2/ipl[n] n = 0 - 3 - /dev/ip2stat[n] -> /dev/ip2/stat[n] n = 0 - 3 - /dev/ttyF[n] -> /dev/tts/F[n] n = 0 - 255 - /dev/cuf[n] -> /dev/cua/F[n] n = 0 - 255 - -Only devices for existing ports and boards will be created. - -IMPORTANT NOTE: The naming convention used for devfs by this driver -was changed from 1.2.12 to 1.2.13. The old naming convention was to -use ttf/%d for the tty device and cuf/%d for the cua device. That -has been changed to conform to an agreed-upon standard of placing -all the tty devices under tts. The device names are now tts/F%d for -the tty device and cua/F%d for the cua devices. If you were using -the older devfs names, you must update for the newer convention. - -You do not need to run ip2mkdev if you are using devfs and only want to -use the devfs native device names. - -7. NOTES +6. NOTES This is a release version of the driver, but it is impossible to test it in all configurations of Linux. If there is any anomalous behaviour that does not match the standard serial port's behaviour please let us know. -8. ip2mkdev shell script +7. ip2mkdev shell script Previously, this script was simply attached here. It is now attached as a shar archive to make it easier to extract the script from the documentation. diff --git a/Documentation/cpu-freq/cpufreq-stats.txt b/Documentation/cpu-freq/cpufreq-stats.txt index 6a82948..53d62c1 100644 --- a/Documentation/cpu-freq/cpufreq-stats.txt +++ b/Documentation/cpu-freq/cpufreq-stats.txt @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ - CPU frequency and voltage scaling statictics in the Linux(TM) kernel + CPU frequency and voltage scaling statistics in the Linux(TM) kernel L i n u x c p u f r e q - s t a t s d r i v e r @@ -18,8 +18,8 @@ Contents 1. Introduction cpufreq-stats is a driver that provices CPU frequency statistics for each CPU. -This statistics is provided in /sysfs as a bunch of read_only interfaces. This -interface (when configured) will appear in a seperate directory under cpufreq +These statistics are provided in /sysfs as a bunch of read_only interfaces. This +interface (when configured) will appear in a separate directory under cpufreq in /sysfs (<sysfs root>/devices/system/cpu/cpuX/cpufreq/stats/) for each CPU. Various statistics will form read_only files under this directory. @@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ drwxr-xr-x 3 root root 0 May 14 15:58 .. This gives the amount of time spent in each of the frequencies supported by this CPU. The cat output will have "<frequency> <time>" pair in each line, which will mean this CPU spent <time> usertime units of time at <frequency>. Output -will have one line for each of the supported freuencies. usertime units here +will have one line for each of the supported frequencies. usertime units here is 10mS (similar to other time exported in /proc). -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -115,7 +115,7 @@ basic statistics which includes time_in_state and total_trans. "CPU frequency translation statistics details" (CONFIG_CPU_FREQ_STAT_DETAILS) provides fine grained cpufreq stats by trans_table. The reason for having a -seperate config option for trans_table is: +separate config option for trans_table is: - trans_table goes against the traditional /sysfs rule of one value per interface. It provides a whole bunch of value in a 2 dimensional matrix form. diff --git a/Documentation/cpu-freq/governors.txt b/Documentation/cpu-freq/governors.txt index f4b8dc4..6a9c55b 100644 --- a/Documentation/cpu-freq/governors.txt +++ b/Documentation/cpu-freq/governors.txt @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ selected for each specific use. Basically, it's the following flow graph: -CPU can be set to switch independetly | CPU can only be set +CPU can be set to switch independently | CPU can only be set within specific "limits" | to specific frequencies "CPUfreq policy" @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ directory. 2.4 Ondemand ------------ -The CPUfreq govenor "ondemand" sets the CPU depending on the +The CPUfreq governor "ondemand" sets the CPU depending on the current usage. To do this the CPU must have the capability to switch the frequency very quickly. There are a number of sysfs file accessible parameters: @@ -137,11 +137,11 @@ have to be made in a row before the CPU frequency is actually lower. If set to '1' then the frequency decreases as quickly as it increases, if set to '2' it decreases at half the rate of the increase. -ignore_nice_load: this parameter takes a value of '0' or '1', when set -to '0' (its default) then all processes are counted towards towards the -'cpu utilisation' value. When set to '1' then processes that are +ignore_nice_load: this parameter takes a value of '0' or '1'. When +set to '0' (its default), all processes are counted towards the +'cpu utilisation' value. When set to '1', the processes that are run with a 'nice' value will not count (and thus be ignored) in the -overal usage calculation. This is useful if you are running a CPU +overall usage calculation. This is useful if you are running a CPU intensive calculation on your laptop that you do not care how long it takes to complete as you can 'nice' it and prevent it from taking part in the deciding process of whether to increase your CPU frequency. diff --git a/Documentation/cputopology.txt b/Documentation/cputopology.txt index 2b28e9e..b61cb95 100644 --- a/Documentation/cputopology.txt +++ b/Documentation/cputopology.txt @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ The type of **_id is int. The type of siblings is cpumask_t. To be consistent on all architectures, the 4 attributes should have -deafult values if their values are unavailable. Below is the rule. +default values if their values are unavailable. Below is the rule. 1) physical_package_id: If cpu has no physical package id, -1 is the default value. 2) core_id: If cpu doesn't support multi-core, its core id is 0. diff --git a/Documentation/dell_rbu.txt b/Documentation/dell_rbu.txt index 941343a..2c0d631 100644 --- a/Documentation/dell_rbu.txt +++ b/Documentation/dell_rbu.txt @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ for updating BIOS images on Dell servers and desktops. Scope: This document discusses the functionality of the rbu driver only. -It does not cover the support needed from aplications to enable the BIOS to +It does not cover the support needed from applications to enable the BIOS to update itself with the image downloaded in to the memory. Overview: @@ -16,8 +16,8 @@ OpenManage and Dell Update packages (DUP). Libsmbios can also be used to update BIOS on Dell systems go to http://linux.dell.com/libsmbios/ for details. -Dell_RBU driver supports BIOS update using the monilothic image and packetized -image methods. In case of moniolithic the driver allocates a contiguous chunk +Dell_RBU driver supports BIOS update using the monolithic image and packetized +image methods. In case of monolithic the driver allocates a contiguous chunk of physical pages having the BIOS image. In case of packetized the app using the driver breaks the image in to packets of fixed sizes and the driver would place each packet in contiguous physical memory. The driver also @@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ The driver supports two types of update mechanism; monolithic and packetized. These update mechanism depends upon the BIOS currently running on the system. Most of the Dell systems support a monolithic update where the BIOS image is copied to a single contiguous block of physical memory. -In case of packet mechanism the single memory can be broken in smaller chuks +In case of packet mechanism the single memory can be broken in smaller chunks of contiguous memory and the BIOS image is scattered in these packets. By default the driver uses monolithic memory for the update type. This can be @@ -52,11 +52,11 @@ echo packet > /sys/devices/platform/dell_rbu/image_type In packet update mode the packet size has to be given before any packets can be downloaded. It is done as below echo XXXX > /sys/devices/platform/dell_rbu/packet_size -In the packet update mechanism, the user neesd to create a new file having +In the packet update mechanism, the user needs to create a new file having packets of data arranged back to back. It can be done as follows The user creates packets header, gets the chunk of the BIOS image and -placs it next to the packetheader; now, the packetheader + BIOS image chunk -added to geather should match the specified packet_size. This makes one +places it next to the packetheader; now, the packetheader + BIOS image chunk +added together should match the specified packet_size. This makes one packet, the user needs to create more such packets out of the entire BIOS image file and then arrange all these packets back to back in to one single file. @@ -93,8 +93,8 @@ read back the image downloaded. NOTE: This driver requires a patch for firmware_class.c which has the modified request_firmware_nowait function. -Also after updating the BIOS image an user mdoe application neeeds to execute -code which message the BIOS update request to the BIOS. So on the next reboot -the BIOS knows about the new image downloaded and it updates it self. -Also don't unload the rbu drive if the image has to be updated. +Also after updating the BIOS image a user mode application needs to execute +code which sends the BIOS update request to the BIOS. So on the next reboot +the BIOS knows about the new image downloaded and it updates itself. +Also don't unload the rbu driver if the image has to be updated. diff --git a/Documentation/devices.txt b/Documentation/devices.txt index addc67b..28c4f79 100644 --- a/Documentation/devices.txt +++ b/Documentation/devices.txt @@ -2005,7 +2005,7 @@ Your cooperation is appreciated. 116 char Advanced Linux Sound Driver (ALSA) 116 block MicroMemory battery backed RAM adapter (NVRAM) - Supports 16 boards, 15 paritions each. + Supports 16 boards, 15 partitions each. Requested by neilb at cse.unsw.edu.au. 0 = /dev/umem/d0 Whole of first board @@ -3094,7 +3094,7 @@ Your cooperation is appreciated. This major is reserved to assist the expansion to a larger number space. No device nodes with this major should ever be created on the filesystem. - (This is probaly not true anymore, but I'll leave it + (This is probably not true anymore, but I'll leave it for now /Torben) ---LARGE MAJORS!!!!!--- @@ -3205,7 +3205,7 @@ for a session; this includes virtual consoles, serial ports, and pseudoterminals (PTYs). All terminal devices share a common set of capabilities known as line -diciplines; these include the common terminal line dicipline as well +disciplines; these include the common terminal line discipline as well as SLIP and PPP modes. All terminal devices are named similarly; this section explains the @@ -3285,7 +3285,7 @@ port TTY, for which no alternate device would exist. Pseudoterminals (PTYs) Pseudoterminals, or PTYs, are used to create login sessions or provide -other capabilities requiring a TTY line dicipline (including SLIP or +other capabilities requiring a TTY line discipline (including SLIP or PPP capability) to arbitrary data-generation processes. Each PTY has a master side, named /dev/pty[p-za-e][0-9a-f], and a slave side, named /dev/tty[p-za-e][0-9a-f]. The kernel arbitrates the use of PTYs by diff --git a/Documentation/driver-model/class.txt b/Documentation/driver-model/class.txt index 2d1d893..548505f 100644 --- a/Documentation/driver-model/class.txt +++ b/Documentation/driver-model/class.txt @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ device. The following device classes have been identified: Each device class defines a set of semantics and a programming interface that devices of that class adhere to. Device drivers are the -implemention of that programming interface for a particular device on +implementation of that programming interface for a particular device on a particular bus. Device classes are agnostic with respect to what bus a device resides diff --git a/Documentation/driver-model/driver.txt b/Documentation/driver-model/driver.txt index 59806c9..8213216 100644 --- a/Documentation/driver-model/driver.txt +++ b/Documentation/driver-model/driver.txt @@ -178,7 +178,7 @@ the driver to that device. A driver's probe() may return a negative errno value to indicate that the driver did not bind to this device, in which case it should have -released all reasources it allocated. +released all resources it allocated. int (*remove) (struct device * dev); diff --git a/Documentation/driver-model/overview.txt b/Documentation/driver-model/overview.txt index 2050c9f..07236ed 100644 --- a/Documentation/driver-model/overview.txt +++ b/Documentation/driver-model/overview.txt @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ the two. The PCI bus layer freely accesses the fields of struct device. It knows about the structure of struct pci_dev, and it should know the structure of struct -device. Individual PCI device drivers that have been converted the the current +device. Individual PCI device drivers that have been converted to the current driver model generally do not and should not touch the fields of struct device, unless there is a strong compelling reason to do so. diff --git a/Documentation/dvb/avermedia.txt b/Documentation/dvb/avermedia.txt index 8bab846..e44c009 100644 --- a/Documentation/dvb/avermedia.txt +++ b/Documentation/dvb/avermedia.txt @@ -45,9 +45,9 @@ Assumptions and Introduction by circuitry on the card and is often presented uncompressed. For a PAL TV signal encoded at a resolution of 768x576 24-bit color pixels over 25 frames per second - a fair amount of data - is generated and must be proceesed by the PC before it can be + is generated and must be processed by the PC before it can be displayed on the video monitor screen. Some Analogue TV cards - for PC's have onboard MPEG2 encoders which permit the raw + for PCs have onboard MPEG2 encoders which permit the raw digital data stream to be presented to the PC in an encoded and compressed form - similar to the form that is used in Digital TV. diff --git a/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt b/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt index 9e10092..ca58e33 100644 --- a/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt +++ b/Documentation/dvb/cards.txt @@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ Hardware supported by the linuxtv.org DVB drivers frontends (i.e. tuner / demodulator units) used, usually without changing the product name, revision number or specs. Some cards are also available in versions with different frontends for - DVB-S/DVB-C/DVB-T. Thus the frontend drivers are listed seperately. + DVB-S/DVB-C/DVB-T. Thus the frontend drivers are listed separately. Note 1: There is no guarantee that every frontend driver works out of the box with every card, because of different wiring. diff --git a/Documentation/dvb/ci.txt b/Documentation/dvb/ci.txt index 95f0e73..531239b 100644 --- a/Documentation/dvb/ci.txt +++ b/Documentation/dvb/ci.txt @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ This application requires the following to function properly as of now. descrambler to function, eg: $ ca_zap channels.conf "TMC" - (d) Hopeflly Enjoy your favourite subscribed channel as you do with + (d) Hopefully enjoy your favourite subscribed channel as you do with a FTA card. (3) Currently ca_zap, and dst_test, both are meant for demonstration @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ Modules that have been tested by this driver at present are ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ With the High Level CI approach any new card with almost any random architecture can be implemented with this style, the definitions -insidethe switch statement can be easily adapted for any card, thereby +inside the switch statement can be easily adapted for any card, thereby eliminating the need for any additional ioctls. The disadvantage is that the driver/hardware has to manage the rest. For diff --git a/Documentation/dvb/faq.txt b/Documentation/dvb/faq.txt index a42132d..dbcedf5 100644 --- a/Documentation/dvb/faq.txt +++ b/Documentation/dvb/faq.txt @@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ Some very frequently asked questions about linuxtv-dvb It's not a bug, it's a feature. Because the frontends have significant power requirements (and hence get very hot), they are powered down if they are unused (i.e. if the frontend device - is closed). The dvb-core.o module paramter "dvb_shutdown_timeout" + is closed). The dvb-core.o module parameter "dvb_shutdown_timeout" allow you to change the timeout (default 5 seconds). Setting the timeout to 0 disables the timeout feature. @@ -138,7 +138,7 @@ Some very frequently asked questions about linuxtv-dvb - v4l2-common: common functions for Video4Linux-2 drivers - - v4l1-compat: backward compatiblity layer for Video4Linux-1 legacy + - v4l1-compat: backward compatibility layer for Video4Linux-1 legacy applications - dvb-core: DVB core module. This provides you with the @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ Some very frequently asked questions about linuxtv-dvb - video-buf: capture helper module for the saa7146_vv driver. This one is responsible to handle capture buffers. - - dvb-ttpci: The main driver for AV7110 based, full-featued + - dvb-ttpci: The main driver for AV7110 based, full-featured DVB-S/C/T cards eof diff --git a/Documentation/eisa.txt b/Documentation/eisa.txt index 8c8388d..6a099ed 100644 --- a/Documentation/eisa.txt +++ b/Documentation/eisa.txt @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ The EISA infrastructure is made up of three parts : - The bus code implements most of the generic code. It is shared among all the architectures that the EISA code runs on. It - implements bus probing (detecting EISA cards avaible on the bus), + implements bus probing (detecting EISA cards available on the bus), allocates I/O resources, allows fancy naming through sysfs, and offers interfaces for driver to register. @@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ struct eisa_driver { id_table : an array of NULL terminated EISA id strings, followed by an empty string. Each string can - optionnaly be paired with a driver-dependant value + optionally be paired with a driver-dependant value (driver_data). driver : a generic driver, such as described in diff --git a/Documentation/exception.txt b/Documentation/exception.txt index 3cb39ad..2d5aded 100644 --- a/Documentation/exception.txt +++ b/Documentation/exception.txt @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ int verify_area(int type, const void * addr, unsigned long size) function (which has since been replaced by access_ok()). This function verified that the memory area starting at address -addr and of size size was accessible for the operation specified +'addr' and of size 'size' was accessible for the operation specified in type (read or write). To do this, verify_read had to look up the virtual memory area (vma) that contained the address addr. In the normal case (correctly working program), this test was successful. diff --git a/Documentation/fb/fbcon.txt b/Documentation/fb/fbcon.txt index f373df1..99ea58e 100644 --- a/Documentation/fb/fbcon.txt +++ b/Documentation/fb/fbcon.txt @@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ from the console layer before unloading the driver. The VGA driver cannot be unloaded if it is still bound to the console layer. (See Documentation/console/console.txt for more information). -This is more complicated in the case of the the framebuffer console (fbcon), +This is more complicated in the case of the framebuffer console (fbcon), because fbcon is an intermediate layer between the console and the drivers: console ---> fbcon ---> fbdev drivers ---> hardware diff --git a/Documentation/fb/sisfb.txt b/Documentation/fb/sisfb.txt index 3b50c51..2e68e50 100644 --- a/Documentation/fb/sisfb.txt +++ b/Documentation/fb/sisfb.txt @@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ information. Additionally, "modinfo sisfb" gives an overview over all supported options including some explanation. The desired display mode can be specified using the keyword "mode" with -a parameter in one of the follwing formats: +a parameter in one of the following formats: - XxYxDepth or - XxY-Depth or - XxY-Depth@Rate or diff --git a/Documentation/fb/sstfb.txt b/Documentation/fb/sstfb.txt index 628d7ff..df27f5b 100644 --- a/Documentation/fb/sstfb.txt +++ b/Documentation/fb/sstfb.txt @@ -48,12 +48,12 @@ Module Usage Module insertion: # insmod sstfb.o - you should see some strange output frome the board: + you should see some strange output from the board: a big blue square, a green and a red small squares and a vertical - white rectangle. why ? the function's name is self explanatory : + white rectangle. why? the function's name is self-explanatory: "sstfb_test()"... (if you don't have a second monitor, you'll have to plug your monitor - directely to the 2D videocard to see what you're typing) + directly to the 2D videocard to see what you're typing) # con2fb /dev/fbx /dev/ttyx bind a tty to the new frame buffer. if you already have a frame buffer driver, the voodoo fb will likely be /dev/fb1. if not, @@ -72,12 +72,12 @@ Module Usage Kernel/Modules Options - You can pass some otions to sstfb module, and via the kernel command - line when the driver is compiled in : + You can pass some options to the sstfb module, and via the kernel + command line when the driver is compiled in: for module : insmod sstfb.o option1=value1 option2=value2 ... in kernel : video=sstfb:option1,option2:value2,option3 ... - sstfb supports the folowing options : + sstfb supports the following options : Module Kernel Description @@ -95,11 +95,11 @@ inverse=1 inverse Supposed to enable inverse console. clipping=1 clipping Enable or disable clipping. clipping=0 noclipping With clipping enabled, all offscreen - reads and writes are disgarded. + reads and writes are discarded. Default: enable clipping. gfxclk=x gfxclk:x Force graphic clock frequency (in MHz). - Be carefull with this option, it may be + Be careful with this option, it may be DANGEROUS. Default: auto 50Mhz for Voodoo 1, @@ -137,23 +137,23 @@ Bugs - The driver is 16 bpp only, 24/32 won't work. - The driver is not your_favorite_toy-safe. this includes SMP... [Actually from inspection it seems to be safe - Alan] - - when using XFree86 FBdev (X over fbdev) you may see strange color + - When using XFree86 FBdev (X over fbdev) you may see strange color patterns at the border of your windows (the pixels lose the lowest - byte -> basicaly the blue component nd some of the green) . I'm unable + byte -> basically the blue component and some of the green). I'm unable to reproduce this with XFree86-3.3, but one of the testers has this - problem with XFree86-4. apparently recent Xfree86-4.x solve this + problem with XFree86-4. Apparently recent Xfree86-4.x solve this problem. - I didn't really test changing the palette, so you may find some weird things when playing with that. - - Sometimes the driver will not recognise the DAC , and the - initialisation will fail. this is specificaly true for - voodoo 2 boards , but it should be solved in recent versions. please - contact me . - - the 24/32 is not likely to work anytime soon , knowing that the - hardware does ... unusual thigs in 24/32 bpp - - When used with anther video board, current limitations of linux - console subsystem can cause some troubles, specificaly, you should - disable software scrollback , as it can oops badly ... + - Sometimes the driver will not recognise the DAC, and the + initialisation will fail. This is specifically true for + voodoo 2 boards, but it should be solved in recent versions. Please + contact me. + - The 24/32 is not likely to work anytime soon, knowing that the + hardware does ... unusual things in 24/32 bpp. + - When used with another video board, current limitations of the linux + console subsystem can cause some troubles, specifically, you should + disable software scrollback, as it can oops badly ... Todo @@ -161,7 +161,7 @@ Todo - Buy more coffee. - test/port to other arch. - try to add panning using tweeks with front and back buffer . - - try to implement accel on voodoo2 , this board can actualy do a + - try to implement accel on voodoo2, this board can actually do a lot in 2D even if it was sold as a 3D only board ... ghoz. diff --git a/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt b/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt index 2e410f5..42b95e0 100644 --- a/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt +++ b/Documentation/feature-removal-schedule.txt @@ -184,7 +184,7 @@ Who: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de> --------------------------- What: USB driver API moves to EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL -When: Febuary 2008 +When: February 2008 Files: include/linux/usb.h, drivers/usb/core/driver.c Why: The USB subsystem has changed a lot over time, and it has been possible to create userspace USB drivers using usbfs/libusb/gadgetfs diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/00-INDEX b/Documentation/filesystems/00-INDEX index 16dec61..3c384c0 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/00-INDEX +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/00-INDEX @@ -26,8 +26,6 @@ cramfs.txt - info on the cram filesystem for small storage (ROMs etc). dentry-locking.txt - info on the RCU-based dcache locking model. -devfs/ - - directory containing devfs documentation. directory-locking - info about the locking scheme used for directory operations. dlmfs.txt diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/befs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/befs.txt index 877a7b1..67391a1 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/befs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/befs.txt @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ WARNING Make sure you understand that this is alpha software. This means that the implementation is neither complete nor well-tested. -I DISCLAIM ALL RESPONSIBILTY FOR ANY POSSIBLE BAD EFFECTS OF THIS CODE! +I DISCLAIM ALL RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY POSSIBLE BAD EFFECTS OF THIS CODE! LICENSE ===== @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ He has been working on the code since Aug 13, 2001. See the changelog for details. Original Author: Makoto Kato <m_kato@ga2.so-net.ne.jp> -His orriginal code can still be found at: +His original code can still be found at: <http://hp.vector.co.jp/authors/VA008030/bfs/> Does anyone know of a more current email address for Makoto? He doesn't respond to the address given above... @@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ Which is it, BFS or BEFS? ================ Be, Inc said, "BeOS Filesystem is officially called BFS, not BeFS". But Unixware Boot Filesystem is called bfs, too. And they are already in -the kernel. Because of this nameing conflict, on Linux the BeOS +the kernel. Because of this naming conflict, on Linux the BeOS filesystem is called befs. HOW TO INSTALL @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ if the patching step fails (i.e. there are rejected hunks), you can try to figure it out yourself (it shouldn't be hard), or mail the maintainer (Will Dyson <will_dyson@pobox.com>) for help. -step 2. Configuretion & make kernel +step 2. Configuration & make kernel The linux kernel has many compile-time options. Most of them are beyond the scope of this document. I suggest the Kernel-HOWTO document as a good general diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/configfs/configfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/configfs/configfs.txt index c4ff96b..c3a7afb 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/configfs/configfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/configfs/configfs.txt @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ -configfs - Userspace-driven kernel object configuation. +configfs - Userspace-driven kernel object configuration. Joel Becker <joel.becker@oracle.com> @@ -254,7 +254,7 @@ using the group _init() functions on the group. Finally, when userspace calls rmdir(2) on the item or group, ct_group_ops->drop_item() is called. As a config_group is also a -config_item, it is not necessary for a seperate drop_group() method. +config_item, it is not necessary for a separate drop_group() method. The subsystem must config_item_put() the reference that was initialized upon item allocation. If a subsystem has no work to do, it may omit the ct_group_ops->drop_item() method, and configfs will call @@ -406,7 +406,7 @@ that condition is met. Far better would be an explicit action notifying the subsystem that the config_item is ready to go. More importantly, an explicit action allows -the subsystem to provide feedback as to whether the attibutes are +the subsystem to provide feedback as to whether the attributes are initialized in a way that makes sense. configfs provides this as committable items. @@ -422,7 +422,7 @@ support mkdir(2) or rmdir(2) either. It only allows rename(2). The "pending" directory does allow mkdir(2) and rmdir(2). An item is created in the "pending" directory. Its attributes can be modified at will. Userspace commits the item by renaming it into the "live" -directory. At this point, the subsystem recieves the ->commit_item() +directory. At this point, the subsystem receives the ->commit_item() callback. If all required attributes are filled to satisfaction, the method returns zero and the item is moved to the "live" directory. diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/directory-locking b/Documentation/filesystems/directory-locking index 34380d4..d7099a9 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/directory-locking +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/directory-locking @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ own descendent. Moreover, there is exactly one cross-directory rename Consider the object blocking the cross-directory rename. One of its descendents is locked by cross-directory rename (otherwise we -would again have an infinite set of of contended objects). But that +would again have an infinite set of contended objects). But that means that cross-directory rename is taking locks out of order. Due to (2) the order hadn't changed since we had acquired filesystem lock. But locking rules for cross-directory rename guarantee that we do not diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/dlmfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/dlmfs.txt index 9afab84..c50bbb2 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/dlmfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/dlmfs.txt @@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ request for an already acquired lock will not generate another DLM call. Userspace programs are assumed to handle their own local locking. -Two levels of locks are supported - Shared Read, and Exlcusive. +Two levels of locks are supported - Shared Read, and Exclusive. Also supported is a Trylock operation. For information on the libo2dlm interface, please see o2dlm.h, diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/ext2.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/ext2.txt index 3dd2872..4333e83 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/ext2.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/ext2.txt @@ -205,7 +205,7 @@ Reserved Space In ext2, there is a mechanism for reserving a certain number of blocks for a particular user (normally the super-user). This is intended to -allow for the system to continue functioning even if non-priveleged users +allow for the system to continue functioning even if non-privileged users fill up all the space available to them (this is independent of filesystem quotas). It also keeps the filesystem from filling up entirely which helps combat fragmentation. diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/files.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/files.txt index 8c206f4..133e213 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/files.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/files.txt @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ the fdtable structure - 2. Reading of the fdtable as described above must be protected by rcu_read_lock()/rcu_read_unlock(). -3. For any update to the the fd table, files->file_lock must +3. For any update to the fd table, files->file_lock must be held. 4. To look up the file structure given an fd, a reader diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/ntfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/ntfs.txt index 638cbd3..35f105b 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/ntfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/ntfs.txt @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ Table of contents - Using NTFS volume and stripe sets - The Device-Mapper driver - The Software RAID / MD driver - - Limitiations when using the MD driver + - Limitations when using the MD driver - ChangeLog @@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ There is plenty of additional information on the linux-ntfs web site at http://linux-ntfs.sourceforge.net/ The web site has a lot of additional information, such as a comprehensive -FAQ, documentation on the NTFS on-disk format, informaiton on the Linux-NTFS +FAQ, documentation on the NTFS on-disk format, information on the Linux-NTFS userspace utilities, etc. @@ -383,14 +383,14 @@ Software RAID / MD driver. For which you need to set up your /etc/raidtab appropriately (see man 5 raidtab). Linear volume sets, i.e. linear raid, as well as stripe sets, i.e. raid level -0, have been tested and work fine (though see section "Limitiations when using +0, have been tested and work fine (though see section "Limitations when using the MD driver with NTFS volumes" especially if you want to use linear raid). Even though untested, there is no reason why mirrors, i.e. raid level 1, and stripes with parity, i.e. raid level 5, should not work, too. You have to use the "persistent-superblock 0" option for each raid-disk in the NTFS volume/stripe you are configuring in /etc/raidtab as the persistent -superblock used by the MD driver would damange the NTFS volume. +superblock used by the MD driver would damage the NTFS volume. Windows by default uses a stripe chunk size of 64k, so you probably want the "chunk-size 64k" option for each raid-disk, too. @@ -435,7 +435,7 @@ setup correctly to avoid the possibility of causing damage to the data on the ntfs volume. -Limitiations when using the Software RAID / MD driver +Limitations when using the Software RAID / MD driver ----------------------------------------------------- Using the md driver will not work properly if any of your NTFS partitions have diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt index 7240ee7..3355e69 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/proc.txt @@ -410,7 +410,7 @@ VmallocChunk: 111088 kB this memory, making it slower to access than lowmem. LowTotal: LowFree: Lowmem is memory which can be used for everything that - highmem can be used for, but it is also availble for the + highmem can be used for, but it is also available for the kernel's use for its own data structures. Among many other things, it is where everything from the Slab is allocated. Bad things happen when you're out of lowmem. @@ -1255,7 +1255,7 @@ to allocate (but not use) more memory than is actually available. address space are refused. Used for a typical system. It ensures a seriously wild allocation fails while allowing overcommit to reduce swap usage. root is allowed to - allocate slighly more memory in this mode. This is the + allocate slightly more memory in this mode. This is the default. 1 - Always overcommit. Appropriate for some scientific @@ -1588,7 +1588,7 @@ Enable the strict RFC793 interpretation of the TCP urgent pointer field. The default is to use the BSD compatible interpretation of the urgent pointer pointing to the first byte after the urgent data. The RFC793 interpretation is to have it point to the last byte of urgent data. Enabling this option may -lead to interoperatibility problems. Disabled by default. +lead to interoperability problems. Disabled by default. tcp_syncookies -------------- @@ -1733,7 +1733,7 @@ error_burst and error_cost These parameters are used to limit how many ICMP destination unreachable to send from the host in question. ICMP destination unreachable messages are -sent when we can not reach the next hop, while trying to transmit a packet. +sent when we cannot reach the next hop while trying to transmit a packet. It will also print some error messages to kernel logs if someone is ignoring our ICMP redirects. The higher the error_cost factor is, the fewer destination unreachable and error messages will be let through. Error_burst @@ -1857,7 +1857,7 @@ proxy_qlen Maximum queue length of the delayed proxy arp timer. (see proxy_delay). -app_solcit +app_solicit ---------- Determines the number of requests to send to the user level ARP daemon. Use 0 diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/spufs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/spufs.txt index 8edc395..982645a 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/spufs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/spufs.txt @@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ FILES /ibox The second SPU to CPU communication mailbox. This file is similar to the first mailbox file, but can be read in blocking I/O mode, and the - poll familiy of system calls can be used to wait for it. The possible + poll family of system calls can be used to wait for it. The possible operations on an open ibox file are: read(2) @@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ FILES /wbox - The CPU to SPU communation mailbox. It is write-only can can be written + The CPU to SPU communation mailbox. It is write-only and can be written in units of 32 bits. If the mailbox is full, write() will block and poll can be used to wait for it becoming empty again. The possible operations on an open wbox file are: write(2) If a count smaller than @@ -359,7 +359,7 @@ ERRORS EFAULT npc is not a valid pointer or status is neither NULL nor a valid pointer. - EINTR A signal occured while spu_run was in progress. The npc value + EINTR A signal occurred while spu_run was in progress. The npc value has been updated to the new program counter value if necessary. EINVAL fd is not a file descriptor returned from spu_create(2). diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/sysfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/sysfs.txt index 89b1d19..4b5ca26 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/sysfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/sysfs.txt @@ -238,7 +238,7 @@ Top Level Directory Layout The sysfs directory arrangement exposes the relationship of kernel data structures. -The top level sysfs diretory looks like: +The top level sysfs directory looks like: block/ bus/ diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt index 1773106..6dd0508 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/tmpfs.txt @@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ tmpfs has the following uses: tmpfs /dev/shm tmpfs defaults 0 0 Remember to create the directory that you intend to mount tmpfs on - if necessary (/dev/shm is automagically created if you use devfs). + if necessary. This mount is _not_ needed for SYSV shared memory. The internal mount is used for that. (In the 2.3 kernel versions it was @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ size: The limit of allocated bytes for this tmpfs instance. The nr_blocks: The same as size, but in blocks of PAGE_CACHE_SIZE. nr_inodes: The maximum number of inodes for this instance. The default is half of the number of your physical RAM pages, or (on a - a machine with highmem) the number of lowmem RAM pages, + machine with highmem) the number of lowmem RAM pages, whichever is the lower. These parameters accept a suffix k, m or g for kilo, mega and giga and diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/vfat.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/vfat.txt index 2001abb..069cb10 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/vfat.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/vfat.txt @@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ iocharset=name -- Character set to use for converting between the you should consider the following option instead. utf8=<bool> -- UTF-8 is the filesystem safe version of Unicode that - is used by the console. It can be be enabled for the + is used by the console. It can be enabled for the filesystem with this option. If 'uni_xlate' gets set, UTF-8 gets disabled. diff --git a/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt b/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt index cd07c21..7737bfd 100644 --- a/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt +++ b/Documentation/filesystems/vfs.txt @@ -410,7 +410,7 @@ otherwise noted. put_link: called by the VFS to release resources allocated by follow_link(). The cookie returned by follow_link() is passed - to to this method as the last parameter. It is used by + to this method as the last parameter. It is used by filesystems such as NFS where page cache is not stable (i.e. page that was installed when the symbolic link walk started might not be in the page cache at the end of the diff --git a/Documentation/fujitsu/frv/mmu-layout.txt b/Documentation/fujitsu/frv/mmu-layout.txt index 11dcc56..db10250 100644 --- a/Documentation/fujitsu/frv/mmu-layout.txt +++ b/Documentation/fujitsu/frv/mmu-layout.txt @@ -233,7 +233,7 @@ related kernel services: (*) __debug_mmu.iamr[] (*) __debug_mmu.damr[] - These receive the current IAMR and DAMR contents. These can be viewed with with the _amr + These receive the current IAMR and DAMR contents. These can be viewed with the _amr GDB macro: (gdb) _amr diff --git a/Documentation/highuid.txt b/Documentation/highuid.txt index 2c33926..76034d9 100644 --- a/Documentation/highuid.txt +++ b/Documentation/highuid.txt @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ What's left to be done for 32-bit UIDs on all Linux architectures: Other filesystems have not been checked yet. -- The ncpfs and smpfs filesystems can not presently use 32-bit UIDs in +- The ncpfs and smpfs filesystems cannot presently use 32-bit UIDs in all ioctl()s. Some new ioctl()s have been added with 32-bit UIDs, but more are needed. (as well as new user<->kernel data structures) diff --git a/Documentation/hrtimers.txt b/Documentation/hrtimers.txt index 7620ff7..ce31f65 100644 --- a/Documentation/hrtimers.txt +++ b/Documentation/hrtimers.txt @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ back and forth trying to integrate high-resolution and high-precision features into the existing timer framework, and after testing various such high-resolution timer implementations in practice, we came to the conclusion that the timer wheel code is fundamentally not suitable for -such an approach. We initially didnt believe this ('there must be a way +such an approach. We initially didn't believe this ('there must be a way to solve this'), and spent a considerable effort trying to integrate things into the timer wheel, but we failed. In hindsight, there are several reasons why such integration is hard/impossible: @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ several reasons why such integration is hard/impossible: high-res timers. - the unpredictable [O(N)] overhead of cascading leads to delays which - necessiate a more complex handling of high resolution timers, which + necessitate a more complex handling of high resolution timers, which in turn decreases robustness. Such a design still led to rather large timing inaccuracies. Cascading is a fundamental property of the timer wheel concept, it cannot be 'designed out' without unevitably @@ -58,7 +58,7 @@ several reasons why such integration is hard/impossible: The primary users of precision timers are user-space applications that utilize nanosleep, posix-timers and itimer interfaces. Also, in-kernel users like drivers and subsystems which require precise timed events -(e.g. multimedia) can benefit from the availability of a seperate +(e.g. multimedia) can benefit from the availability of a separate high-resolution timer subsystem as well. While this subsystem does not offer high-resolution clock sources just @@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ The increasing demand for realtime and multimedia applications along with other potential users for precise timers gives another reason to separate the "timeout" and "precise timer" subsystems. -Another potential benefit is that such a seperation allows even more +Another potential benefit is that such a separation allows even more special-purpose optimization of the existing timer wheel for the low resolution and low precision use cases - once the precision-sensitive APIs are separated from the timer wheel and are migrated over to @@ -96,8 +96,8 @@ file systems. The rbtree is solely used for time sorted ordering, while a separate list is used to give the expiry code fast access to the queued timers, without having to walk the rbtree. -(This seperate list is also useful for later when we'll introduce -high-resolution clocks, where we need seperate pending and expired +(This separate list is also useful for later when we'll introduce +high-resolution clocks, where we need separate pending and expired queues while keeping the time-order intact.) Time-ordered enqueueing is not purely for the purposes of diff --git a/Documentation/ia64/efirtc.txt b/Documentation/ia64/efirtc.txt index ede2c1e..057e6be 100644 --- a/Documentation/ia64/efirtc.txt +++ b/Documentation/ia64/efirtc.txt @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ to initialize the system view of the time during boot. Because we wanted to minimize the impact on existing user-level apps using the CMOS clock, we decided to expose an API that was very similar to the one used today with the legacy RTC driver (driver/char/rtc.c). However, because -EFI provides a simpler services, not all all ioctl() are available. Also +EFI provides a simpler services, not all ioctl() are available. Also new ioctl()s have been introduced for things that EFI provides but not the legacy. diff --git a/Documentation/ia64/fsys.txt b/Documentation/ia64/fsys.txt index 28da181..59dd689 100644 --- a/Documentation/ia64/fsys.txt +++ b/Documentation/ia64/fsys.txt @@ -165,7 +165,7 @@ complicated cases. * Signal handling The delivery of (asynchronous) signals must be delayed until fsys-mode -is exited. This is acomplished with the help of the lower-privilege +is exited. This is accomplished with the help of the lower-privilege transfer trap: arch/ia64/kernel/process.c:do_notify_resume_user() checks whether the interrupted task was in fsys-mode and, if so, sets PSR.lp and returns immediately. When fsys-mode is exited via the diff --git a/Documentation/ia64/mca.txt b/Documentation/ia64/mca.txt index a71cc6a..f097c60 100644 --- a/Documentation/ia64/mca.txt +++ b/Documentation/ia64/mca.txt @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ by locks is indeterminate, including linked lists. --- The complicated ia64 MCA process. All of this is mandated by Intel's -specification for ia64 SAL, error recovery and and unwind, it is not as +specification for ia64 SAL, error recovery and unwind, it is not as if we have a choice here. * MCA occurs on one cpu, usually due to a double bit memory error. @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ if we have a choice here. INIT is less complicated than MCA. Pressing the nmi button or using the equivalent command on the management console sends INIT to all -cpus. SAL picks one one of the cpus as the monarch and the rest are +cpus. SAL picks one of the cpus as the monarch and the rest are slaves. All the OS INIT handlers are entered at approximately the same time. The OS monarch prints the state of all tasks and returns, after which the slaves return and the system resumes. diff --git a/Documentation/ibm-acpi.txt b/Documentation/ibm-acpi.txt index 8b3fd82..71aa403 100644 --- a/Documentation/ibm-acpi.txt +++ b/Documentation/ibm-acpi.txt @@ -450,7 +450,7 @@ his laptop (the location of sensors may vary on other models): No commands can be written to this file. -EXPERIMENTAL: Embedded controller reigster dump -- /proc/acpi/ibm/ecdump +EXPERIMENTAL: Embedded controller register dump -- /proc/acpi/ibm/ecdump ------------------------------------------------------------------------ This feature is marked EXPERIMENTAL because the implementation diff --git a/Documentation/ide.txt b/Documentation/ide.txt index 29866fb..0bf38ba 100644 --- a/Documentation/ide.txt +++ b/Documentation/ide.txt @@ -281,7 +281,7 @@ Summary of ide driver parameters for kernel command line "idex=serialize" : do not overlap operations on idex. Please note that you will have to specify this option for - both the respecitve primary and secondary channel + both the respective primary and secondary channel to take effect. "idex=four" : four drives on idex and ide(x^1) share same ports diff --git a/Documentation/input/amijoy.txt b/Documentation/input/amijoy.txt index 3b8b2d4..4f0e89d 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/amijoy.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/amijoy.txt @@ -79,10 +79,10 @@ JOY0DAT Y7 Y6 Y5 Y4 Y3 Y2 Y1 Y0 X7 X6 X5 X4 X3 X2 X1 X0 JOY1DAT Y7 Y6 Y5 Y4 Y3 Y2 Y1 Y0 X7 X6 X5 X4 X3 X2 X1 X0 0=LEFT CONTROLLER PAIR, 1=RIGHT CONTROLLER PAIR. - (4 counters total).The bit usage for both left and right + (4 counters total). The bit usage for both left and right addresses is shown below. Each 6 bit counter (Y7-Y2,X7-X2) is clocked by 2 of the signals input from the mouse serial - stream. Starting with first bit recived: + stream. Starting with first bit received: +-------------------+-----------------------------------------+ | Serial | Bit Name | Description | diff --git a/Documentation/input/atarikbd.txt b/Documentation/input/atarikbd.txt index 8fb896c..1e7e585 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/atarikbd.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/atarikbd.txt @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ provides a convenient connection point for a mouse and switch-type joysticks. The ikbd processor also maintains a time-of-day clock with one second resolution. The ikbd has been designed to be general enough that it can be used with a -ariety of new computer products. Product variations in a number of +variety of new computer products. Product variations in a number of keyswitches, mouse resolution, etc. can be accommodated. The ikbd communicates with the main processor over a high speed bi-directional serial interface. It can function in a variety of modes to facilitate @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ is obtained by ORing 0x80 with the make code. The special codes 0xF6 through 0xFF are reserved for use as follows: 0xF6 status report 0xF7 absolute mouse position record - 0xF8-0xFB relative mouse position records(lsbs determind by + 0xF8-0xFB relative mouse position records (lsbs determined by mouse button states) 0xFC time-of-day 0xFD joystick report (both sticks) @@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ selected. 4.2 Absolute Position reporting The ikbd can also maintain absolute mouse position. Commands exist for -reseting the mouse position, setting X/Y scaling, and interrogating the +resetting the mouse position, setting X/Y scaling, and interrogating the current mouse position. 4.3 Mouse Cursor Key Mode @@ -406,7 +406,7 @@ INTERROGATION MODE. 9.18 SET JOYSTICK MONITORING 0x17 - rate ; time between samples in hundreths of a second + rate ; time between samples in hundredths of a second Returns: (in packets of two as long as in mode) %000000xy ; where y is JOYSTICK1 Fire button ; and x is JOYSTICK0 Fire button @@ -522,7 +522,7 @@ controller memory. The time between data bytes must be less than 20ms. 0x20 ; memory access { data } ; 6 data bytes starting at ADR -This comand permits the host to read from the ikbd controller memory. +This command permits the host to read from the ikbd controller memory. 9.26 CONTROLLER EXECUTE diff --git a/Documentation/input/cs461x.txt b/Documentation/input/cs461x.txt index 6181747..afe0d65 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/cs461x.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/cs461x.txt @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ This driver have the basic support for PCI devices only; there is no ISA or PnP ISA cards supported. AFAIK the ns558 have support for Crystal ISA and PnP ISA series. -The driver works witn ALSA drivers simultaneously. For exmple, the xracer +The driver works with ALSA drivers simultaneously. For example, the xracer uses joystick as input device and PCM device as sound output in one time. There are no sound or input collisions detected. The source code have comments about them; but I've found the joystick can be initialized diff --git a/Documentation/input/ff.txt b/Documentation/input/ff.txt index c53b1c1..085eb15 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/ff.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/ff.txt @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ joystick.txt for details. There is an utility called fftest that will allow you to test the driver. % fftest /dev/input/eventXX -3. Instructions to the developper +3. Instructions to the developer ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ All interactions are done using the event API. That is, you can use ioctl() and write() on /dev/input/eventXX. diff --git a/Documentation/input/gameport-programming.txt b/Documentation/input/gameport-programming.txt index 1ba3d32..14e0a8b 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/gameport-programming.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/gameport-programming.txt @@ -18,8 +18,8 @@ Make sure struct gameport is initialized to 0 in all other fields. The gameport generic code will take care of the rest. If your hardware supports more than one io address, and your driver can -choose which one program the hardware to, starting from the more exotic -addresses is preferred, because the likelyhood of clashing with the standard +choose which one to program the hardware to, starting from the more exotic +addresses is preferred, because the likelihood of clashing with the standard 0x201 address is smaller. Eg. if your driver supports addresses 0x200, 0x208, 0x210 and 0x218, then diff --git a/Documentation/input/input.txt b/Documentation/input/input.txt index 47137e7..ff8cea0 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/input.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/input.txt @@ -68,8 +68,8 @@ will be available as a character device on major 13, minor 63: crw-r--r-- 1 root root 13, 63 Mar 28 22:45 mice - This device has to be created, unless you use devfs, in which case it's -created automatically. The commands to do create it by hand are: + This device has to be created. + The commands to create it by hand are: cd /dev mkdir input @@ -154,7 +154,7 @@ about it. 3.2 Event handlers ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - Event handlers distrubite the events from the devices to userland and + Event handlers distribute the events from the devices to userland and kernel, as needed. 3.2.1 keybdev @@ -230,7 +230,7 @@ generated in the kernel straight to the program, with timestamps. The API is still evolving, but should be useable now. It's described in section 5. - This should be the way for GPM and X to get keyboard and mouse mouse + This should be the way for GPM and X to get keyboard and mouse events. It allows for multihead in X without any specific multihead kernel support. The event codes are the same on all architectures and are hardware independent. @@ -279,7 +279,7 @@ struct input_event { }; 'time' is the timestamp, it returns the time at which the event happened. -Type is for example EV_REL for relative momement, REL_KEY for a keypress or +Type is for example EV_REL for relative moment, REL_KEY for a keypress or release. More types are defined in include/linux/input.h. 'code' is event code, for example REL_X or KEY_BACKSPACE, again a complete @@ -289,24 +289,3 @@ list is in include/linux/input.h. EV_REL, absolute new value for EV_ABS (joysticks ...), or 0 for EV_KEY for release, 1 for keypress and 2 for autorepeat. -6. Contacts -~~~~~~~~~~~ - This effort has its home page at: - - http://www.suse.cz/development/input/ - -You'll find both the latest HID driver and the complete Input driver -there as well as information how to access the CVS repository for -latest revisions of the drivers. - - There is also a mailing list for this: - - majordomo@atrey.karlin.mff.cuni.cz - -Send "subscribe linux-input" to subscribe to it. - -The input changes are also being worked on as part of the LinuxConsole -project, see: - - http://sourceforge.net/projects/linuxconsole/ - diff --git a/Documentation/input/joystick-parport.txt b/Documentation/input/joystick-parport.txt index d537c48..ede5f33 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/joystick-parport.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/joystick-parport.txt @@ -456,8 +456,8 @@ uses the following kernel/module command line: 8 | Sony PSX DDR controller 9 | SNES mouse - The exact type of the PSX controller type is autoprobed when used so -hot swapping should work (but is not recomended). + The exact type of the PSX controller type is autoprobed when used, so +hot swapping should work (but is not recommended). Should you want to use more than one of parallel ports at once, you can use gamecon.map2 and gamecon.map3 as additional command line parameters for two @@ -465,8 +465,8 @@ more parallel ports. There are two options specific to PSX driver portion. gamecon.psx_delay sets the command delay when talking to the controllers. The default of 25 should -work but you can try lowering it for better performace. If your pads don't -respond try raising it untill they work. Setting the type to 8 allows the +work but you can try lowering it for better performance. If your pads don't +respond try raising it until they work. Setting the type to 8 allows the driver to be used with Dance Dance Revolution or similar games. Arrow keys are registered as key presses instead of X and Y axes. diff --git a/Documentation/input/joystick.txt b/Documentation/input/joystick.txt index 841c353..389de9b 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/joystick.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/joystick.txt @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ and install it before going on. 2.2 Device nodes ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ -For applications to be able to use the joysticks, in you don't use devfs, +For applications to be able to use the joysticks, you'll have to manually create these nodes in /dev: cd /dev diff --git a/Documentation/input/yealink.txt b/Documentation/input/yealink.txt index 0962c5c..0a8c97e 100644 --- a/Documentation/input/yealink.txt +++ b/Documentation/input/yealink.txt @@ -87,13 +87,13 @@ Line 3 Format : 888888888888 Format description: - From a user space perspective the world is seperated in "digits" and "icons". + From a userspace perspective the world is separated into "digits" and "icons". A digit can have a character set, an icon can only be ON or OFF. Format specifier '8' : Generic 7 segment digit with individual addressable segments - Reduced capabillity 7 segm digit, when segments are hard wired together. + Reduced capability 7 segm digit, when segments are hard wired together. '1' : 2 segments digit only able to produce a 1. 'e' : Most significant day of the month digit, able to produce at least 1 2 3. diff --git a/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt b/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt index 11c9be4..c19efde 100644 --- a/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt +++ b/Documentation/ioctl/hdio.txt @@ -203,7 +203,7 @@ HDIO_SET_MULTCOUNT change IDE blockmode Source code comments read: - This is tightly woven into the driver->do_special can not + This is tightly woven into the driver->do_special cannot touch. DON'T do it again until a total personality rewrite is committed. diff --git a/Documentation/isdn/INTERFACE.fax b/Documentation/isdn/INTERFACE.fax index 7e57313..9c8c6d9 100644 --- a/Documentation/isdn/INTERFACE.fax +++ b/Documentation/isdn/INTERFACE.fax @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ Structure T30_s description: If the HL-driver receives ISDN_CMD_FAXCMD, all needed information is in this struct set by the LL. To signal information to the LL, the HL-driver has to set the - the parameters and use ISDN_STAT_FAXIND. + parameters and use ISDN_STAT_FAXIND. (Please refer to INTERFACE) Structure T30_s: diff --git a/Documentation/isdn/README.hysdn b/Documentation/isdn/README.hysdn index 56cc59d..eeca11f 100644 --- a/Documentation/isdn/README.hysdn +++ b/Documentation/isdn/README.hysdn @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ $Id: README.hysdn,v 1.3.6.1 2001/02/10 14:41:19 kai Exp $ The hysdn driver has been written by -by Werner Cornelius (werner@isdn4linux.de or werner@titro.de) +Werner Cornelius (werner@isdn4linux.de or werner@titro.de) for Hypercope GmbH Aachen Germany. Hypercope agreed to publish this driver under the GNU General Public License. diff --git a/Documentation/java.txt b/Documentation/java.txt index e4814c2..c768dc6 100644 --- a/Documentation/java.txt +++ b/Documentation/java.txt @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ other program after you have done the following: the kernel (CONFIG_BINFMT_MISC) and set it up properly. If you choose to compile it as a module, you will have to insert it manually with modprobe/insmod, as kmod - can not easily be supported with binfmt_misc. + cannot easily be supported with binfmt_misc. Read the file 'binfmt_misc.txt' in this directory to know more about the configuration process. diff --git a/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt b/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt index 003fccc..7f34778d 100644 --- a/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt +++ b/Documentation/kbuild/kconfig-language.txt @@ -110,7 +110,7 @@ applicable everywhere (see syntax). the indentation level, this means it ends at the first line which has a smaller indentation than the first line of the help text. "---help---" and "help" do not differ in behaviour, "---help---" is - used to help visually seperate configuration logic from help within + used to help visually separate configuration logic from help within the file as an aid to developers. @@ -226,7 +226,7 @@ menuconfig: "menuconfig" <symbol> <config options> -This is similiar to the simple config entry above, but it also gives a +This is similar to the simple config entry above, but it also gives a hint to front ends, that all suboptions should be displayed as a separate list of options. diff --git a/Documentation/kdump/kdump.txt b/Documentation/kdump/kdump.txt index 08bafa8..99f2d4d 100644 --- a/Documentation/kdump/kdump.txt +++ b/Documentation/kdump/kdump.txt @@ -249,7 +249,7 @@ If die() is called, and it happens to be a thread with pid 0 or 1, or die() is called inside interrupt context or die() is called and panic_on_oops is set, the system will boot into the dump-capture kernel. -On powererpc systems when a soft-reset is generated, die() is called by all cpus and the system system will boot into the dump-capture kernel. +On powererpc systems when a soft-reset is generated, die() is called by all cpus and the system will boot into the dump-capture kernel. For testing purposes, you can trigger a crash by using "ALT-SysRq-c", "echo c > /proc/sysrq-trigger or write a module to force the panic. diff --git a/Documentation/kernel-docs.txt b/Documentation/kernel-docs.txt index 99d24f2..b53bccb 100644 --- a/Documentation/kernel-docs.txt +++ b/Documentation/kernel-docs.txt @@ -290,17 +290,6 @@ Description: Very nice 92 pages GPL book on the topic of modules programming. Lots of examples. - * Title: "Device File System (devfs) Overview" - Author: Richard Gooch. - URL: http://www.atnf.csiro.au/people/rgooch/linux/docs/devfs.html - Keywords: filesystem, /dev, devfs, dynamic devices, major/minor - allocation, device management. - Description: Document describing Richard Gooch's controversial - devfs, which allows for dynamic devices, only shows present - devices in /dev, gets rid of major/minor numbers allocation - problems, and allows for hundreds of identical devices (which some - USB systems might demand soon). - * Title: "I/O Event Handling Under Linux" Author: Richard Gooch. URL: http://www.atnf.csiro.au/~rgooch/linux/docs/io-events.html diff --git a/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt b/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt index 137e993..12b3b24 100644 --- a/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt +++ b/Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt @@ -355,9 +355,9 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file clock= [BUGS=IA-32, HW] gettimeofday clocksource override. [Deprecated] - Forces specified clocksource (if avaliable) to be used + Forces specified clocksource (if available) to be used when calculating gettimeofday(). If specified - clocksource is not avalible, it defaults to PIT. + clocksource is not available, it defaults to PIT. Format: { pit | tsc | cyclone | pmtmr } disable_8254_timer @@ -611,8 +611,8 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file noirqbalance [IA-32,SMP,KNL] Disable kernel irq balancing i8042.direct [HW] Put keyboard port into non-translated mode - i8042.dumbkbd [HW] Pretend that controlled can only read data from - keyboard and can not control its state + i8042.dumbkbd [HW] Pretend that controller can only read data from + keyboard and cannot control its state (Don't attempt to blink the leds) i8042.noaux [HW] Don't check for auxiliary (== mouse) port i8042.nokbd [HW] Don't check/create keyboard port @@ -1368,7 +1368,7 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file reboot= [BUGS=IA-32,BUGS=ARM,BUGS=IA-64] Rebooting mode Format: <reboot_mode>[,<reboot_mode2>[,...]] - See arch/*/kernel/reboot.c. + See arch/*/kernel/reboot.c or arch/*/kernel/process.c reserve= [KNL,BUGS] Force the kernel to ignore some iomem area diff --git a/Documentation/keys.txt b/Documentation/keys.txt index e373f02..3da586b 100644 --- a/Documentation/keys.txt +++ b/Documentation/keys.txt @@ -671,7 +671,7 @@ The keyctl syscall functions are: Note that this setting is inherited across fork/exec. - [1] The default default is: the thread keyring if there is one, otherwise + [1] The default is: the thread keyring if there is one, otherwise the process keyring if there is one, otherwise the session keyring if there is one, otherwise the user default session keyring. @@ -708,14 +708,14 @@ The keyctl syscall functions are: If the specified key is 0, then any assumed authority will be divested. - The assumed authorititive key is inherited across fork and exec. + The assumed authoritative key is inherited across fork and exec. =============== KERNEL SERVICES =============== -The kernel services for key managment are fairly simple to deal with. They can +The kernel services for key management are fairly simple to deal with. They can be broken down into two areas: keys and key types. Dealing with keys is fairly straightforward. Firstly, the kernel service diff --git a/Documentation/kobject.txt b/Documentation/kobject.txt index 949f7b5..e448555 100644 --- a/Documentation/kobject.txt +++ b/Documentation/kobject.txt @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ more complex object types. It provides a set of basic fields that almost all complex data types share. kobjects are intended to be embedded in larger data structures and replace fields they duplicate. -1.2 Defintion +1.2 Definition struct kobject { char name[KOBJ_NAME_LEN]; diff --git a/Documentation/laptop-mode.txt b/Documentation/laptop-mode.txt index 5696e87..c487186 100644 --- a/Documentation/laptop-mode.txt +++ b/Documentation/laptop-mode.txt @@ -152,7 +152,7 @@ loaded on demand while the application executes) and sequentially accessed data DO_REMOUNTS: The control script automatically remounts any mounted journaled filesystems -with approriate commit interval options. When this option is set to 0, this +with appropriate commit interval options. When this option is set to 0, this feature is disabled. DO_REMOUNT_NOATIME: diff --git a/Documentation/lockdep-design.txt b/Documentation/lockdep-design.txt index 55a7e4f..dab123d 100644 --- a/Documentation/lockdep-design.txt +++ b/Documentation/lockdep-design.txt @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ cases there is an inherent "natural" ordering between the two objects (defined by the properties of the hierarchy), and the kernel grabs the locks in this fixed order on each of the objects. -An example of such an object hieararchy that results in "nested locking" +An example of such an object hierarchy that results in "nested locking" is that of a "whole disk" block-dev object and a "partition" block-dev object; the partition is "part of" the whole device and as long as one always takes the whole disk lock as a higher lock than the partition @@ -158,11 +158,11 @@ enum bdev_bd_mutex_lock_class In this case the locking is done on a bdev object that is known to be a partition. -The validator treats a lock that is taken in such a nested fasion as a +The validator treats a lock that is taken in such a nested fashion as a separate (sub)class for the purposes of validation. Note: When changing code to use the _nested() primitives, be careful and -check really thoroughly that the hiearchy is correctly mapped; otherwise +check really thoroughly that the hierarchy is correctly mapped; otherwise you can get false positives or false negatives. Proof of 100% correctness: @@ -170,7 +170,7 @@ Proof of 100% correctness: The validator achieves perfect, mathematical 'closure' (proof of locking correctness) in the sense that for every simple, standalone single-task -locking sequence that occured at least once during the lifetime of the +locking sequence that occurred at least once during the lifetime of the kernel, the validator proves it with a 100% certainty that no combination and timing of these locking sequences can cause any class of lock related deadlock. [*] diff --git a/Documentation/m68k/kernel-options.txt b/Documentation/m68k/kernel-options.txt index d5d3f06..1c41db2 100644 --- a/Documentation/m68k/kernel-options.txt +++ b/Documentation/m68k/kernel-options.txt @@ -415,7 +415,7 @@ switch to another mode once Linux has started. The first 3 parameters of this sub-option should be obvious: <xres>, <yres> and <depth> give the dimensions of the screen and the number of -planes (depth). The depth is is the logarithm to base 2 of the number +planes (depth). The depth is the logarithm to base 2 of the number of colors possible. (Or, the other way round: The number of colors is 2^depth). diff --git a/Documentation/mca.txt b/Documentation/mca.txt index 6091335..aabce4a 100644 --- a/Documentation/mca.txt +++ b/Documentation/mca.txt @@ -177,7 +177,7 @@ Currently, there are a number of MCA-specific device drivers. with clones that have a different adapter id than the original NE/2. -6) Future Domain MCS-600/700, OEM'd IBM Fast SCSI Aapter/A and +6) Future Domain MCS-600/700, OEM'd IBM Fast SCSI Adapter/A and Reply Sound Blaster/SCSI (SCSI part) Better support for these cards than the driver for ISA. Supports multiple cards with IRQ sharing. diff --git a/Documentation/md.txt b/Documentation/md.txt index 9ae9e40..2202f5d 100644 --- a/Documentation/md.txt +++ b/Documentation/md.txt @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ be reconstructed (due to no parity). For this reason, md will normally refuse to start such an array. This requires the sysadmin to take action to explicitly start the array -desipite possible corruption. This is normally done with +despite possible corruption. This is normally done with mdadm --assemble --force .... This option is not really available if the array has the root @@ -175,7 +175,7 @@ All md devices contain: raid levels that involve striping (1,4,5,6,10). The address space of the array is conceptually divided into chunks and consecutive chunks are striped onto neighbouring devices. - The size should be atleast PAGE_SIZE (4k) and should be a power + The size should be at least PAGE_SIZE (4k) and should be a power of 2. This can only be set while assembling an array component_size @@ -214,8 +214,8 @@ All md devices contain: safe_mode_delay When an md array has seen no write requests for a certain period of time, it will be marked as 'clean'. When another write - request arrive, the array is marked as 'dirty' before the write - commenses. This is known as 'safe_mode'. + request arrives, the array is marked as 'dirty' before the write + commences. This is known as 'safe_mode'. The 'certain period' is controlled by this file which stores the period as a number of seconds. The default is 200msec (0.200). Writing a value of 0 disables safemode. @@ -307,8 +307,8 @@ Each directory contains: This applies only to raid1 arrays. spare - device is working, but not a full member. This includes spares that are in the process - of being recoverred to - This list make grow in future. + of being recovered to + This list may grow in future. This can be written to. Writing "faulty" simulates a failure on the device. Writing "remove" removes the device from the array. @@ -330,7 +330,7 @@ Each directory contains: This gives the role that the device has in the array. It will either be 'none' if the device is not active in the array (i.e. is a spare or has failed) or an integer less than the - 'raid_disks' number for the array indicating which possition + 'raid_disks' number for the array indicating which position it currently fills. This can only be set while assembling an array. A device for which this is set is assumed to be working. @@ -353,7 +353,7 @@ in the array. These are named rdNN -where 'NN' is the possition in the array, starting from 0. +where 'NN' is the position in the array, starting from 0. So for a 3 drive array there will be rd0, rd1, rd2. These are symbolic links to the appropriate 'dev-XXX' entry. Thus, for example, diff --git a/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt b/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt index 46b9b38..994355b 100644 --- a/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt +++ b/Documentation/memory-barriers.txt @@ -670,7 +670,7 @@ effectively random order, despite the write barrier issued by CPU 1: In the above example, CPU 2 perceives that B is 7, despite the load of *C -(which would be B) coming after the the LOAD of C. +(which would be B) coming after the LOAD of C. If, however, a data dependency barrier were to be placed between the load of C and the load of *C (ie: B) on CPU 2: @@ -1915,7 +1915,7 @@ Whilst most CPUs do imply a data dependency barrier on the read when a memory access depends on a read, not all do, so it may not be relied on. Other CPUs may also have split caches, but must coordinate between the various -cachelets for normal memory accesss. The semantics of the Alpha removes the +cachelets for normal memory accesses. The semantics of the Alpha removes the need for coordination in absence of memory barriers. diff --git a/Documentation/mono.txt b/Documentation/mono.txt index 807a0c7..e8e1758 100644 --- a/Documentation/mono.txt +++ b/Documentation/mono.txt @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ other program after you have done the following: the kernel (CONFIG_BINFMT_MISC) and set it up properly. If you choose to compile it as a module, you will have to insert it manually with modprobe/insmod, as kmod - can not be easily supported with binfmt_misc. + cannot be easily supported with binfmt_misc. Read the file 'binfmt_misc.txt' in this directory to know more about the configuration process. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/3c509.txt b/Documentation/networking/3c509.txt index 867a99f..0643e3b 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/3c509.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/3c509.txt @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ packets faster than they can be removed from the card. This should be rare or impossible in normal operation. Possible causes of this error report are: - a "green" mode enabled that slows the processor down when there is no - keyboard activitiy. + keyboard activity. - some other device or device driver hogging the bus or disabling interrupts. Check /proc/interrupts for excessive interrupt counts. The timer tick diff --git a/Documentation/networking/NAPI_HOWTO.txt b/Documentation/networking/NAPI_HOWTO.txt index 54376e8..93af3e8 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/NAPI_HOWTO.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/NAPI_HOWTO.txt @@ -35,7 +35,7 @@ Legend: packets out of the rx ring. Note from this that the lower the load the more we could clean up the rxring "Ndone" == is the converse of "Done". Note again, that the higher -the load the more times we couldnt clean up the rxring. +the load the more times we couldn't clean up the rxring. Observe that: when the NIC receives 890Kpackets/sec only 17 rx interrupts are generated. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/arcnet-hardware.txt b/Documentation/networking/arcnet-hardware.txt index 30a5f01..731de41 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/arcnet-hardware.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/arcnet-hardware.txt @@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ And now to the cabling. What you can connect together: 5. An active hub to passive hub. -Remember, that you can not connect two passive hubs together. The power loss +Remember that you cannot connect two passive hubs together. The power loss implied by such a connection is too high for the net to operate reliably. An example of a typical ARCnet network: diff --git a/Documentation/networking/bonding.txt b/Documentation/networking/bonding.txt index dc942ea..de809e5 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/bonding.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/bonding.txt @@ -1023,7 +1023,7 @@ Changing a Bond's Configuration files located in /sys/class/net/<bond name>/bonding The names of these files correspond directly with the command- -line parameters described elsewhere in in this file, and, with the +line parameters described elsewhere in this file, and, with the exception of arp_ip_target, they accept the same values. To see the current setting, simply cat the appropriate file. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/cs89x0.txt b/Documentation/networking/cs89x0.txt index 188beb7..6489647 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/cs89x0.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/cs89x0.txt @@ -227,7 +227,7 @@ configuration options are available on the command line: * media=rj45 - specify media type or media=bnc or media=aui - or medai=auto + or media=auto * duplex=full - specify forced half/full/autonegotiate duplex or duplex=half or duplex=auto @@ -584,7 +584,7 @@ of four ways after installing and or configuring the CS8900/20-based adapter: 1.) The system does not boot properly (or at all). - 2.) The driver can not communicate with the adapter, reporting an "Adapter + 2.) The driver cannot communicate with the adapter, reporting an "Adapter not found" error message. 3.) You cannot connect to the network or the driver will not load. @@ -684,7 +684,7 @@ ethernet@crystal.cirrus.com) and request that you be registered for automatic software-update notification. Cirrus Logic maintains a web page at http://www.cirrus.com with the -the latest drivers and technical publications. +latest drivers and technical publications. 6.4 Current maintainer diff --git a/Documentation/networking/cxgb.txt b/Documentation/networking/cxgb.txt index 7632463..20a8876 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/cxgb.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/cxgb.txt @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ FEATURES ethtool -C eth0 rx-usecs 100 - You may also provide a timer latency value while disabling adpative-rx: + You may also provide a timer latency value while disabling adaptive-rx: ethtool -C <interface> adaptive-rx off rx-usecs <microseconds> @@ -172,7 +172,7 @@ PERFORMANCE smaller window prevents congestion and facilitates better pacing, especially if/when MAC level flow control does not work well or when it is not supported on the machine. Experimentation may be necessary to attain - the correct value. This method is provided as a starting point fot the + the correct value. This method is provided as a starting point for the correct receive buffer size. Setting the min, max, and default receive buffer (RX_WINDOW) size is performed in the same manner as single connection. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/decnet.txt b/Documentation/networking/decnet.txt index e6c39c5..badb748 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/decnet.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/decnet.txt @@ -82,7 +82,7 @@ ethernet address of your ethernet card has to be set according to the DECnet address of the node in order for it to be autoconfigured (and then appear in /proc/net/decnet_dev). There is a utility available at the above FTP sites called dn2ethaddr which can compute the correct ethernet -address to use. The address can be set by ifconfig either before at +address to use. The address can be set by ifconfig either before or at the time the device is brought up. If you are using RedHat you can add the line: diff --git a/Documentation/networking/dl2k.txt b/Documentation/networking/dl2k.txt index d4604920..10e8490 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/dl2k.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/dl2k.txt @@ -173,7 +173,7 @@ Installing the Driver Parameter Description ===================== -You can install this driver without any addtional parameter. However, if you +You can install this driver without any additional parameter. However, if you are going to have extensive functions then it is necessary to set extra parameter. Below is a list of the command line parameters supported by the Linux device @@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ rx_timeout=n - Rx DMA wait time for an interrupt. reach timeout of n * 640 nano seconds. Set proper rx_coalesce and rx_timeout can reduce congestion collapse and overload which - has been a bottlenect for high speed network. + has been a bottleneck for high speed network. For example, rx_coalesce=10 rx_timeout=800. that is, hardware assert only 1 interrupt diff --git a/Documentation/networking/dmfe.txt b/Documentation/networking/dmfe.txt index 0463635..b1b7499 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/dmfe.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/dmfe.txt @@ -34,7 +34,7 @@ Next you should configure your network interface with a command similar to : ifconfig eth0 172.22.3.18 ^^^^^^^^^^^ - Your IP Adress + Your IP Address Then you may have to modify the default routing table with command : diff --git a/Documentation/networking/driver.txt b/Documentation/networking/driver.txt index a9ad58b..4f7da5a 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/driver.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/driver.txt @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ Transmit path guidelines: ... } - And then at the end of your TX reclaimation event handling: + And then at the end of your TX reclamation event handling: if (netif_queue_stopped(dp->dev) && TX_BUFFS_AVAIL(dp) > (MAX_SKB_FRAGS + 1)) diff --git a/Documentation/networking/e1000.txt b/Documentation/networking/e1000.txt index 71fe15a..5c0a5cc 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/e1000.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/e1000.txt @@ -350,7 +350,7 @@ Additional Configurations As an example, if you install the e1000 driver for two PRO/1000 adapters (eth0 and eth1) and set the speed and duplex to 10full and 100half, add - the following to modules.conf or or modprobe.conf: + the following to modules.conf or modprobe.conf: alias eth0 e1000 alias eth1 e1000 diff --git a/Documentation/networking/fib_trie.txt b/Documentation/networking/fib_trie.txt index f50d0c6..0723db7 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/fib_trie.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/fib_trie.txt @@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ trie_rebalance() resize() Analyzes a tnode and optimizes the child array size by either inflating - or shrinking it repeatedly until it fullfills the criteria for optimal + or shrinking it repeatedly until it fulfills the criteria for optimal level compression. This part follows the original paper pretty closely and there may be some room for experimentation here. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/gen_stats.txt b/Documentation/networking/gen_stats.txt index c3297f7..70e6275 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/gen_stats.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/gen_stats.txt @@ -79,8 +79,8 @@ Rate Estimator: 0) Prepare an estimator attribute. Most likely this would be in user space. The value of this TLV should contain a tc_estimator structure. - As usual, such a TLV nees to be 32 bit aligned and therefore the - length needs to be appropriately set etc. The estimator interval + As usual, such a TLV needs to be 32 bit aligned and therefore the + length needs to be appropriately set, etc. The estimator interval and ewma log need to be converted to the appropriate values. tc_estimator.c::tc_setup_estimator() is advisable to be used as the conversion routine. It does a few clever things. It takes a time @@ -103,8 +103,8 @@ In the kernel when setting up: else failed -From now on, everytime you dump my_rate_est_stats it will contain -uptodate info. +From now on, every time you dump my_rate_est_stats it will contain +up-to-date info. Once you are done, call gen_kill_estimator(my_basicstats, my_rate_est_stats) Make sure that my_basicstats and my_rate_est_stats diff --git a/Documentation/networking/ip-sysctl.txt b/Documentation/networking/ip-sysctl.txt index 935e298..fd3c0c0 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/ip-sysctl.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/ip-sysctl.txt @@ -495,7 +495,7 @@ icmp_errors_use_inbound_ifaddr - BOOLEAN Note that if no primary address exists for the interface selected, then the primary address of the first non-loopback interface that - has one will be used regarldess of this setting. + has one will be used regardless of this setting. Default: 0 @@ -787,7 +787,7 @@ accept_ra_defrtr - BOOLEAN disabled if accept_ra is disabled. accept_ra_pinfo - BOOLEAN - Learn Prefix Inforamtion in Router Advertisement. + Learn Prefix Information in Router Advertisement. Functional default: enabled if accept_ra is enabled. disabled if accept_ra is disabled. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/netconsole.txt b/Documentation/networking/netconsole.txt index 53618fb..1caa6c7 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/netconsole.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/netconsole.txt @@ -52,6 +52,6 @@ messages is high, but should have no other impact. Netconsole was designed to be as instantaneous as possible, to enable the logging of even the most critical kernel bugs. It works from IRQ contexts as well, and does not enable interrupts while -sending packets. Due to these unique needs, configuration can not +sending packets. Due to these unique needs, configuration cannot be more automatic, and some fundamental limitations will remain: only IP networks, UDP packets and ethernet devices are supported. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/netif-msg.txt b/Documentation/networking/netif-msg.txt index 18ad4ce..c967ddb 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/netif-msg.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/netif-msg.txt @@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ History Per-interface rather than per-driver message level setting. More selective control over the type of messages emitted. - The netif_msg recommandation adds these features with only a minor + The netif_msg recommendation adds these features with only a minor complexity and code size increase. The recommendation is the following points diff --git a/Documentation/networking/operstates.txt b/Documentation/networking/operstates.txt index 4a21d9b..c9074f9 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/operstates.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/operstates.txt @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ 1. Introduction Linux distinguishes between administrative and operational state of an -interface. Admininstrative state is the result of "ip link set dev +interface. Administrative state is the result of "ip link set dev <dev> up or down" and reflects whether the administrator wants to use the device for traffic. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/packet_mmap.txt b/Documentation/networking/packet_mmap.txt index aaf99d5..12a008a 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/packet_mmap.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/packet_mmap.txt @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ the following process: [setup] socket() -------> creation of the capture socket setsockopt() ---> allocation of the circular buffer (ring) - mmap() ---------> maping of the allocated buffer to the + mmap() ---------> mapping of the allocated buffer to the user process [capture] poll() ---------> to wait for incoming packets @@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ The destruction of the socket and all associated resources is done by a simple call to close(fd). Next I will describe PACKET_MMAP settings and it's constraints, -also the maping of the circular buffer in the user process and +also the mapping of the circular buffer in the user process and the use of this buffer. -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -153,8 +153,8 @@ we will get the following buffer structure: A frame can be of any size with the only condition it can fit in a block. A block can only hold an integer number of frames, or in other words, a frame cannot -be spawn accross two blocks so there are some datails you have to take into -account when choosing the frame_size. See "Maping and use of the circular +be spawned accross two blocks, so there are some details you have to take into +account when choosing the frame_size. See "Mapping and use of the circular buffer (ring)". @@ -215,8 +215,8 @@ called pg_vec, its size limits the number of blocks that can be allocated. block #1 -kmalloc allocates any number of bytes of phisically contiguous memory from -a pool of pre-determined sizes. This pool of memory is mantained by the slab +kmalloc allocates any number of bytes of physically contiguous memory from +a pool of pre-determined sizes. This pool of memory is maintained by the slab allocator which is at the end the responsible for doing the allocation and hence which imposes the maximum memory that kmalloc can allocate. @@ -262,7 +262,7 @@ i386 architecture: <pagesize> = 4096 bytes <max-order> = 11 -and a value for <frame size> of 2048 byteas. These parameters will yield +and a value for <frame size> of 2048 bytes. These parameters will yield <block number> = 131072/4 = 32768 blocks <block size> = 4096 << 11 = 8 MiB. @@ -278,7 +278,7 @@ an i386 kernel's memory size is limited to 1GiB. All memory allocations are not freed until the socket is closed. The memory allocations are done with GFP_KERNEL priority, this basically means that the allocation can wait and swap other process' memory in order to allocate -the nececessary memory, so normally limits can be reached. +the necessary memory, so normally limits can be reached. Other constraints ------------------- @@ -296,7 +296,7 @@ the following (from include/linux/if_packet.h): - struct tpacket_hdr - pad to TPACKET_ALIGNMENT=16 - struct sockaddr_ll - - Gap, chosen so that packet data (Start+tp_net) alignes to + - Gap, chosen so that packet data (Start+tp_net) aligns to TPACKET_ALIGNMENT=16 - Start+tp_mac: [ Optional MAC header ] - Start+tp_net: Packet data, aligned to TPACKET_ALIGNMENT=16. @@ -311,14 +311,14 @@ the following (from include/linux/if_packet.h): tp_frame_size must be a multiple of TPACKET_ALIGNMENT tp_frame_nr must be exactly frames_per_block*tp_block_nr -Note that tp_block_size should be choosed to be a power of two or there will +Note that tp_block_size should be chosen to be a power of two or there will be a waste of memory. -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- -+ Maping and use of the circular buffer (ring) ++ Mapping and use of the circular buffer (ring) -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- -The maping of the buffer in the user process is done with the conventional +The mapping of the buffer in the user process is done with the conventional mmap function. Even the circular buffer is compound of several physically discontiguous blocks of memory, they are contiguous to the user space, hence just one call to mmap is needed: diff --git a/Documentation/networking/pktgen.txt b/Documentation/networking/pktgen.txt index 18d385c..c8eee23 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/pktgen.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/pktgen.txt @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ Date: 041221 Enable CONFIG_NET_PKTGEN to compile and build pktgen.o either in kernel or as module. Module is preferred. insmod pktgen if needed. Once running -pktgen creates a thread on each CPU where each thread has affinty it's CPU. +pktgen creates a thread on each CPU where each thread has affinity to its CPU. Monitoring and controlling is done via /proc. Easiest to select a suitable a sample script and configure. @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ root 129 0.3 0.0 0 0 ? SW 2003 523:20 [pktgen/0] root 130 0.3 0.0 0 0 ? SW 2003 509:50 [pktgen/1] -For montoring and control pktgen creates: +For monitoring and control pktgen creates: /proc/net/pktgen/pgctrl /proc/net/pktgen/kpktgend_X /proc/net/pktgen/ethX @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ Running: Stopped: eth1 Result: OK: max_before_softirq=10000 -Most important the devices assigend to thread. Note! A device can only belong +Most important the devices assigned to thread. Note! A device can only belong to one thread. @@ -147,7 +147,7 @@ Examples: Example scripts =============== -A collection of small tutorial scripts for pktgen is in expamples dir. +A collection of small tutorial scripts for pktgen is in examples dir. pktgen.conf-1-1 # 1 CPU 1 dev pktgen.conf-1-2 # 1 CPU 2 dev diff --git a/Documentation/networking/s2io.txt b/Documentation/networking/s2io.txt index bd528ff..4bde53e 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/s2io.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/s2io.txt @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ However, you may want to set PCI latency timer to 248. #setpci -d 17d5:* LATENCY_TIMER=f8 For detailed description of the PCI registers, please see Xframe User Guide. b. Use 2-buffer mode. This results in large performance boost on -on certain platforms(eg. SGI Altix, IBM xSeries). +certain platforms(eg. SGI Altix, IBM xSeries). c. Ensure Receive Checksum offload is enabled. Use "ethtool -K ethX" command to set/verify this option. d. Enable NAPI feature(in kernel configuration Device Drivers ---> Network diff --git a/Documentation/networking/sk98lin.txt b/Documentation/networking/sk98lin.txt index 7837c53..4e1cc74 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/sk98lin.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/sk98lin.txt @@ -180,7 +180,7 @@ To set the driver parameters in this file, proceed as follows: 1. Insert a line of the form : options sk98lin ... For "...", the same syntax is required as described for the command - line paramaters of modprobe below. + line parameters of modprobe below. 2. To activate the new parameters, either reboot your computer or unload and reload the driver. @@ -320,7 +320,7 @@ Parameter: Moderation Values: None, Static, Dynamic Default: None -Interrupt moderation is employed to limit the maxmimum number of interrupts +Interrupt moderation is employed to limit the maximum number of interrupts the driver has to serve. That is, one or more interrupts (which indicate any transmit or receive packet to be processed) are queued until the driver processes them. When queued interrupts are to be served, is determined by the @@ -364,9 +364,9 @@ Parameter: IntsPerSec Values: 30...40000 (interrupts per second) Default: 2000 -This parameter is only used, if either static or dynamic interrupt moderation -is used on a network adapter card. Using this paramter if no moderation is -applied, will lead to no action performed. +This parameter is only used if either static or dynamic interrupt moderation +is used on a network adapter card. Using this parameter if no moderation is +applied will lead to no action performed. This parameter determines the length of any interrupt moderation interval. Assuming that static interrupt moderation is to be used, an 'IntsPerSec' @@ -484,7 +484,7 @@ If any problems occur during the installation process, check the following list: -Problem: The SK-98xx adapter can not be found by the driver. +Problem: The SK-98xx adapter cannot be found by the driver. Solution: In /proc/pci search for the following entry: 'Ethernet controller: SysKonnect SK-98xx ...' If this entry exists, the SK-98xx or SK-98xx V2.0 adapter has @@ -497,12 +497,12 @@ Solution: In /proc/pci search for the following entry: www.syskonnect.com Some COMPAQ machines have problems dealing with PCI under Linux. - Linux. This problem is described in the 'PCI howto' document + This problem is described in the 'PCI howto' document (included in some distributions or available from the web, e.g. at 'www.linux.org'). -Problem: Programs such as 'ifconfig' or 'route' can not be found or the +Problem: Programs such as 'ifconfig' or 'route' cannot be found or the error message 'Operation not permitted' is displayed. Reason: You are not logged in as user 'root'. Solution: Logout and login as 'root' or change to 'root' via 'su'. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/skfp.txt b/Documentation/networking/skfp.txt index 3a419ed..abfddf8 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/skfp.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/skfp.txt @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ Makes my life much easier :-) If you run into problems during installation, check those items: -Problem: The FDDI adapter can not be found by the driver. +Problem: The FDDI adapter cannot be found by the driver. Reason: Look in /proc/pci for the following entry: 'FDDI network controller: SysKonnect SK-FDDI-PCI ...' If this entry exists, then the FDDI adapter has been @@ -99,7 +99,7 @@ Reason: Look in /proc/pci for the following entry: Problem: You want to use your computer as a router between multiple IP subnetworks (using multiple adapters), but - you can not reach computers in other subnetworks. + you cannot reach computers in other subnetworks. Reason: Either the router's kernel is not configured for IP forwarding or there is a problem with the routing table and gateway configuration in at least one of the diff --git a/Documentation/networking/slicecom.txt b/Documentation/networking/slicecom.txt index 59cfd95..2f04c92 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/slicecom.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/slicecom.txt @@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ red: green: meaning: - - no frame-sync, no signal received, or signal SNAFU. - on "Everything is OK" -on on Recepion is ok, but the remote end sends Remote Alarm +on on Reception is ok, but the remote end sends Remote Alarm on - The interface is unconfigured ----------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -257,12 +257,12 @@ which begin with '//' are the comments. // No alarms - Everything OK // // LOS - Loss Of Signal - No signal sensed on the input -// AIS - Alarm Indication Signal - The remot side sends '11111111'-s, +// AIS - Alarm Indication Signal - The remote side sends '11111111'-s, // it tells, that there's an error condition, or it's not // initialised. // AUXP - Auxiliary Pattern Indication - 01010101.. received. // LFA - Loss of Frame Alignment - no frame sync received. -// RRA - Receive Remote Alarm - the remote end's OK, but singnals error cond. +// RRA - Receive Remote Alarm - the remote end's OK, but signals error cond. // LMFA - Loss of CRC4 Multiframe Alignment - no CRC4 multiframe sync. // NMF - No Multiframe alignment Found after 400 msec - no such alarm using // no-crc4 or crc4 framing, see below. @@ -364,6 +364,6 @@ Treat them very carefully, these can cause much trouble! # echo >lbireg 0x1d 0x21 - - Swithing the loop off: + - Switching the loop off: # echo >lbireg 0x1d 0x00 diff --git a/Documentation/networking/smctr.txt b/Documentation/networking/smctr.txt index 4c866f5..9af25b8 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/smctr.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/smctr.txt @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ This driver is rather simple to use. Select Y to Token Ring adapter support in the kernel configuration. A choice for SMC Token Ring adapters will appear. This drives supports all SMC ISA/MCA adapters. Choose this option. I personally recommend compiling the driver as a module (M), but if you -you would like to compile it staticly answer Y instead. +you would like to compile it statically answer Y instead. This driver supports multiple adapters without the need to load multiple copies of the driver. You should be able to load up to 7 adapters without any kernel diff --git a/Documentation/networking/tcp.txt b/Documentation/networking/tcp.txt index 0fa3004..0121edc 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/tcp.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/tcp.txt @@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ if needed and you will get the expected protocol. If you ask for an unknown congestion method, then the sysctl attempt will fail. If you remove a tcp congestion control module, then you will get the next -available one. Since reno can not be built as a module, and can not be +available one. Since reno cannot be built as a module, and cannot be deleted, it will always be available. How the new TCP output machine [nyi] works. diff --git a/Documentation/networking/tms380tr.txt b/Documentation/networking/tms380tr.txt index 179e527..c169a57 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/tms380tr.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/tms380tr.txt @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ This driver is rather simple to use. Select Y to Token Ring adapter support in the kernel configuration. A choice for SysKonnect Token Ring adapters will appear. This drives supports all SysKonnect ISA and PCI adapters. Choose this option. I personally recommend compiling the driver as a module (M), but if you -you would like to compile it staticly answer Y instead. +you would like to compile it statically answer Y instead. This driver supports multiple adapters without the need to load multiple copies of the driver. You should be able to load up to 7 adapters without any kernel diff --git a/Documentation/networking/vortex.txt b/Documentation/networking/vortex.txt index 6091e5f..6356d3f 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/vortex.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/vortex.txt @@ -359,13 +359,13 @@ steps you should take: Eliminate some variables: try different cards, different computers, different cables, different ports on the switch/hub, - different versions of the kernel or ofthe driver, etc. + different versions of the kernel or of the driver, etc. - OK, it's a driver problem. You need to generate a report. Typically this is an email to the maintainer and/or linux-net@vger.kernel.org. The maintainer's - email address will be inthe driver source or in the MAINTAINERS file. + email address will be in the driver source or in the MAINTAINERS file. - The contents of your report will vary a lot depending upon the problem. If it's a kernel crash then you should refer to the diff --git a/Documentation/networking/wan-router.txt b/Documentation/networking/wan-router.txt index c96897a..0cf6541 100644 --- a/Documentation/networking/wan-router.txt +++ b/Documentation/networking/wan-router.txt @@ -148,7 +148,7 @@ NEW IN THIS RELEASE for async connections. o Added the PPPCONFIG utility - Used to configure the PPPD dameon for the + Used to configure the PPPD daemon for the WANPIPE Async PPP and standard serial port. The wancfg calls the pppconfig to configure the pppd. @@ -214,7 +214,7 @@ PRODUCT COMPONENTS AND RELATED FILES /usr/local/wanrouter/patches/kdrivers: Sources of the latest WANPIPE device drivers. These are used to UPGRADE the linux kernel to the newest - version if the kernel source has already been pathced with + version if the kernel source has already been patched with WANPIPE drivers. /usr/local/wanrouter/samples: @@ -350,7 +350,7 @@ REVISION HISTORY Available as a patch. 2.0.6 Aug 17, 1999 Increased debugging in statup scripts - Fixed insallation bugs from 2.0.5 + Fixed installation bugs from 2.0.5 Kernel patch works for both 2.2.10 and 2.2.11 kernels. There is no functional difference between the two packages @@ -434,11 +434,11 @@ beta3-2.1.4 Jul 2000 o X25 M_BIT Problem fix. change. beta1-2.1.5 Nov 15 2000 - o Fixed the MulitPort PPP Support for kernels 2.2.16 and above. + o Fixed the MultiPort PPP Support for kernels 2.2.16 and above. 2.2.X kernels only o Secured the driver UDP debugging calls - - All illegal netowrk debugging calls are reported to + - All illegal network debugging calls are reported to the log. - Defined a set of allowed commands, all other denied. @@ -451,7 +451,7 @@ beta1-2.1.5 Nov 15 2000 o Keyboard Led Monitor/Debugger - A new utilty /usr/sbin/wpkbdmon uses keyboard leds - to convey operatinal statistic information of the + to convey operational statistic information of the Sangoma WANPIPE cards. NUM_LOCK = Line State (On=connected, Off=disconnected) CAPS_LOCK = Tx data (On=transmitting, Off=no tx data) @@ -470,7 +470,7 @@ beta1-2.1.5 Nov 15 2000 o Fixed the Frame Relay and Chdlc network interfaces so they are compatible with libpcap libraries. Meaning, tcpdump, snort, ethereal, and all other packet sniffers and debuggers work on - all WANPIPE netowrk interfaces. + all WANPIPE network interfaces. - Set the network interface encoding type to ARPHRD_PPP. This tell the sniffers that data obtained from the network interface is in pure IP format. @@ -570,7 +570,7 @@ bata1-2.2.1 Feb 09 2001 Option to COMPILE WANPIPE modules against the currently running kernel, thus no need for manual kernel and module - re-compilatin. + re-compilation. o Updates and Bug Fixes to wancfg utility. diff --git a/Documentation/nfsroot.txt b/Documentation/nfsroot.txt index 3cc953c..719f9a9 100644 --- a/Documentation/nfsroot.txt +++ b/Documentation/nfsroot.txt @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ Updated 2006 by Horms <horms@verge.net.au> In order to use a diskless system, such as an X-terminal or printer server for example, it is necessary for the root filesystem to be present on a non-disk device. This may be an initramfs (see Documentation/filesystems/ -ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt), a ramdisk (see Documenation/initrd.txt) or a +ramfs-rootfs-initramfs.txt), a ramdisk (see Documentation/initrd.txt) or a filesystem mounted via NFS. The following text describes on how to use NFS for the root filesystem. For the rest of this text 'client' means the diskless system, and 'server' means the NFS server. diff --git a/Documentation/pci-error-recovery.txt b/Documentation/pci-error-recovery.txt index 634d3e5..6650af4 100644 --- a/Documentation/pci-error-recovery.txt +++ b/Documentation/pci-error-recovery.txt @@ -172,7 +172,7 @@ is STEP 6 (Permanent Failure). >>> a value of 0xff on read, and writes will be dropped. If the device >>> driver attempts more than 10K I/O's to a frozen adapter, it will >>> assume that the device driver has gone into an infinite loop, and ->>> it will panic the the kernel. There doesn't seem to be any other +>>> it will panic the kernel. There doesn't seem to be any other >>> way of stopping a device driver that insists on spinning on I/O. STEP 2: MMIO Enabled diff --git a/Documentation/pi-futex.txt b/Documentation/pi-futex.txt index 5d61dac..9a5bc86 100644 --- a/Documentation/pi-futex.txt +++ b/Documentation/pi-futex.txt @@ -118,4 +118,4 @@ properties of futexes, and all four combinations are possible: futex, robust-futex, PI-futex, robust+PI-futex. More details about priority inheritance can be found in -Documentation/rtmutex.txt. +Documentation/rt-mutex.txt. diff --git a/Documentation/pm.txt b/Documentation/pm.txt index 79c0f32..da8589a 100644 --- a/Documentation/pm.txt +++ b/Documentation/pm.txt @@ -18,10 +18,10 @@ enabled by default). If a working ACPI implementation is found, the ACPI driver will override and disable APM, otherwise the APM driver will be used. -No sorry, you can not have both ACPI and APM enabled and running at +No, sorry, you cannot have both ACPI and APM enabled and running at once. Some people with broken ACPI or broken APM implementations would like to use both to get a full set of working features, but you -simply can not mix and match the two. Only one power management +simply cannot mix and match the two. Only one power management interface can be in control of the machine at once. Think about it.. User-space Daemons @@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ void pm_unregister_all(pm_callback cback); * * Returns: 0 if the request is successful * EINVAL if the request is not supported - * EBUSY if the device is now busy and can not handle the request + * EBUSY if the device is now busy and cannot handle the request * ENOMEM if the device was unable to handle the request due to memory * * Details: The device request callback will be called before the diff --git a/Documentation/pnp.txt b/Documentation/pnp.txt index 9529c9c..9ff966b 100644 --- a/Documentation/pnp.txt +++ b/Documentation/pnp.txt @@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ static struct pnp_driver serial_pnp_driver = { .remove = serial_pnp_remove, }; -* name and id_table can not be NULL. +* name and id_table cannot be NULL. 4.) register the driver ex: diff --git a/Documentation/power/pci.txt b/Documentation/power/pci.txt index 73fc87e..24edf25 100644 --- a/Documentation/power/pci.txt +++ b/Documentation/power/pci.txt @@ -326,7 +326,7 @@ A reference implementation This is a typical implementation. Drivers can slightly change the order of the operations in the implementation, ignore some operations or add -more deriver specific operations in it, but drivers should do something like +more driver specific operations in it, but drivers should do something like this on the whole. 5. Resources diff --git a/Documentation/power/swsusp.txt b/Documentation/power/swsusp.txt index 823b2cf..9ea2208 100644 --- a/Documentation/power/swsusp.txt +++ b/Documentation/power/swsusp.txt @@ -156,7 +156,7 @@ instead set the PF_NOFREEZE process flag when creating the thread (and be very carefull). -Q: What is the difference between between "platform", "shutdown" and +Q: What is the difference between "platform", "shutdown" and "firmware" in /sys/power/disk? A: @@ -175,8 +175,8 @@ reliable. Q: I do not understand why you have such strong objections to idea of selective suspend. -A: Do selective suspend during runtime power managment, that's okay. But -its useless for suspend-to-disk. (And I do not see how you could use +A: Do selective suspend during runtime power management, that's okay. But +it's useless for suspend-to-disk. (And I do not see how you could use it for suspend-to-ram, I hope you do not want that). Lets see, so you suggest to @@ -211,7 +211,7 @@ slowness may not matter to you. It can always be fixed later. For devices like disk it does matter, you do not want to spindown for FREEZE. -Q: After resuming, system is paging heavilly, leading to very bad interactivity. +Q: After resuming, system is paging heavily, leading to very bad interactivity. A: Try running diff --git a/Documentation/power/tricks.txt b/Documentation/power/tricks.txt index c6d58d3..3b26bb5 100644 --- a/Documentation/power/tricks.txt +++ b/Documentation/power/tricks.txt @@ -9,7 +9,7 @@ If you want to trick swsusp/S3 into working, you might want to try: * turn off APIC and preempt -* use ext2. At least it has working fsck. [If something seemes to go +* use ext2. At least it has working fsck. [If something seems to go wrong, force fsck when you have a chance] * turn off modules diff --git a/Documentation/power/userland-swsusp.txt b/Documentation/power/userland-swsusp.txt index 9405822..64755e9 100644 --- a/Documentation/power/userland-swsusp.txt +++ b/Documentation/power/userland-swsusp.txt @@ -91,7 +91,7 @@ unfreeze user space processes frozen by SNAPSHOT_UNFREEZE if they are still frozen when the device is being closed). Currently it is assumed that the userland utilities reading/writing the -snapshot image from/to the kernel will use a swap parition, called the resume +snapshot image from/to the kernel will use a swap partition, called the resume partition, as storage space. However, this is not really required, as they can use, for example, a special (blank) suspend partition or a file on a partition that is unmounted before SNAPSHOT_ATOMIC_SNAPSHOT and mounted afterwards. diff --git a/Documentation/power/video.txt b/Documentation/power/video.txt index d859faa..2b35849 100644 --- a/Documentation/power/video.txt +++ b/Documentation/power/video.txt @@ -16,7 +16,7 @@ problem for S1 standby, because hardware should retain its state over that. We either have to run video BIOS during early resume, or interpret it -using vbetool later, or maybe nothing is neccessary on particular +using vbetool later, or maybe nothing is necessary on particular system because video state is preserved. Unfortunately different methods work on different systems, and no known method suits all of them. diff --git a/Documentation/powerpc/booting-without-of.txt b/Documentation/powerpc/booting-without-of.txt index 5c0ba23..1ccc8a5 100644 --- a/Documentation/powerpc/booting-without-of.txt +++ b/Documentation/powerpc/booting-without-of.txt @@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ it with special cases. in case you are entering the kernel with MMU enabled and a non-1:1 mapping. - r5 : NULL (as to differenciate with method a) + r5 : NULL (as to differentiate with method a) Note about SMP entry: Either your firmware puts your other CPUs in some sleep loop or spin loop in ROM where you can get @@ -245,7 +245,7 @@ the block to RAM before passing it to the kernel. --------- The kernel is entered with r3 pointing to an area of memory that is - roughtly described in include/asm-powerpc/prom.h by the structure + roughly described in include/asm-powerpc/prom.h by the structure boot_param_header: struct boot_param_header { @@ -335,7 +335,7 @@ struct boot_param_header { "compact" format for the tree itself that is however not backward compatible. You should always generate a structure of the highest version defined at the time of your implementation. Currently - that is version 16, unless you explicitely aim at being backward + that is version 16, unless you explicitly aim at being backward compatible. - last_comp_version @@ -418,9 +418,9 @@ zero terminated string and is mandatory for version 1 to 3 of the format definition (as it is in Open Firmware). Version 0x10 makes it optional as it can generate it from the unit name defined below. -There is also a "unit name" that is used to differenciate nodes with +There is also a "unit name" that is used to differentiate nodes with the same name at the same level, it is usually made of the node -name's, the "@" sign, and a "unit address", which definition is +names, the "@" sign, and a "unit address", which definition is specific to the bus type the node sits on. The unit name doesn't exist as a property per-se but is included in @@ -550,11 +550,11 @@ Here's the basic structure of a single node: * [child nodes if any] * token OF_DT_END_NODE (that is 0x00000002) -So the node content can be summmarised as a start token, a full path, -a list of properties, a list of child node and an end token. Every +So the node content can be summarised as a start token, a full path, +a list of properties, a list of child nodes, and an end token. Every child node is a full node structure itself as defined above. -4) Device tree 'strings" block +4) Device tree "strings" block In order to save space, property names, which are generally redundant, are stored separately in the "strings" block. This block is simply the @@ -573,7 +573,7 @@ implementation of Open Firmware or an implementation compatible with the Open Firmware client interface, those properties will be created by the trampoline code in the kernel's prom_init() file. For example, that's where you'll have to add code to detect your board model and -set the platform number. However, when using the flatenned device-tree +set the platform number. However, when using the flattened device-tree entry point, there is no prom_init() pass, and thus you have to provide those properties yourself. @@ -630,12 +630,11 @@ like address space bits, you'll have to add a bus translator to the prom_parse.c file of the recent kernels for your bus type. The "reg" property only defines addresses and sizes (if #size-cells -is -non-0) within a given bus. In order to translate addresses upward +is non-0) within a given bus. In order to translate addresses upward (that is into parent bus addresses, and possibly into cpu physical addresses), all busses must contain a "ranges" property. If the "ranges" property is missing at a given level, it's assumed that -translation isn't possible. The format of the "ranges" proprety for a +translation isn't possible. The format of the "ranges" property for a bus is a list of: bus address, parent bus address, size @@ -689,7 +688,7 @@ is present). 4) Note about node and property names and character set ------------------------------------------------------- -While open firmware provides more flexibe usage of 8859-1, this +While open firmware provides more flexible usage of 8859-1, this specification enforces more strict rules. Nodes and properties should be comprised only of ASCII characters 'a' to 'z', '0' to '9', ',', '.', '_', '+', '#', '?', and '-'. Node names additionally @@ -732,12 +731,12 @@ address which can extend beyond that limit. that typically get driven by the same platform code in the kernel, you would use a different "model" property but put a value in "compatible". The kernel doesn't directly use that - value (see /chosen/linux,platform for how the kernel choses a + value (see /chosen/linux,platform for how the kernel chooses a platform type) but it is generally useful. The root node is also generally where you add additional properties specific to your board like the serial number if any, that sort of - thing. it is recommended that if you add any "custom" property whose + thing. It is recommended that if you add any "custom" property whose name may clash with standard defined ones, you prefix them with your vendor name and a comma. @@ -817,7 +816,7 @@ address which can extend beyond that limit. your board. It's a list of addresses/sizes concatenated together, with the number of cells of each defined by the #address-cells and #size-cells of the root node. For example, - with both of these properties beeing 2 like in the example given + with both of these properties being 2 like in the example given earlier, a 970 based machine with 6Gb of RAM could typically have a "reg" property here that looks like: @@ -970,7 +969,7 @@ device-tree in another format. The currently supported formats are: - "asm": assembly language file. This is a file that can be sourced by gas to generate a device-tree "blob". That file can then simply be added to your Makefile. Additionally, the - assembly file exports some symbols that can be use + assembly file exports some symbols that can be used. The syntax of the dtc tool is @@ -984,10 +983,10 @@ generated. Supported versions are 1,2,3 and 16. The default is currently version 3 but that may change in the future to version 16. Additionally, dtc performs various sanity checks on the tree, like the -uniqueness of linux,phandle properties, validity of strings, etc... +uniqueness of linux, phandle properties, validity of strings, etc... The format of the .dts "source" file is "C" like, supports C and C++ -style commments. +style comments. / { } @@ -1069,13 +1068,13 @@ while all this has been defined and implemented. around. It contains no internal offsets or pointers for this purpose. - - An example of code for iterating nodes & retreiving properties + - An example of code for iterating nodes & retrieving properties directly from the flattened tree format can be found in the kernel file arch/ppc64/kernel/prom.c, look at scan_flat_dt() function, - it's usage in early_init_devtree(), and the corresponding various + its usage in early_init_devtree(), and the corresponding various early_init_dt_scan_*() callbacks. That code can be re-used in a GPL bootloader, and as the author of that code, I would be happy - do discuss possible free licencing to any vendor who wishes to + to discuss possible free licencing to any vendor who wishes to integrate all or part of this code into a non-GPL bootloader. diff --git a/Documentation/powerpc/eeh-pci-error-recovery.txt b/Documentation/powerpc/eeh-pci-error-recovery.txt index 3764dd4..4530d1b 100644 --- a/Documentation/powerpc/eeh-pci-error-recovery.txt +++ b/Documentation/powerpc/eeh-pci-error-recovery.txt @@ -90,7 +90,7 @@ EEH-isolated, there is a firmware call it can make to determine if this is the case. If so, then the device driver should put itself into a consistent state (given that it won't be able to complete any pending work) and start recovery of the card. Recovery normally -would consist of reseting the PCI device (holding the PCI #RST +would consist of resetting the PCI device (holding the PCI #RST line high for two seconds), followed by setting up the device config space (the base address registers (BAR's), latency timer, cache line size, interrupt line, and so on). This is followed by a @@ -116,7 +116,7 @@ At this time, a generic EEH recovery mechanism has been implemented, so that individual device drivers do not need to be modified to support EEH recovery. This generic mechanism piggy-backs on the PCI hotplug infrastructure, and percolates events up through the userspace/udev -infrastructure. Followiing is a detailed description of how this is +infrastructure. Following is a detailed description of how this is accomplished. EEH must be enabled in the PHB's very early during the boot process, diff --git a/Documentation/powerpc/hvcs.txt b/Documentation/powerpc/hvcs.txt index 1e38166..f93462c 100644 --- a/Documentation/powerpc/hvcs.txt +++ b/Documentation/powerpc/hvcs.txt @@ -259,7 +259,7 @@ This index of '2' means that in order to connect to vty-server adapter It should be noted that due to the system hotplug I/O capabilities of a system the /dev/hvcs* entry that interacts with a particular vty-server -adapter is not guarenteed to remain the same across system reboots. Look +adapter is not guaranteed to remain the same across system reboots. Look in the Q & A section for more on this issue. --------------------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/Documentation/prio_tree.txt b/Documentation/prio_tree.txt index 2fbb0c4..3aa68f9 100644 --- a/Documentation/prio_tree.txt +++ b/Documentation/prio_tree.txt @@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ path which is not desirable. Hence, we do not optimize the height of the heap-and-size indexed overflow-sub-trees using prio_tree->index_bits. Instead the overflow sub-trees are indexed using full BITS_PER_LONG bits of size_index. This may lead to skewed sub-trees because most of the -higher significant bits of the size_index are likely to be be 0 (zero). In +higher significant bits of the size_index are likely to be 0 (zero). In the example above, all 3 overflow-sub-trees are skewed. This may marginally affect the performance. However, processes rarely map many vmas with the same start_vm_pgoff but different end_vm_pgoffs. Therefore, we normally diff --git a/Documentation/rocket.txt b/Documentation/rocket.txt index a106780..1d85829 100644 --- a/Documentation/rocket.txt +++ b/Documentation/rocket.txt @@ -97,7 +97,7 @@ a range of I/O addresses for it to use. The first RocketPort card requires a 68-byte contiguous block of I/O addresses, starting at one of the following: 0x100h, 0x140h, 0x180h, 0x200h, 0x240h, 0x280h, 0x300h, 0x340h, 0x380h. This I/O address must be reflected in the DIP -switiches of *all* of the Rocketport cards. +switches of *all* of the Rocketport cards. The second, third, and fourth RocketPort cards require a 64-byte contiguous block of I/O addresses, starting at one of the following @@ -107,7 +107,7 @@ second, third, and fourth Rocketport cards (if present) are set via software control. The DIP switch settings for the I/O address must be set to the value of the first Rocketport cards. -In order to destinguish each of the card from the others, each card +In order to distinguish each of the card from the others, each card must have a unique board ID set on the dip switches. The first Rocketport board must be set with the DIP switches corresponding to the first board, the second board must be set with the DIP switches @@ -120,7 +120,7 @@ conflict with any other cards in the system, including other RocketPort cards. Below, you will find a list of commonly used I/O address ranges which may be in use by other devices in your system. On a Linux system, "cat /proc/ioports" will also be helpful in -identifying what I/O addresses are being used by devics on your +identifying what I/O addresses are being used by devices on your system. Remember, the FIRST RocketPort uses 68 I/O addresses. So, if you set it diff --git a/Documentation/rpc-cache.txt b/Documentation/rpc-cache.txt index 5f757c8..8a382be 100644 --- a/Documentation/rpc-cache.txt +++ b/Documentation/rpc-cache.txt @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ The common code handles such things as: - general cache lookup with correct locking - supporting 'NEGATIVE' as well as positive entries - allowing an EXPIRED time on cache items, and removing - items after they expire, and are no longe in-use. + items after they expire, and are no longer in-use. - making requests to user-space to fill in cache entries - allowing user-space to directly set entries in the cache - delaying RPC requests that depend on as-yet incomplete @@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ Creating a Cache structure void cache_put(struct kref *) This is called when the last reference to an item is - is dropped. The pointer passed is to the 'ref' field + dropped. The pointer passed is to the 'ref' field in the cache_head. cache_put should release any references create by 'cache_init' and, if CACHE_VALID is set, any references created by cache_update. diff --git a/Documentation/s390/3270.txt b/Documentation/s390/3270.txt index 0a044e6..7a5c73a 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/3270.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/3270.txt @@ -111,9 +111,7 @@ Here are the installation steps in detail: config3270.sh. Inspect the output script it produces, /tmp/mkdev3270, and then run that script. This will create the necessary character special device files and make the necessary - changes to /etc/inittab. If you have selected DEVFS, the driver - itself creates the device files, and /tmp/mkdev3270 only changes - /etc/inittab. + changes to /etc/inittab. Then notify /sbin/init that /etc/inittab has changed, by issuing the telinit command with the q operand: diff --git a/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt b/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt index 844c03f..4dd25ee 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/Debugging390.txt @@ -8,8 +8,8 @@ Overview of Document: ===================== This document is intended to give an good overview of how to debug -Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture it isn't intended as a complete reference & not a -tutorial on the fundamentals of C & assembly, it dosen't go into +Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture. It isn't intended as a complete reference & not a +tutorial on the fundamentals of C & assembly. It doesn't go into 390 IO in any detail. It is intended to complement the documents in the reference section below & any other worthwhile references you get. @@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ s/390 z/Architecture 0 0 Reserved ( must be 0 ) otherwise specification exception occurs. 1 1 Program Event Recording 1 PER enabled, - PER is used to facilititate debugging e.g. single stepping. + PER is used to facilitate debugging e.g. single stepping. 2-4 2-4 Reserved ( must be 0 ). @@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ s/390 z/Architecture 1 1 64 bit 32 1=31 bit addressing mode 0=24 bit addressing mode (for backward - compatibility ), linux always runs with this bit set to 1 + compatibility), linux always runs with this bit set to 1 33-64 Instruction address. 33-63 Reserved must be 0 @@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ Bytes 0-512 ( 200 hex ) on s/390 & 0-512,4096-4544,4604-5119 currently on z/Arch are used by the processor itself for holding such information as exception indications & entry points for exceptions. Bytes after 0xc00 hex are used by linux for per processor globals on s/390 & z/Architecture -( there is a gap on z/Architecure too currently between 0xc00 & 1000 which linux uses ). +( there is a gap on z/Architecture too currently between 0xc00 & 1000 which linux uses ). The closest thing to this on traditional architectures is the interrupt vector table. This is a good thing & does simplify some of the kernel coding however it means that we now cannot catch stray NULL pointers in the @@ -239,7 +239,7 @@ they go to 64 Bit. On 390 our limitations & strengths make us slightly different. For backward compatibility we are only allowed use 31 bits (2GB) -of our 32 bit addresses,however, we use entirely separate address +of our 32 bit addresses, however, we use entirely separate address spaces for the user & kernel. This means we can support 2GB of non Extended RAM on s/390, & more @@ -317,9 +317,9 @@ Each process/thread under Linux for S390 has its own kernel task_struct defined in linux/include/linux/sched.h The S390 on initialisation & resuming of a process on a cpu sets the __LC_KERNEL_STACK variable in the spare prefix area for this cpu -( which we use for per processor globals). +(which we use for per-processor globals). -The kernel stack pointer is intimately tied with the task stucture for +The kernel stack pointer is intimately tied with the task structure for each processor as follows. s/390 @@ -354,7 +354,7 @@ static inline struct task_struct * get_current(void) } i.e. just anding the current kernel stack pointer with the mask -8192. -Thankfully because Linux dosen't have support for nested IO interrupts +Thankfully because Linux doesn't have support for nested IO interrupts & our devices have large buffers can survive interrupts being shut for short amounts of time we don't need a separate stack for interrupts. @@ -366,8 +366,8 @@ Register Usage & Stackframes on Linux for s/390 & z/Architecture Overview: --------- This is the code that gcc produces at the top & the bottom of -each function, it usually is fairly consistent & similar from -function to function & if you know its layout you can probalby +each function. It usually is fairly consistent & similar from +function to function & if you know its layout you can probably make some headway in finding the ultimate cause of a problem after a crash without a source level debugger. @@ -394,7 +394,7 @@ i.e they aren't in registers & they aren't static. back-chain: This is a pointer to the stack pointer before entering a framed functions ( see frameless function ) prologue got by -deferencing the address of the current stack pointer, +dereferencing the address of the current stack pointer, i.e. got by accessing the 32 bit value at the stack pointers current location. @@ -724,7 +724,7 @@ This is useful for debugging because 1) You can double check whether the files you expect to be included are the ones that are being included ( e.g. double check that you aren't going to the i386 asm directory ). 2) Check that macro definitions aren't clashing with typedefs, -3) Check that definitons aren't being used before they are being included. +3) Check that definitions aren't being used before they are being included. 4) Helps put the line emitting the error under the microscope if it contains macros. For convenience the Linux kernel's makefile will do preprocessing automatically for you @@ -840,12 +840,11 @@ using the strip command to make it a more reasonable size to boot it. A source/assembly mixed dump of the kernel can be done with the line objdump --source vmlinux > vmlinux.lst -Also if the file isn't compiled -g this will output as much debugging information -as it can ( e.g. function names ), however, this is very slow as it spends lots -of time searching for debugging info, the following self explanitory line should be used -instead if the code isn't compiled -g. +Also, if the file isn't compiled -g, this will output as much debugging information +as it can (e.g. function names). This is very slow as it spends lots +of time searching for debugging info. The following self explanatory line should be used +instead if the code isn't compiled -g, as it is much faster: objdump --disassemble-all --syms vmlinux > vmlinux.lst -as it is much faster As hard drive space is valuble most of us use the following approach. 1) Look at the emitted psw on the console to find the crash address in the kernel. @@ -861,7 +860,7 @@ Linux source tree. 6) rm /arch/s390/kernel/signal.o 7) make /arch/s390/kernel/signal.o 8) watch the gcc command line emitted -9) type it in again or alernatively cut & paste it on the console adding the -g option. +9) type it in again or alternatively cut & paste it on the console adding the -g option. 10) objdump --source arch/s390/kernel/signal.o > signal.lst This will output the source & the assembly intermixed, as the snippet below shows This will unfortunately output addresses which aren't the same @@ -913,8 +912,8 @@ If you wanted to know does ping work but didn't have the source strace ping -c 1 127.0.0.1 & then look at the man pages for each of the syscalls below, ( In fact this is sometimes easier than looking at some spagetti -source which conditionally compiles for several architectures ) -Not everything that it throws out needs to make sense immeadiately +source which conditionally compiles for several architectures ). +Not everything that it throws out needs to make sense immediately. Just looking quickly you can see that it is making up a RAW socket for the ICMP protocol. @@ -974,8 +973,9 @@ through the pipe for each line containing the string open. Example 3 --------- -Getting sophistocated -telnetd crashes on & I don't know why +Getting sophisticated +telnetd crashes & I don't know why + Steps ----- 1) Replace the following line in /etc/inetd.conf @@ -1085,8 +1085,7 @@ Notes ----- Addresses & values in the VM debugger are always hex never decimal Address ranges are of the format <HexValue1>-<HexValue2> or <HexValue1>.<HexValue2> -e.g. The address range 0x2000 to 0x3000 can be described described as -2000-3000 or 2000.1000 +e.g. The address range 0x2000 to 0x3000 can be described as 2000-3000 or 2000.1000 The VM Debugger is case insensitive. @@ -1311,7 +1310,7 @@ for finding out when a particular variable changes. An alternative way of finding the STD of a currently running process is to do the following, ( this method is more complex but -could be quite convient if you aren't updating the kernel much & +could be quite convenient if you aren't updating the kernel much & so your kernel structures will stay constant for a reasonable period of time ). @@ -1413,7 +1412,7 @@ SMP Specific commands To find out how many cpus you have Q CPUS displays all the CPU's available to your virtual machine To find the cpu that the current cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at do -Q CPU to change the current cpu cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at do +Q CPU to change the current cpu VM debugger commands are being directed at do CPU <desired cpu no> On a SMP guest issue a command to all CPUs try prefixing the command with cpu all. @@ -1674,8 +1673,8 @@ channel is idle & the second for device end ( secondary status ) sometimes you g concurrently, you check how the IO went on by issuing a TEST SUBCHANNEL at each interrupt, from which you receive an Interruption response block (IRB). If you get channel & device end status in the IRB without channel checks etc. your IO probably went okay. If you didn't you -probably need a doctorto examine the IRB & extended status word etc. -If an error occurs more sophistocated control units have a facitity known as +probably need a doctor to examine the IRB & extended status word etc. +If an error occurs, more sophistocated control units have a facitity known as concurrent sense this means that if an error occurs Extended sense information will be presented in the Extended status word in the IRB if not you have to issue a subsequent SENSE CCW command after the test subchannel. @@ -1704,7 +1703,7 @@ concentrate on data processing. IOP's can use one or more links ( known as channel paths ) to talk to each IO device. It first checks for path availability & chooses an available one, then starts ( & sometimes terminates IO ). -There are two types of channel path ESCON & the Paralell IO interface. +There are two types of channel path: ESCON & the Parallel IO interface. IO devices are attached to control units, control units provide the logic to interface the channel paths & channel path IO protocols to @@ -1743,11 +1742,11 @@ controllers or a control unit which connects to 1000 3270 terminals ). The 390 IO systems come in 2 flavours the current 390 machines support both -The Older 360 & 370 Interface,sometimes called the paralell I/O interface, +The Older 360 & 370 Interface,sometimes called the Parallel I/O interface, sometimes called Bus-and Tag & sometimes Original Equipment Manufacturers Interface (OEMI). -This byte wide paralell channel path/bus has parity & data on the "Bus" cable +This byte wide Parallel channel path/bus has parity & data on the "Bus" cable & control lines on the "Tag" cable. These can operate in byte multiplex mode for sharing between several slow devices or burst mode & monopolize the channel for the whole burst. Upto 256 devices can be addressed on one of these cables. These cables are @@ -1777,7 +1776,7 @@ Consoles 3270 & 3215 ( a teletype emulated under linux for a line mode console ) DASD's direct access storage devices ( otherwise known as hard disks ). Tape Drives. CTC ( Channel to Channel Adapters ), -ESCON or Paralell Cables used as a very high speed serial link +ESCON or Parallel Cables used as a very high speed serial link between 2 machines. We use 2 cables under linux to do a bi-directional serial link. @@ -1803,8 +1802,8 @@ OSA 7C09 ON OSA 7C09 SUBCHANNEL = 0001 OSA 7C14 ON OSA 7C14 SUBCHANNEL = 0002 OSA 7C15 ON OSA 7C15 SUBCHANNEL = 0003 -If you have a guest with certain priviliges you may be able to see devices -which don't belong to you to avoid this do add the option V. +If you have a guest with certain privileges you may be able to see devices +which don't belong to you. To avoid this, add the option V. e.g. Q V OSA @@ -1837,7 +1836,7 @@ RDRLIST RECEIVE / LOG TXT A1 ( replace 8) filel & press F11 to look at it -You should see someting like. +You should see something like: 00020942' SSCH B2334000 0048813C CC 0 SCH 0000 DEV 7C08 CPA 000FFDF0 PARM 00E2C9C4 KEY 0 FPI C0 LPM 80 @@ -1916,7 +1915,7 @@ Assembly -------- info registers: displays registers other than floating point. info all-registers: displays floating points as well. -disassemble: dissassembles +disassemble: disassembles e.g. disassemble without parameters will disassemble the current function disassemble $pc $pc+10 @@ -1935,7 +1934,7 @@ undisplay : undo's display's info breakpoints: shows all current breakpoints -info stack: shows stack back trace ( if this dosent work too well, I'll show you the +info stack: shows stack back trace ( if this doesn't work too well, I'll show you the stacktrace by hand below ). info locals: displays local variables. @@ -2045,13 +2044,13 @@ what gdb does when the victim receives certain signals. list: e.g. list lists current function source -list 1,10 list first 10 lines of curret file. +list 1,10 list first 10 lines of current file. list test.c:1,10 directory: Adds directories to be searched for source if gdb cannot find the source. -(note it is a bit sensititive about slashes ) +(note it is a bit sensititive about slashes) e.g. To add the root of the filesystem to the searchpath do directory // @@ -2123,9 +2122,9 @@ p/x (*(**$sp+56))&0x7fffffff Disassembling instructions without debug info --------------------------------------------- -gdb typically compains if there is a lack of debugging -symbols in the disassemble command with -"No function contains specified address." to get around +gdb typically complains if there is a lack of debugging +symbols in the disassemble command with +"No function contains specified address." To get around this do x/<number lines to disassemble>xi <address> e.g. @@ -2184,7 +2183,7 @@ ps -aux | grep gdb kill -SIGSEGV <gdb's pid> or alternatively use killall -SIGSEGV gdb if you have the killall command. Now look at the core dump. -./gdb ./gdb core +./gdb core Displays the following GNU gdb 4.18 Copyright 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @@ -2316,7 +2315,7 @@ Showing us the shared libraries init uses where they are in memory /proc/1/mem is the current running processes memory which you can read & write to like a file. strace uses this sometimes as it is a bit faster than the -rather inefficent ptrace interface for peeking at DATA. +rather inefficient ptrace interface for peeking at DATA. cat status @@ -2446,7 +2445,7 @@ displays the following lines as it executes them. + RELSTATUS=release + MACHTYPE=i586-pc-linux-gnu -perl -d <scriptname> runs the perlscript in a fully intercative debugger +perl -d <scriptname> runs the perlscript in a fully interactive debugger <like gdb>. Type 'h' in the debugger for help. @@ -2477,7 +2476,7 @@ Lcrash is a perfectly normal program,however, it requires 2 additional files, Kerntypes which is built using a patch to the linux kernel sources in the linux root directory & the System.map. -Kerntypes is an an objectfile whose sole purpose in life +Kerntypes is an objectfile whose sole purpose in life is to provide stabs debug info to lcrash, to do this Kerntypes is built from kerntypes.c which just includes the most commonly referenced header files used when debugging, lcrash can then read the diff --git a/Documentation/s390/cds.txt b/Documentation/s390/cds.txt index f0be389..d80e573 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/cds.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/cds.txt @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ determine the device driver owning the device that raised the interrupt. In order not to introduce a new I/O concept to the common Linux code, Linux/390 preserves the IRQ concept and semantically maps the ESA/390 subchannels to Linux as IRQs. This allows Linux/390 to support up to 64k -different IRQs, uniquely representig a single device each. +different IRQs, uniquely representing a single device each. Up to kernel 2.4, Linux/390 used to provide interfaces via the IRQ (subchannel). For internal use of the common I/O layer, these are still there. However, @@ -143,7 +143,7 @@ During its startup the Linux/390 system checks for peripheral devices. Each of those devices is uniquely defined by a so called subchannel by the ESA/390 channel subsystem. While the subchannel numbers are system generated, each subchannel also takes a user defined attribute, the so called device number. -Both subchannel number and device number can not exceed 65535. During driverfs +Both subchannel number and device number cannot exceed 65535. During driverfs initialisation, the information about control unit type and device types that imply specific I/O commands (channel command words - CCWs) in order to operate the device are gathered. Device drivers can retrieve this set of hardware @@ -177,11 +177,11 @@ This routine returns the characteristics for the device specified. The function is meant to be called with an irq handler in place; that is, at earliest during set_online() processing. -While the request is procesed synchronously, the device interrupt +While the request is processed synchronously, the device interrupt handler is called for final ending status. In case of error situations the interrupt handler may recover appropriately. The device irq handler can recognize the corresponding interrupts by the interruption parameter be -0x00524443.The ccw_device must not be locked prior to calling read_dev_chars(). +0x00524443. The ccw_device must not be locked prior to calling read_dev_chars(). The function may be called enabled or disabled. @@ -325,7 +325,7 @@ with the following CCW flags values defined : CCW_FLAG_DC - data chaining CCW_FLAG_CC - command chaining -CCW_FLAG_SLI - suppress incorrct length +CCW_FLAG_SLI - suppress incorrect length CCW_FLAG_SKIP - skip CCW_FLAG_PCI - PCI CCW_FLAG_IDA - indirect addressing @@ -348,7 +348,7 @@ The ccw_device_start() function returns : not online. When the I/O request completes, the CDS first level interrupt handler will -accumalate the status in a struct irb and then call the device interrupt handler. +accumulate the status in a struct irb and then call the device interrupt handler. The intparm field will contain the value the device driver has associated with a particular I/O request. If a pending device status was recognized, intparm will be set to 0 (zero). This may happen during I/O initiation or delayed @@ -433,7 +433,7 @@ puts the CPU into I/O disabled state by preserving the current PSW flags. The device driver is allowed to issue the next ccw_device_start() call from within its interrupt handler already. It is not required to schedule a -bottom-half, unless an non deterministicly long running error recovery procedure +bottom-half, unless an non deterministically long running error recovery procedure or similar needs to be scheduled. During I/O processing the Linux/390 generic I/O device driver support has already obtained the IRQ lock, i.e. the handler must not try to obtain it again when calling ccw_device_start() or we end in a diff --git a/Documentation/s390/crypto/crypto-API.txt b/Documentation/s390/crypto/crypto-API.txt index 78a7762..29dee79 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/crypto/crypto-API.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/crypto/crypto-API.txt @@ -61,9 +61,9 @@ Example: z990 crypto instruction for SHA1 algorithm is available -> when the sha1 algorithm is requested through the crypto API (which has a module autoloader) the z990 module will be loaded. -TBD: a userspace module probin mechanism +TBD: a userspace module probing mechanism something like 'probe sha1 sha1_z990 sha1' in modprobe.conf - -> try module sha1_z990, if it fails to load load standard module sha1 + -> try module sha1_z990, if it fails to load standard module sha1 the 'probe' statement is currently not supported in modprobe.conf diff --git a/Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt b/Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt index efb674e..62c0823 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/driver-model.txt @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ notify: This function is called by the common I/O layer for some state changes * In online state, device detached (CIO_GONE) or last path gone (CIO_NO_PATH). The driver must return !0 to keep the device; for return code 0, the device will be deleted as usual (also when no - notify function is registerd). If the driver wants to keep the + notify function is registered). If the driver wants to keep the device, it is moved into disconnected state. * In disconnected state, device operational again (CIO_OPER). The common I/O layer performs some sanity checks on device number and @@ -262,7 +262,7 @@ attribute 'online' which can be 0 or 1. ----------- The netiucv driver creates an attribute 'connection' under -bus/iucv/drivers/netiucv. Piping to this attibute creates a new netiucv +bus/iucv/drivers/netiucv. Piping to this attribute creates a new netiucv connection to the specified host. Netiucv connections show up under devices/iucv/ as "netiucv<ifnum>". The interface diff --git a/Documentation/s390/monreader.txt b/Documentation/s390/monreader.txt index d843bb0..beeaa4b 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/monreader.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/monreader.txt @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ This loads the module and sets the DCSS name to "MYDCSS". NOTE: ----- -This API provides no interface to control the *MONITOR service, e.g. specifiy +This API provides no interface to control the *MONITOR service, e.g. specify which data should be collected. This can be done by the CP command MONITOR (Class E privileged), see "CP Command and Utility Reference". diff --git a/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt b/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt index e321a8e..000230c 100644 --- a/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt +++ b/Documentation/s390/s390dbf.txt @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ where log records can be stored efficiently in memory, where each component (e.g. device drivers) can have one separate debug log. One purpose of this is to inspect the debug logs after a production system crash in order to analyze the reason for the crash. -If the system still runs but only a subcomponent which uses dbf failes, +If the system still runs but only a subcomponent which uses dbf fails, it is possible to look at the debug logs on a live system via the Linux debugfs filesystem. The debug feature may also very useful for kernel and driver development. @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ Predefined views for hex/ascii, sprintf and raw binary data are provided. It is also possible to define other views. The content of a view can be inspected simply by reading the corresponding debugfs file. -All debug logs have an an actual debug level (range from 0 to 6). +All debug logs have an actual debug level (range from 0 to 6). The default level is 3. Event and Exception functions have a 'level' parameter. Only debug entries with a level that is lower or equal than the actual level are written to the log. This means, when @@ -83,8 +83,8 @@ Example: It is also possible to deactivate the debug feature globally for every debug log. You can change the behavior using 2 sysctl parameters in /proc/sys/s390dbf: -There are currently 2 possible triggers, which stop the debug feature -globally. The first possbility is to use the "debug_active" sysctl. If +There are currently 2 possible triggers, which stop the debug feature +globally. The first possibility is to use the "debug_active" sysctl. If set to 1 the debug feature is running. If "debug_active" is set to 0 the debug feature is turned off. The second trigger which stops the debug feature is an kernel oops. @@ -468,7 +468,7 @@ The hex_ascii view shows the data field in hex and ascii representation The raw view returns a bytestream as the debug areas are stored in memory. The sprintf view formats the debug entries in the same way as the sprintf -function would do. The sprintf event/expection functions write to the +function would do. The sprintf event/exception functions write to the debug entry a pointer to the format string (size = sizeof(long)) and for each vararg a long value. So e.g. for a debug entry with a format string plus two varargs one would need to allocate a (3 * sizeof(long)) @@ -556,7 +556,7 @@ The input_proc can be used to implement functionality when it is written to the view (e.g. like with 'echo "0" > /sys/kernel/debug/s390dbf/dasd/level). For header_proc there can be used the default function -debug_dflt_header_fn() which is defined in in debug.h. +debug_dflt_header_fn() which is defined in debug.h. and which produces the same header output as the predefined views. E.g: 00 00964419409:440761 2 - 00 88023ec diff --git a/Documentation/sched-coding.txt b/Documentation/sched-coding.txt index 2b75ef67..cbd8db7 100644 --- a/Documentation/sched-coding.txt +++ b/Documentation/sched-coding.txt @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ Main Scheduling Methods void load_balance(runqueue_t *this_rq, int idle) Attempts to pull tasks from one cpu to another to balance cpu usage, if needed. This method is called explicitly if the runqueues are - inbalanced or periodically by the timer tick. Prior to calling, + imbalanced or periodically by the timer tick. Prior to calling, the current runqueue must be locked and interrupts disabled. void schedule() diff --git a/Documentation/sched-design.txt b/Documentation/sched-design.txt index 9d04e7b..1605bf0 100644 --- a/Documentation/sched-design.txt +++ b/Documentation/sched-design.txt @@ -93,9 +93,9 @@ and the goal is also to add a few new things: Design ====== -the core of the new scheduler are the following mechanizms: +The core of the new scheduler contains the following mechanisms: - - *two*, priority-ordered 'priority arrays' per CPU. There is an 'active' + - *two* priority-ordered 'priority arrays' per CPU. There is an 'active' array and an 'expired' array. The active array contains all tasks that are affine to this CPU and have timeslices left. The expired array contains all tasks which have used up their timeslices - but this array diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997 b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997 index dc88ee2..6faad7e 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997 +++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997 @@ -1214,7 +1214,7 @@ Thu Jul 21 10:37:39 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22) * sr.c(sr_open): Do not allow opens with write access. -Mon Jul 18 09:51:22 1994 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22) +Mon Jul 18 09:51:22 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22) * Linux 1.1.31 released. diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt b/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt index 041780f..3229b64 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ SCSI device: I-O data CDPS-PX24 (CD-ROM drive) You can also use "cardctl" program (this program is in pcmcia-cs source code) to get more info. -# cat /var/log/messgaes +# cat /var/log/messages ... Jan 2 03:45:06 lindberg cardmgr[78]: unsupported card in socket 1 Jan 2 03:45:06 lindberg cardmgr[78]: product info: "WBT", "NinjaSCSI-3", "R1.0" @@ -36,18 +36,18 @@ Socket 1: product info: "IO DATA", "CBSC16 ", "1" -[2] Get Linux kernel source, and extract it to /usr/src. - Because NinjaSCSI driver requiers some SCSI header files in Linux kernel - source. - I recomend rebuilding your kernel. This eliminate some versioning problem. +[2] Get the Linux kernel source, and extract it to /usr/src. + Because the NinjaSCSI driver requires some SCSI header files in Linux + kernel source, I recommend rebuilding your kernel; this eliminates + some versioning problems. $ cd /usr/src $ tar -zxvf linux-x.x.x.tar.gz $ cd linux $ make config ... -[3] If you use this driver with Kernel 2.2, Unpack pcmcia-cs in some directory - and make & install. This driver requies pcmcia-cs header file. +[3] If you use this driver with Kernel 2.2, unpack pcmcia-cs in some directory + and make & install. This driver requires the pcmcia-cs header file. $ cd /usr/src $ tar zxvf cs-pcmcia-cs-3.x.x.tar.gz ... @@ -59,10 +59,10 @@ $ emacs Makefile ... $ make -[5] Copy nsp_cs.o to suitable plase, like /lib/modules/<Kernel version>/pcmcia/ . +[5] Copy nsp_cs.ko to suitable place, like /lib/modules/<Kernel version>/pcmcia/ . [6] Add these lines to /etc/pcmcia/config . - If you yse pcmcia-cs-3.1.8 or later, we can use "nsp_cs.conf" file. + If you use pcmcia-cs-3.1.8 or later, we can use "nsp_cs.conf" file. So, you don't need to edit file. Just copy to /etc/pcmcia/ . ------------------------------------- diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aacraid.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aacraid.txt index ee03678..3367130 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/aacraid.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/aacraid.txt @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ Introduction ------------------------- The aacraid driver adds support for Adaptec (http://www.adaptec.com) RAID controllers. This is a major rewrite from the original -Adaptec supplied driver. It has signficantly cleaned up both the code +Adaptec supplied driver. It has significantly cleaned up both the code and the running binary size (the module is less than half the size of the original). diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt index 382b439..904d49e 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ The following information is available in this file: an SDTR with an offset of 0 to be sure the target knows we are async. This works around a firmware defect in the Quantum Atlas 10K. - - Implement controller susupend and resume. + - Implement controller suspend and resume. - Clear PCI error state during driver attach so that we don't disable memory mapped I/O due to a stray write by some other driver probe that occurred before we @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ The following information is available in this file: - Add support for scsi_report_device_reset() found in 2.5.X kernels. - Add 7901B support. - - Simplify handling of the packtized lun Rev A workaround. + - Simplify handling of the packetized lun Rev A workaround. - Correct and simplify handling of the ignore wide residue message. The previous code would fail to report a residual if the transaction data length was even and we received diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt index 3481fcd..9b894f1 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt @@ -160,7 +160,7 @@ The following information is available in this file: 6.2.34 (May 5th, 2003) - Fix locking regression instroduced in 6.2.29 that - could cuase a lock order reversal between the io_request_lock + could cause a lock order reversal between the io_request_lock and our per-softc lock. This was only possible on RH9, SuSE, and kernel.org 2.4.X kernels. diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt index 79e5ac6..c92f447 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt @@ -102,7 +102,7 @@ linux-1.1.x and fairly stable since linux-1.2.x, and are also in FreeBSD The hardware RAID devices sold by Adaptec are *NOT* supported by this driver (and will people please stop emailing me about them, they are a totally separate beast from the bare SCSI controllers and this driver - can not be retrofitted in any sane manner to support the hardware RAID + cannot be retrofitted in any sane manner to support the hardware RAID features on those cards - Doug Ledford). @@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ linux-1.1.x and fairly stable since linux-1.2.x, and are also in FreeBSD that instead of dumping the register contents on the card, this option dumps the contents of the sequencer program RAM. This gives the ability to verify that the instructions downloaded to the - card's sequencer are indeed what they are suppossed to be. Again, + card's sequencer are indeed what they are supposed to be. Again, unless you have documentation to tell you how to interpret these numbers, then it is totally useless. @@ -317,7 +317,7 @@ linux-1.1.x and fairly stable since linux-1.2.x, and are also in FreeBSD initial DEVCONFIG values for each of your aic7xxx controllers as they are listed, and also record what the machine is detecting as the proper termination on your controllers. NOTE: the order in - which the initial DEVCONFIG values are printed out is not gauranteed + which the initial DEVCONFIG values are printed out is not guaranteed to be the same order as the SCSI controllers are registered. The above option and this option both work on the order of the SCSI controllers as they are registered, so make sure you match the right diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt b/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt index ae3b79a..88219f9 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt @@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ Parameters ---------- The driver uses the settings from the EEPROM set in the SCSI BIOS setup. If there is no EEPROM, the driver uses default values. -Both can be overriden by command line parameters (module or kernel +Both can be overridden by command line parameters (module or kernel parameters). The following parameters are available: diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt b/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt index 6e45e70..f36dc0e 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt @@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ * Implemented suggestions from Alan Cox * Added calculation of resid for sg layer * Better error handling - * Added checking underflow condtions + * Added checking underflow conditions * Added DATAPROTECT checking * Changed error return codes * Fixed pointer bug in bus reset routine diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt index d16ce5b..35f6b8e 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt @@ -229,7 +229,7 @@ In a second step of the driver development, the following improvement has been applied: The first approach limited the number of devices to 7, far - fewer than the 15 that it could usem then it just maped ldn -> + fewer than the 15 that it could use, then it just mapped ldn -> (ldn/8,ldn%8) for pun,lun. We ended up with a real mishmash of puns and luns, but it all seemed to work. @@ -254,12 +254,12 @@ device to be existant, but it has no ldn assigned, it gets a ldn out of 7 to 14. The numbers are assigned in cyclic order. Therefore it takes 8 dynamical reassignments on the SCSI-devices, until a certain device - loses its ldn again. This assures, that dynamical remapping is avoided + loses its ldn again. This assures that dynamical remapping is avoided during intense I/O between up to 15 SCSI-devices (means pun,lun - combinations). A further advantage of this method is, that people who + combinations). A further advantage of this method is that people who build their kernel without probing on all luns will get what they expect, because the driver just won't assign everything with lun>0 when - multpile lun probing is inactive. + multiple lun probing is inactive. 2.4 SCSI-Device Order --------------------- @@ -309,9 +309,9 @@ 2.6 Abort & Reset Commands -------------------------- These are implemented with busy waiting for interrupt to arrive. - ibmmca_reset() and ibmmca_abort() do not work sufficently well - up to now and need still a lot of development work. But, this seems - to be even a problem with other SCSI-low level drivers, too. However, + ibmmca_reset() and ibmmca_abort() do not work sufficiently well + up to now and need still a lot of development work. This seems + to be a problem with other low-level SCSI drivers too, however this should be no excuse. 2.7 Disk Geometry @@ -684,8 +684,8 @@ not like sending commands to non-existing SCSI-devices and will react with a command error as a sign of protest. While this error is not present on IBM SCSI Adapter w/cache, it appears on IBM Integrated SCSI - Adapters. Therefore, I implemented a workarround to forgive those - adapters their protests, but it is marked up in the statisctis, so + Adapters. Therefore, I implemented a workaround to forgive those + adapters their protests, but it is marked up in the statistics, so after a successful boot, you can see in /proc/scsi/ibmmca/<host_number> how often the command errors have been forgiven to the SCSI-subsystem. If the number is bigger than 0, you have a SCSI subsystem of older @@ -778,15 +778,15 @@ not accept this, as they stick quite near to ANSI-SCSI and report a COMMAND_ERROR message which causes the driver to panic. The main problem was located around the INQUIRY command. Now, for all the - mentioned commands, the buffersize, sent to the adapter is at + mentioned commands, the buffersize sent to the adapter is at maximum 255 which seems to be a quite reasonable solution. - TEST_UNIT_READY gets a buffersize of 0 to make sure, that no + TEST_UNIT_READY gets a buffersize of 0 to make sure that no data is transferred in order to avoid any possible command failure. - 2) On unsuccessful TEST_UNIT_READY, the midlevel-driver has to send - a REQUEST_SENSE in order to see, where the problem is located. This + 2) On unsuccessful TEST_UNIT_READY, the mid-level driver has to send + a REQUEST_SENSE in order to see where the problem is located. This REQUEST_SENSE may have various length in its answer-buffer. IBM - SCSI-subsystems report a command failure, if the returned buffersize - is different from the sent buffersize, but this can be supressed by + SCSI-subsystems report a command failure if the returned buffersize + is different from the sent buffersize, but this can be suppressed by a special bit, which is now done and problems seem to be solved. 2) Code adaption to all kernel-releases. Now, the 3.2 code compiles on 2.0.x, 2.1.x, 2.2.x and 2.3.x kernel releases without any code-changes. @@ -1086,7 +1086,7 @@ Q: "Reset SCSI-devices at boottime" halts the system at boottime, why? A: This is only tested with the IBM SCSI Adapter w/cache. It is not - yet prooved to run on other adapters, however you may be lucky. + yet proven to run on other adapters, however you may be lucky. In version 3.1d this has been hugely improved and should work better, now. Normally you really won't need to activate this flag in the kernel configuration, as all post 1989 SCSI-devices should accept @@ -1104,7 +1104,7 @@ The parameter 'normal' sets the new industry standard, starting from pun 0, scanning up to pun 6. This allows you to change your opinion still after having already compiled the kernel. - Q: Why I cannot find the IBM MCA SCSI support in the config menue? + Q: Why can't I find IBM MCA SCSI support in the config menu? A: You have to activate MCA bus support, first. Q: Where can I find the latest info about this driver? A: See the file MAINTAINERS for the current WWW-address, which offers @@ -1156,7 +1156,7 @@ Guide) what has to be done for reset, we still share the bad shape of the reset functions with all other low level SCSI-drivers. Astonishingly, reset works in most cases quite ok, but the harddisks - won't run in synchonous mode anymore after a reset, until you reboot. + won't run in synchronous mode anymore after a reset, until you reboot. Q: Why does my XXX w/Cache adapter not use read-prefetch? A: Ok, that is not completely possible. If a cache is present, the adapter tries to use it internally. Explicitly, one can use the cache diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt b/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt index ff864c0..3c7cea5 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt @@ -4,11 +4,11 @@ Overview: -------- -Different classes of controllers from LSI Logic, accept and respond to the +Different classes of controllers from LSI Logic accept and respond to the user applications in a similar way. They understand the same firmware control commands. Furthermore, the applications also can treat different classes of the controllers uniformly. Hence it is logical to have a single module that -interefaces with the applications on one side and all the low level drivers +interfaces with the applications on one side and all the low level drivers on the other. The advantages, though obvious, are listed for completeness: diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt index 822d2ac..58ad8db 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ Written by Gerard Roudier <groudier@free.fr> 15. SCSI problem troubleshooting 15.1 Problem tracking 15.2 Understanding hardware error reports -16. Synchonous transfer negotiation tables +16. Synchronous transfer negotiation tables 16.1 Synchronous timings for 53C875 and 53C860 Ultra-SCSI controllers 16.2 Synchronous timings for fast SCSI-2 53C8XX controllers 17. Serial NVRAM support (by Richard Waltham) @@ -96,10 +96,10 @@ The original driver has been written for 386bsd and FreeBSD by: It is now available as a bundle of 2 drivers: - ncr53c8xx generic driver that supports all the SYM53C8XX family including - the ealiest 810 rev. 1, the latest 896 (2 channel LVD SCSI controller) and + the earliest 810 rev. 1, the latest 896 (2 channel LVD SCSI controller) and the new 895A (1 channel LVD SCSI controller). - sym53c8xx enhanced driver (a.k.a. 896 drivers) that drops support of oldest - chips in order to gain advantage of new features, as LOAD/STORE intructions + chips in order to gain advantage of new features, as LOAD/STORE instructions available since the 810A and hardware phase mismatch available with the 896 and the 895A. @@ -207,7 +207,7 @@ The 896 and the 895A allows handling of the phase mismatch context from SCRIPTS (avoids the phase mismatch interrupt that stops the SCSI processor until the C code has saved the context of the transfer). Implementing this without using LOAD/STORE instructions would be painfull -and I did'nt even want to try it. +and I didn't even want to try it. The 896 chip supports 64 bit PCI transactions and addressing, while the 895A supports 32 bit PCI transactions and 64 bit addressing. @@ -631,8 +631,8 @@ string variable using 'insmod'. A boot setup command for the ncr53c8xx (sym53c8xx) driver begins with the driver name "ncr53c8xx="(sym53c8xx). The kernel syntax parser then expects -an optionnal list of integers separated with comma followed by an optional -list of comma-separated strings. Example of boot setup command under lilo +an optional list of integers separated with comma followed by an optional +list of comma-separated strings. Example of boot setup command under lilo prompt: lilo: linux root=/dev/hda2 ncr53c8xx=tags:4,sync:10,debug:0x200 @@ -778,7 +778,7 @@ port address 0x1400. Some scsi boards use a 875 (ultra wide) and only supply narrow connectors. If you have connected a wide device with a 50 pins to 68 pins cable converter, any accepted wide negotiation will break further data transfers. - In such a case, using "wide:0" in the bootup command will be helpfull. + In such a case, using "wide:0" in the bootup command will be helpful. 10.2.14 Differential mode diff:0 never set up diff mode @@ -899,7 +899,7 @@ boot setup can be: ncr53c8xx=safe:y,mpar:y ncr53c8xx=safe:y -My personnal system works flawlessly with the following equivalent setup: +My personal system works flawlessly with the following equivalent setup: ncr53c8xx=mpar:y,spar:y,disc:y,specf:1,fsn:n,ultra:2,fsn:n,revprob:n,verb:1\ tags:32,sync:12,debug:0,burst:7,led:1,wide:1,settle:2,diff:0,irqm:0 @@ -1151,7 +1151,7 @@ Driver files: New driver versions are made available separately in order to allow testing changes and new features prior to including them into the linux kernel -distribution. The following URL provides informations on latest avalaible +distribution. The following URL provides information on latest available patches: ftp://ftp.tux.org/pub/people/gerard-roudier/README @@ -1382,7 +1382,7 @@ SCSI standards, chip cores functionnals and internal driver data structures. You are not required to decode and understand them, unless you want to help maintain the driver code. -16. Synchonous transfer negotiation tables +16. Synchronous transfer negotiation tables Tables below have been created by calling the routine the driver uses for synchronisation negotiation timing calculation and chip setting. diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt b/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt index ce574e7..f536907 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt @@ -56,8 +56,7 @@ Compile your kernel and install the modules. Now, your osst driver is inside the kernel or available as a module, depending on your choice during kernel config. You may still need to create -the device nodes by calling the Makedevs.sh script (see below) manually, -unless you use a devfs kernel, where this won't be needed. +the device nodes by calling the Makedevs.sh script (see below) manually. To load your module, you may use the command modprobe osst diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt index 5d9223b..067ac39 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ General Iomega ZIP drive page for Linux: http://www.torque.net/~campbell/ -Driver achive for old drivers: +Driver archive for old drivers: http://www.torque.net/~campbell/ppa/ Linux Parport page (parallel port) diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/scsi-changer.txt b/Documentation/scsi/scsi-changer.txt index c132687..d74bbd2 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/scsi-changer.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/scsi-changer.txt @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ changers. But it allows to handle nearly all possible cases. It knows media transport - this one shuffles around the media, i.e. the transport arm. Also known as "picker". storage - a slot which can hold a media. - import/export - the same as above, but is accessable from outside, + import/export - the same as above, but is accessible from outside, i.e. there the operator (you !) can use this to fill in and remove media from the changer. Sometimes named "mailslot". diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/scsi_eh.txt b/Documentation/scsi/scsi_eh.txt index ce767b9..b964eef 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/scsi_eh.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/scsi_eh.txt @@ -160,7 +160,7 @@ ways. - Fine-grained EH callbacks LLDD can implement fine-grained EH callbacks and let SCSI midlayer drive error handling and call appropriate callbacks. - This will be dicussed further in [2-1]. + This will be discussed further in [2-1]. - eh_strategy_handler() callback This is one big callback which should perform whole error @@ -194,7 +194,7 @@ lower layers and lower layers are ready to process or fail the scmd again. To achieve these goals, EH performs recovery actions with increasing -severity. Some actions are performed by issueing SCSI commands and +severity. Some actions are performed by issuing SCSI commands and others are performed by invoking one of the following fine-grained hostt EH callbacks. Callbacks may be omitted and omitted ones are considered to fail always. diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/st.txt b/Documentation/scsi/st.txt index 20e30cf..5ff65b1 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/st.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/st.txt @@ -249,7 +249,7 @@ BOOT TIME CONFIGURATION If the driver is compiled into the kernel, the same parameters can be also set using, e.g., the LILO command line. The preferred syntax is -is to use the same keyword used when loading as module but prepended +to use the same keyword used when loading as module but prepended with 'st.'. For instance, to set the maximum number of scatter/gather segments, the parameter 'st.max_sg_segs=xx' should be used (xx is the number of scatter/gather segments). @@ -369,7 +369,7 @@ MTSETDRVBUFFER the device dependent address. It is recommended to set this flag unless there are tapes using the device dependent (from the old times) (global) - MT_ST_SYSV sets the SYSV sematics (mode) + MT_ST_SYSV sets the SYSV semantics (mode) MT_ST_NOWAIT enables immediate mode (i.e., don't wait for the command to finish) for some commands (e.g., rewind) MT_ST_DEBUGGING debugging (global; debugging must be diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt b/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt index 7f516cd..26c8a08 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt @@ -67,7 +67,7 @@ under Linux is contained in 2 files named sym_glue.h and sym_glue.c. Other drivers files are intended not to depend on the Operating System on which the driver is used. -The history of this driver can be summerized as follows: +The history of this driver can be summarized as follows: 1993: ncr driver written for 386bsd and FreeBSD by: Wolfgang Stanglmeier <wolf@cologne.de> @@ -684,7 +684,7 @@ Field H : SCNTL3 Scsi Control Register 3 Contains the setting of timing values for both asynchronous and synchronous data transfers. Field I : SCNTL4 Scsi Control Register 4 - Only meaninful for 53C1010 Ultra3 controllers. + Only meaningful for 53C1010 Ultra3 controllers. Understanding Fields J, K, L and dumps requires to have good knowledge of SCSI standards, chip cores functionnals and internal driver data structures. diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt b/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt index df7a02b..8b2168a 100644 --- a/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt +++ b/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ Tekram DC390(T) adapter. This is where the name comes from: tm = Tekram scsi = SCSI driver, m = AMD (?) as opposed to w for the DC390W/U/F (NCR53c8X5, X=2/7) driver. Yes, there was also a driver for the latter, tmscsiw, which supported DC390W/U/F adapters. It's not maintained any more, -as the ncr53c8xx is perfectly supporting these adpaters since some time. +as the ncr53c8xx is perfectly supporting these adapters since some time. The driver first appeared in April 1996, exclusively supported the DC390 and has been enhanced since then in various steps. In May 1998 support for @@ -381,7 +381,7 @@ Please see http://www.garloff.de/kurt/linux/dc390/problems.html replaced by the dev index of your scanner). You may try to reset your SCSI bus afterwards (echo "RESET" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/?). The problem seems to be solved as of 2.0d18, thanks to Andreas Rick. -* If there is a valid partition table, the driver will use it for determing +* If there is a valid partition table, the driver will use it for determining the mapping. If there's none, a reasonable mapping (Symbios-like) will be assumed. Other operating systems may not like this mapping, though it's consistent with the BIOS' behaviour. Old DC390 drivers ignored the diff --git a/Documentation/sh/kgdb.txt b/Documentation/sh/kgdb.txt index 5b04f7f..05b4ba8 100644 --- a/Documentation/sh/kgdb.txt +++ b/Documentation/sh/kgdb.txt @@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ might specify the halt option: kgdb=halt -Boot the TARGET machinem, which will appear to hang. +Boot the TARGET machine, which will appear to hang. On your DEVELOPMENT machine, cd to the source directory and run the gdb program. (This is likely to be a cross GDB which runs on your host but diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt index e6b57dd..138673a 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt +++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/ALSA-Configuration.txt @@ -57,11 +57,6 @@ Prior to version 0.9.0rc4 options had a 'snd_' prefix. This was removed. - Default: 1 - For auto-loading more than one card, specify this option together with snd-card-X aliases. - device_mode - - permission mask for dynamic sound device filesystem - - This is available only when DEVFS is enabled - - Default: 0666 - - E.g.: device_mode=0660 Module snd-pcm-oss @@ -1268,8 +1263,8 @@ Prior to version 0.9.0rc4 options had a 'snd_' prefix. This was removed. Note: on some notebooks the buffer address cannot be detected automatically, or causes hang-up during initialization. - In such a case, specify the buffer top address explicity via - buffer_top option. + In such a case, specify the buffer top address explicitly via + the buffer_top option. For example, Sony F250: buffer_top=0x25a800 Sony F270: buffer_top=0x272800 @@ -1887,7 +1882,7 @@ options snd-ens1371 index=1 # OSS/Free portion alias sound-slot-0 snd-interwave alias sound-slot-1 snd-ens1371 ------ /etc/moprobe.conf +----- /etc/modprobe.conf In this example, the interwave card is always loaded as the first card (index 0) and ens1371 as the second (index 1). @@ -1915,21 +1910,6 @@ Please note that the device mapping above may be varied via the module options of snd-pcm-oss module. -DEVFS support -============= - -The ALSA driver fully supports the devfs extension. -You should add lines below to your devfsd.conf file: - -LOOKUP snd MODLOAD ACTION snd -REGISTER ^sound/.* PERMISSIONS root.audio 660 -REGISTER ^snd/.* PERMISSIONS root.audio 660 - -Warning: These lines assume that you have the audio group in your system. - Otherwise replace audio word with another group name (root for - example). - - Proc interfaces (/proc/asound) ============================== diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/Audiophile-Usb.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/Audiophile-Usb.txt index b535c2a..e40cce8 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/Audiophile-Usb.txt +++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/Audiophile-Usb.txt @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ Here is a list of supported device_setup values for this device: - Alsa driver default mode - maintains backward compatibility with setups that do not use this parameter by not introducing any change - - results sometimes in corrupted sound as decribed earlier + - results sometimes in corrupted sound as described earlier * device_setup=0x01 - 16bits 48kHz mode with Di disabled - Ai,Ao,Do can be used at the same time diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/CMIPCI.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/CMIPCI.txt index 1872e244..4b2b153 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/CMIPCI.txt +++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/CMIPCI.txt @@ -16,11 +16,11 @@ As default, ALSA driver assigns the first PCM device (i.e. hw:0,0 for card#0) for front and 4/6ch playbacks, while the second PCM device (hw:0,1) is assigned to the second DAC for rear playback. -There are slight difference between two DACs. +There are slight differences between the two DACs: - The first DAC supports U8 and S16LE formats, while the second DAC supports only S16LE. -- The seconde DAC supports only two channel stereo. +- The second DAC supports only two channel stereo. Please note that the CM8x38 DAC doesn't support continuous playback rate but only fixed rates: 5512, 8000, 11025, 16000, 22050, 32000, @@ -76,7 +76,7 @@ in alsa-lib. For example, you can play a WAV file with 6 channels like % aplay -Dsurround51 sixchannels.wav -For programmin the 4/6 channel playback, you need to specify the PCM +For programming the 4/6 channel playback, you need to specify the PCM channels as you like and set the format S16LE. For example, for playback with 4 channels, diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/DocBook/writing-an-alsa-driver.tmpl b/Documentation/sound/alsa/DocBook/writing-an-alsa-driver.tmpl index 4807ef7..077fbe2 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/DocBook/writing-an-alsa-driver.tmpl +++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/DocBook/writing-an-alsa-driver.tmpl @@ -5486,7 +5486,7 @@ struct _snd_pcm_runtime { <chapter id="power-management"> <title>Power Management</title> <para> - If the chip is supposed to work with with suspend/resume + If the chip is supposed to work with suspend/resume functions, you need to add the power-management codes to the driver. The additional codes for the power-management should be <function>ifdef</function>'ed with diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/MIXART.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/MIXART.txt index 5cb9706..ef42c44 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/MIXART.txt +++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/MIXART.txt @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ With a miXart8AES/EBU there is in addition 1 stereo digital input Formats ------- U8, S16_LE, S16_BE, S24_3LE, S24_3BE, FLOAT_LE, FLOAT_BE -Sample rates : 8000 - 48000 Hz continously +Sample rates : 8000 - 48000 Hz continuously Playback -------- @@ -39,7 +39,7 @@ For instance the playback devices are configured to have max. 4 substreams performing hardware mixing. This could be changed to a maximum of 24 substreams if wished. Mono files will be played on the left and right channel. Each channel -can be muted for each stream to use 8 analog/digital outputs seperately. +can be muted for each stream to use 8 analog/digital outputs separately. Capture ------- @@ -97,4 +97,4 @@ COPYRIGHT ========= Copyright (c) 2003 Digigram SA <alsa@digigram.com> -Distributalbe under GPL. +Distributable under GPL. diff --git a/Documentation/sound/alsa/Procfile.txt b/Documentation/sound/alsa/Procfile.txt index 1fe4884..f738b29 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/alsa/Procfile.txt +++ b/Documentation/sound/alsa/Procfile.txt @@ -71,7 +71,7 @@ The status of MIDI I/O is found in midi* files. It shows the device name and the received/transmitted bytes through the MIDI device. When the card is equipped with AC97 codecs, there are codec97#* -subdirectories (desribed later). +subdirectories (described later). When the OSS mixer emulation is enabled (and the module is loaded), oss_mixer file appears here, too. This shows the current mapping of @@ -161,12 +161,12 @@ seq/drivers Lists the currently available ALSA sequencer drivers. seq/clients - Shows the list of currently available sequencer clinets and + Shows the list of currently available sequencer clients and ports. The connection status and the running status are shown in this file, too. seq/queues - Lists the currently allocated/running sequener queues. + Lists the currently allocated/running sequencer queues. seq/timer Lists the currently allocated/running sequencer timers. @@ -182,10 +182,10 @@ When the problem is related with PCM, first try to turn on xrun_debug mode. This will give you the kernel messages when and where xrun happened. -If it's really a bug, report it with the following information +If it's really a bug, report it with the following information: - the name of the driver/card, show in /proc/asound/cards - - the reigster dump, if available (e.g. card*/cmipci) + - the register dump, if available (e.g. card*/cmipci) when it's a PCM problem, diff --git a/Documentation/sound/oss/AWE32 b/Documentation/sound/oss/AWE32 index cb179bf..b5908a6 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/oss/AWE32 +++ b/Documentation/sound/oss/AWE32 @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ SB32. install awe_wave /sbin/modprobe --first-time -i awe_wave && /usr/local/bin/sfxload PATH_TO_SOUND_BANK_FILE You will of course have to change "PATH_TO_SOUND_BANK_FILE" to the full - path of of the sound bank file. That will enable the Sound Blaster and AWE + path of the sound bank file. That will enable the Sound Blaster and AWE wave synthesis. To play midi files you should get one of these programs if you don't already have them: diff --git a/Documentation/sound/oss/solo1 b/Documentation/sound/oss/solo1 index 6f53d40..95c4c834 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/oss/solo1 +++ b/Documentation/sound/oss/solo1 @@ -6,7 +6,7 @@ is at least one report of it working on later silicon. The chip behaves differently than described in the data sheet, likely due to a chip bug. Working around this would require the help of ESS (for example by publishing an errata sheet), -but ESS has not done so so far. +but ESS has not done so far. Also, the chip only supports 24 bit addresses for recording, which means it cannot work on some Alpha mainboards. diff --git a/Documentation/sound/oss/ultrasound b/Documentation/sound/oss/ultrasound index 32cd504..eed331c 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/oss/ultrasound +++ b/Documentation/sound/oss/ultrasound @@ -19,7 +19,7 @@ db16 ??? no_wave_dma option This option defaults to a value of 0, which allows the Ultrasound wavetable -DSP to use DMA for for playback and downloading samples. This is the same +DSP to use DMA for playback and downloading samples. This is the same as the old behaviour. If set to 1, no DMA is needed for downloading samples, and allows owners of a GUS MAX to make use of simultaneous digital audio (/dev/dsp), MIDI, and wavetable playback. diff --git a/Documentation/sound/oss/vwsnd b/Documentation/sound/oss/vwsnd index a6ea0a1..4c6cbdb 100644 --- a/Documentation/sound/oss/vwsnd +++ b/Documentation/sound/oss/vwsnd @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ boxes. The Visual Workstation has an Analog Devices AD1843 "SoundComm" audio codec chip. The AD1843 is accessed through the Cobalt I/O ASIC, also -known as Lithium. This driver programs both both chips. +known as Lithium. This driver programs both chips. ============================================================================== QUICK CONFIGURATION diff --git a/Documentation/sparc/sbus_drivers.txt b/Documentation/sparc/sbus_drivers.txt index 4b93516..8418d35 100644 --- a/Documentation/sparc/sbus_drivers.txt +++ b/Documentation/sparc/sbus_drivers.txt @@ -25,8 +25,8 @@ the bits necessary to run your device. The most commonly used members of this structure, and their typical usage, will be detailed below. - Here is a piece of skeleton code for perofming a device -probe in an SBUS driverunder Linux: + Here is a piece of skeleton code for performing a device +probe in an SBUS driver under Linux: static int __devinit mydevice_probe_one(struct sbus_dev *sdev) { @@ -98,7 +98,7 @@ in your .remove method. Any memory allocated, registers mapped, IRQs registered, etc. must be undone by your .remove method so that all resources -of your device are relased by the time it returns. +of your device are released by the time it returns. You should _NOT_ use the for_each_sbus(), for_each_sbusdev(), and for_all_sbusdev() interfaces. They are deprecated, will be diff --git a/Documentation/spi/pxa2xx b/Documentation/spi/pxa2xx index 9c45f3d..a1e0ee2 100644 --- a/Documentation/spi/pxa2xx +++ b/Documentation/spi/pxa2xx @@ -124,12 +124,12 @@ use a value of 8. The "pxa2xx_spi_chip.timeout_microsecs" fields is used to efficiently handle trailing bytes in the SSP receiver fifo. The correct value for this field is dependent on the SPI bus speed ("spi_board_info.max_speed_hz") and the specific -slave device. Please note the the PXA2xx SSP 1 does not support trailing byte +slave device. Please note that the PXA2xx SSP 1 does not support trailing byte timeouts and must busy-wait any trailing bytes. The "pxa2xx_spi_chip.enable_loopback" field is used to place the SSP porting into internal loopback mode. In this mode the SSP controller internally -connects the SSPTX pin the the SSPRX pin. This is useful for initial setup +connects the SSPTX pin to the SSPRX pin. This is useful for initial setup testing. The "pxa2xx_spi_chip.cs_control" field is used to point to a board specific @@ -208,7 +208,7 @@ DMA and PIO I/O Support ----------------------- The pxa2xx_spi driver support both DMA and interrupt driven PIO message transfers. The driver defaults to PIO mode and DMA transfers must enabled by -setting the "enable_dma" flag in the "pxa2xx_spi_master" structure and and +setting the "enable_dma" flag in the "pxa2xx_spi_master" structure and ensuring that the "pxa2xx_spi_chip.dma_burst_size" field is non-zero. The DMA mode support both coherent and stream based DMA mappings. diff --git a/Documentation/spi/spi-summary b/Documentation/spi/spi-summary index 068732d3..7279579 100644 --- a/Documentation/spi/spi-summary +++ b/Documentation/spi/spi-summary @@ -262,7 +262,7 @@ NON-STATIC CONFIGURATIONS Developer boards often play by different rules than product boards, and one example is the potential need to hotplug SPI devices and/or controllers. -For those cases you might need to use use spi_busnum_to_master() to look +For those cases you might need to use spi_busnum_to_master() to look up the spi bus master, and will likely need spi_new_device() to provide the board info based on the board that was hotplugged. Of course, you'd later call at least spi_unregister_device() when that board is removed. @@ -322,7 +322,7 @@ As soon as it enters probe(), the driver may issue I/O requests to the SPI device using "struct spi_message". When remove() returns, the driver guarantees that it won't submit any more such messages. - - An spi_message is a sequence of of protocol operations, executed + - An spi_message is a sequence of protocol operations, executed as one atomic sequence. SPI driver controls include: + when bidirectional reads and writes start ... by how its diff --git a/Documentation/stable_kernel_rules.txt b/Documentation/stable_kernel_rules.txt index e409e5d..02a4812 100644 --- a/Documentation/stable_kernel_rules.txt +++ b/Documentation/stable_kernel_rules.txt @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ Rules on what kind of patches are accepted, and which ones are not, into the "-stable" tree: - It must be obviously correct and tested. - - It can not be bigger than 100 lines, with context. + - It cannot be bigger than 100 lines, with context. - It must fix only one thing. - It must fix a real bug that bothers people (not a, "This could be a problem..." type thing). @@ -14,7 +14,7 @@ Rules on what kind of patches are accepted, and which ones are not, into the critical. - No "theoretical race condition" issues, unless an explanation of how the race can be exploited is also provided. - - It can not contain any "trivial" fixes in it (spelling changes, + - It cannot contain any "trivial" fixes in it (spelling changes, whitespace cleanups, etc). - It must be accepted by the relevant subsystem maintainer. - It must follow the Documentation/SubmittingPatches rules. diff --git a/Documentation/uml/UserModeLinux-HOWTO.txt b/Documentation/uml/UserModeLinux-HOWTO.txt index 544430e..b60590e 100644 --- a/Documentation/uml/UserModeLinux-HOWTO.txt +++ b/Documentation/uml/UserModeLinux-HOWTO.txt @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ 13. What to do when UML doesn't work 13.1 Strange compilation errors when you build from source - 13.2 UML hangs on boot after mounting devfs + 13.2 (obsolete) 13.3 A variety of panics and hangs with /tmp on a reiserfs filesystem 13.4 The compile fails with errors about conflicting types for 'open', 'dup', and 'waitpid' 13.5 UML doesn't work when /tmp is an NFS filesystem @@ -379,31 +379,6 @@ bug fixes and enhancements that have gone into subsequent releases. - If you build your own kernel, and want to boot it from one of the - filesystems distributed from this site, then, in nearly all cases, - devfs must be compiled into the kernel and mounted at boot time. The - exception is the SuSE filesystem. For this, devfs must either not be - in the kernel at all, or "devfs=nomount" must be on the kernel command - line. Any disagreement between the kernel and the filesystem being - booted about whether devfs is being used will result in the boot - getting no further than single-user mode. - - - If you don't want to use devfs, you can remove the need for it from a - filesystem by copying /dev from someplace, making a bunch of /dev/ubd - devices: - - - UML# for i in 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7; do mknod ubd$i b 98 $i; done - - - - - and changing /etc/fstab and /etc/inittab to refer to the non-devfs - devices. - - - 22..22.. CCoommppiilliinngg aanndd iinnssttaalllliinngg kkeerrnneell mmoodduulleess UML modules are built in the same way as the native kernel (with the @@ -839,9 +814,7 @@ +o None - device=none - This causes the device to disappear. If you are using devfs, the - device will not appear in /dev. If not, then attempts to open it - will return -ENODEV. + This causes the device to disappear. @@ -1047,7 +1020,7 @@ Note that the IP address you assign to the host end of the tap device must be different than the IP you assign to the eth device inside UML. - If you are short on IPs and don't want to comsume two per UML, then + If you are short on IPs and don't want to consume two per UML, then you can reuse the host's eth IP address for the host ends of the tap devices. Internally, the UMLs must still get unique IPs for their eth devices. You can also give the UMLs non-routable IPs (192.168.x.x or @@ -2058,7 +2031,7 @@ there are multiple COWs associated with a backing file, a -d merge of one of them will invalidate all of the others. However, it is convenient if you're short of disk space, and it should also be - noticably faster than a non-destructive merge. + noticeably faster than a non-destructive merge. @@ -3898,29 +3871,6 @@ - 1133..22.. UUMMLL hhaannggss oonn bboooott aafftteerr mmoouunnttiinngg ddeevvffss - - The boot looks like this: - - - VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem) readonly. - Mounted devfs on /dev - - - - - You're probably running a recent distribution on an old machine. I - saw this with the RH7.1 filesystem running on a Pentium. The shared - library loader, ld.so, was executing an instruction (cmove) which the - Pentium didn't support. That instruction was apparently added later. - If you run UML under the debugger, you'll see the hang caused by one - instruction causing an infinite SIGILL stream. - - - The fix is to boot UML on an older filesystem. - - - 1133..33.. AA vvaarriieettyy ooff ppaanniiccss aanndd hhaannggss wwiitthh //ttmmpp oonn aa rreeiisseerrffss ffiilleessyyss-- tteemm @@ -3953,9 +3903,9 @@ 1133..55.. UUMMLL ddooeessnn''tt wwoorrkk wwhheenn //ttmmpp iiss aann NNFFSS ffiilleessyysstteemm - This seems to be a similar situation with the resierfs problem above. + This seems to be a similar situation with the ReiserFS problem above. Some versions of NFS seems not to handle mmap correctly, which UML - depends on. The workaround is have /tmp be non-NFS directory. + depends on. The workaround is have /tmp be a non-NFS directory. 1133..66.. UUMMLL hhaannggss oonn bboooott wwhheenn ccoommppiilleedd wwiitthh ggpprrooff ssuuppppoorrtt @@ -4022,7 +3972,7 @@ nneett If you can connect to the host, and the host can connect to UML, but - you can not connect to any other machines, then you may need to enable + you cannot connect to any other machines, then you may need to enable IP Masquerading on the host. Usually this is only experienced when using private IP addresses (192.168.x.x or 10.x.x.x) for host/UML networking, rather than the public address space that your host is @@ -4671,7 +4621,7 @@ Chris Reahard built a specialized root filesystem for running a DNS server jailed inside UML. It's available from the download <http://user-mode-linux.sourceforge.net/dl-sf.html> page in the Jail - Filesysems section. + Filesystems section. diff --git a/Documentation/unshare.txt b/Documentation/unshare.txt index 90a5e9e..a864351 100644 --- a/Documentation/unshare.txt +++ b/Documentation/unshare.txt @@ -260,7 +260,7 @@ items: a pointer to it. 7.4) Appropriately modify architecture specific code to register the - the new system call. + new system call. 8) Test Specification --------------------- diff --git a/Documentation/usb/URB.txt b/Documentation/usb/URB.txt index a49e5f2..8ffce74 100644 --- a/Documentation/usb/URB.txt +++ b/Documentation/usb/URB.txt @@ -184,7 +184,7 @@ you can pass information to the completion handler. Note that even when an error (or unlink) is reported, data may have been transferred. That's because USB transfers are packetized; it might take sixteen packets to transfer your 1KByte buffer, and ten of them might -have transferred succesfully before the completion was called. +have transferred successfully before the completion was called. NOTE: ***** WARNING ***** diff --git a/Documentation/usb/acm.txt b/Documentation/usb/acm.txt index 8ef45ea..737d610 100644 --- a/Documentation/usb/acm.txt +++ b/Documentation/usb/acm.txt @@ -49,20 +49,6 @@ Abstract Control Model (USB CDC ACM) specification. Unfortunately many modems and most ISDN TAs use proprietary interfaces and thus won't work with this drivers. Check for ACM compliance before buying. - The driver (with devfs) creates these devices in /dev/usb/acm: - - crw-r--r-- 1 root root 166, 0 Apr 1 10:49 0 - crw-r--r-- 1 root root 166, 1 Apr 1 10:49 1 - crw-r--r-- 1 root root 166, 2 Apr 1 10:49 2 - - And so on, up to 31, with the limit being possible to change in acm.c to up -to 256, so you can use up to 256 USB modems with one computer (you'll need -three USB cards for that, though). - - If you don't use devfs, then you can create device nodes with the same -minor/major numbers anywhere you want, but either the above location or -/dev/usb/ttyACM0 is preferred. - To use the modems you need these modules loaded: usbcore.ko diff --git a/Documentation/usb/error-codes.txt b/Documentation/usb/error-codes.txt index 39c68f8..9cf83e8 100644 --- a/Documentation/usb/error-codes.txt +++ b/Documentation/usb/error-codes.txt @@ -126,7 +126,7 @@ one or more packets could finish before an error stops further endpoint I/O. urb->transfer_flags. -ENODEV Device was removed. Often preceded by a burst of - other errors, since the hub driver does't detect + other errors, since the hub driver doesn't detect device removal events immediately. -EXDEV ISO transfer only partially completed @@ -145,7 +145,7 @@ one or more packets could finish before an error stops further endpoint I/O. hardware problems such as bad devices (including firmware) or cables. (**) This is also one of several codes that different kinds of host -controller use to to indicate a transfer has failed because of device +controller use to indicate a transfer has failed because of device disconnect. In the interval before the hub driver starts disconnect processing, devices may receive such fault reports for every request. diff --git a/Documentation/usb/hiddev.txt b/Documentation/usb/hiddev.txt index cd6fb4b..6a79075 100644 --- a/Documentation/usb/hiddev.txt +++ b/Documentation/usb/hiddev.txt @@ -118,7 +118,7 @@ index, the ioctl returns -1 and sets errno to -EINVAL. HIDIOCGDEVINFO - struct hiddev_devinfo (read) Gets a hiddev_devinfo structure which describes the device. -HIDIOCGSTRING - struct struct hiddev_string_descriptor (read/write) +HIDIOCGSTRING - struct hiddev_string_descriptor (read/write) Gets a string descriptor from the device. The caller must fill in the "index" field to indicate which descriptor should be returned. diff --git a/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt b/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt index cd806bf..e43cfff 100644 --- a/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt +++ b/Documentation/usb/mtouchusb.txt @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ CHANGES Changed reset from standard USB dev reset to vendor reset Changed data sent to host from compensated to raw coordinates Eliminated vendor/product module params - Performed multiple successfull tests with an EXII-5010UC + Performed multiple successful tests with an EXII-5010UC SUPPORTED HARDWARE: @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ This driver appears to be one of possible 2 Linux USB Input Touchscreen drivers. Although 3M produces a binary only driver available for download, I persist in updating this driver since I would like to use the touchscreen for embedded apps using QTEmbedded, DirectFB, etc. So I feel the -logical choice is to use Linux Imput. +logical choice is to use Linux Input. Currently there is no way to calibrate the device via this driver. Even if the device could be calibrated, the driver pulls to raw coordinate data from @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ TODO: Implement a control urb again to handle requests to and from the device such as calibration, etc once/if it becomes available. -DISCLAMER: +DISCLAIMER: I am not a MicroTouch/3M employee, nor have I ever been. 3M does not support this driver! If you want touch drivers only supported within X, please go to: diff --git a/Documentation/usb/usb-serial.txt b/Documentation/usb/usb-serial.txt index a2dee6e..8dc2bac 100644 --- a/Documentation/usb/usb-serial.txt +++ b/Documentation/usb/usb-serial.txt @@ -13,7 +13,6 @@ CONFIGURATION Currently the driver can handle up to 256 different serial interfaces at one time. - If you are not using devfs: The major number that the driver uses is 188 so to use the driver, create the following nodes: mknod /dev/ttyUSB0 c 188 0 @@ -26,10 +25,6 @@ CONFIGURATION mknod /dev/ttyUSB254 c 188 254 mknod /dev/ttyUSB255 c 188 255 - If you are using devfs: - The devices supported by this driver will show up as - /dev/usb/tts/{0,1,...} - When the device is connected and recognized by the driver, the driver will print to the system log, which node(s) the device has been bound to. @@ -228,7 +223,7 @@ Cypress M8 CY4601 Family Serial Driver -Cypress HID->COM RS232 adapter Note: Cypress Semiconductor claims no affiliation with the - the hid->com device. + hid->com device. Most devices using chipsets under the CY4601 family should work with the driver. As long as they stay true to the CY4601 @@ -277,7 +272,7 @@ Digi AccelePort Driver work under SMP with the uhci driver. The driver is generally working, though we still have a few more ioctls - to implement and final testing and debugging to do. The paralled port + to implement and final testing and debugging to do. The parallel port on the USB 2 is supported as a serial to parallel converter; in other words, it appears as another USB serial port on Linux, even though physically it is really a parallel port. The Digi Acceleport USB 8 @@ -427,7 +422,7 @@ Options supported: debug - extra verbose debugging info (default: 0; nonzero enables) use_lowlatency - use low_latency flag to speed up tty layer - when reading from from the device. + when reading from the device. (default: 0; nonzero enables) See http://www.uuhaus.de/linux/palmconnect.html for up-to-date diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/README.pvrusb2 b/Documentation/video4linux/README.pvrusb2 index c73a32c..a4b7ae8 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/README.pvrusb2 +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/README.pvrusb2 @@ -155,7 +155,7 @@ Source file list / functional overview: pvrusb2-i2c-core.[ch] - This module provides an implementation of a kernel-friendly I2C adaptor driver, through which other external I2C client drivers (e.g. msp3400, tuner, lirc) may connect and - operate corresponding chips within the the pvrusb2 device. It is + operate corresponding chips within the pvrusb2 device. It is through here that other V4L modules can reach into this driver to operate specific pieces (and those modules are in turn driven by glue logic which is coordinated by pvrusb2-hdw, doled out by diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/Zoran b/Documentation/video4linux/Zoran index 040a2c8..deb218f 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/Zoran +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/Zoran @@ -144,7 +144,7 @@ tv broadcast formats all aver the world. The CCIR defines parameters needed for broadcasting the signal. The CCIR has defined different standards: A,B,D,E,F,G,D,H,I,K,K1,L,M,N,... -The CCIR says not much about about the colorsystem used !!! +The CCIR says not much about the colorsystem used !!! And talking about a colorsystem says not to much about how it is broadcast. The CCIR standards A,E,F are not used any more. diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-decoder-api.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-decoder-api.txt index 9df4fb3..78bf5f2 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-decoder-api.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-decoder-api.txt @@ -102,7 +102,7 @@ Param[0] Name CX2341X_DEC_GET_XFER_INFO Enum 9/0x09 Description - This API call may be used to detect an end of stream condtion. + This API call may be used to detect an end of stream condition. Result[0] Stream type Result[1] diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-encoder-api.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-encoder-api.txt index 001c686..15df0df 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-encoder-api.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-encoder-api.txt @@ -280,7 +280,7 @@ Param[0] Param[1] Unknown, but leaving this to 0 seems to work best. Indications are that this might have to do with USB support, although passing anything but 0 - onl breaks things. + only breaks things. ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-osd-api.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-osd-api.txt index da98ae3..0a602f3 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-osd-api.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/cx2341x/fw-osd-api.txt @@ -97,7 +97,7 @@ Result[0] Result[1] top left vertical offset Result[2] - bottom right hotizontal offset + bottom right horizontal offset Result[3] bottom right vertical offset diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/cx88/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/cx88/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt index 93fec32..faccee6 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/cx88/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/cx88/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ provide for a handler) GP_SAMPLE register is at 0x35C058 Bits are then right shifted into the GP_SAMPLE register at the specified -rate; you get an interrupt when a full DWORD is recieved. +rate; you get an interrupt when a full DWORD is received. You need to recover the actual RC5 bits out of the (oversampled) IR sensor bits. (Hint: look for the 0/1and 1/0 crossings of the RC5 bi-phase data) An actual raw RC5 code will span 2-3 DWORDS, depending on the actual alignment. diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/et61x251.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/et61x251.txt index cd584f2..1bdee8f 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/et61x251.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/et61x251.txt @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ Some of the features of the driver are: high compression quality (see also "Notes for V4L2 application developers" paragraph); - full support for the capabilities of every possible image sensors that can - be connected to the ET61X[12]51 bridges, including, for istance, red, green, + be connected to the ET61X[12]51 bridges, including, for instance, red, green, blue and global gain adjustments and exposure control (see "Supported devices" paragraph for details); - use of default color settings for sunlight conditions; @@ -222,7 +222,7 @@ identifier - of the camera registered as "/dev/video0": [root@localhost #] echo 1 > i2c_reg [root@localhost #] cat i2c_val -Note that if the sensor registers can not be read, "cat" will fail. +Note that if the sensor registers cannot be read, "cat" will fail. To avoid race conditions, all the I/O accesses to the files are serialized. diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt index 93fec32..faccee6 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/hauppauge-wintv-cx88-ir.txt @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ provide for a handler) GP_SAMPLE register is at 0x35C058 Bits are then right shifted into the GP_SAMPLE register at the specified -rate; you get an interrupt when a full DWORD is recieved. +rate; you get an interrupt when a full DWORD is received. You need to recover the actual RC5 bits out of the (oversampled) IR sensor bits. (Hint: look for the 0/1and 1/0 crossings of the RC5 bi-phase data) An actual raw RC5 code will span 2-3 DWORDS, depending on the actual alignment. diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/meye.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/meye.txt index 2137da9..ecb3416 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/meye.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/meye.txt @@ -29,7 +29,7 @@ driver (PCI vendor/device is 0x136b/0xff01) The third one, present in recent (more or less last year) Picturebooks (C1M* models), is not supported. The manufacturer has given the specs -to the developers under a NDA (which allows the develoment of a GPL +to the developers under a NDA (which allows the development of a GPL driver however), but things are not moving very fast (see http://r-engine.sourceforge.net/) (PCI vendor/device is 0x10cf/0x2011). diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/sn9c102.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/sn9c102.txt index 1d20895..8cda472 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/sn9c102.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/sn9c102.txt @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ It's worth to note that SONiX has never collaborated with the author during the development of this project, despite several requests for enough detailed specifications of the register tables, compression engine and video data format of the above chips. Nevertheless, these informations are no longer necessary, -becouse all the aspects related to these chips are known and have been +because all the aspects related to these chips are known and have been described in detail in this documentation. The driver relies on the Video4Linux2 and USB core modules. It has been @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ Some of the features of the driver are: high compression quality (see also "Notes for V4L2 application developers" and "Video frame formats" paragraphs); - full support for the capabilities of many of the possible image sensors that - can be connected to the SN9C10x bridges, including, for istance, red, green, + can be connected to the SN9C10x bridges, including, for instance, red, green, blue and global gain adjustments and exposure (see "Supported devices" paragraph for details); - use of default color settings for sunlight conditions; diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/w9968cf.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/w9968cf.txt index 0d53ce7..e0bba83 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/w9968cf.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/w9968cf.txt @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ Index 5. Supported devices 6. Module dependencies 7. Module loading -8. Module paramaters +8. Module parameters 9. Contact information 10. Credits diff --git a/Documentation/video4linux/zr36120.txt b/Documentation/video4linux/zr36120.txt index ac6d92d..1a1c2d0 100644 --- a/Documentation/video4linux/zr36120.txt +++ b/Documentation/video4linux/zr36120.txt @@ -118,9 +118,9 @@ card is not there, please try if any other card gives some response, and mail me if you got a working tvcard addition. PS. <TVCard editors behold!) - Dont forget to set video_input to the number of inputs + Don't forget to set video_input to the number of inputs you defined in the video_mux part of the tvcard definition. - Its a common error to add a channel but not incrementing + It's a common error to add a channel but not incrementing video_input and getting angry with me/v4l/linux/linus :( You are now ready to test the framegrabber with your favorite diff --git a/Documentation/vm/numa b/Documentation/vm/numa index 4b8db1b..e93ad94 100644 --- a/Documentation/vm/numa +++ b/Documentation/vm/numa @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ The initial port includes NUMAizing the bootmem allocator code by encapsulating all the pieces of information into a bootmem_data_t structure. Node specific calls have been added to the allocator. In theory, any platform which uses the bootmem allocator should -be able to to put the bootmem and mem_map data structures anywhere +be able to put the bootmem and mem_map data structures anywhere it deems best. Each node's page allocation data structures have also been encapsulated diff --git a/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-api.txt b/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-api.txt index 958ff3d..7e8ae83 100644 --- a/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-api.txt +++ b/Documentation/watchdog/watchdog-api.txt @@ -45,7 +45,7 @@ daemon and it crashes the system will not reboot. Because of this, some of the drivers support the configuration option "Disable watchdog shutdown on close", CONFIG_WATCHDOG_NOWAYOUT. If it is set to Y when compiling the kernel, there is no way of disabling the watchdog once -it has been started. So, if the watchdog dameon crashes, the system +it has been started. So, if the watchdog daemon crashes, the system will reboot after the timeout has passed. Some other drivers will not disable the watchdog, unless a specific @@ -207,7 +207,7 @@ Note that not all devices support these two calls, and some only support the GETBOOTSTATUS call. Some drivers can measure the temperature using the GETTEMP ioctl. The -returned value is the temperature in degrees farenheit. +returned value is the temperature in degrees fahrenheit. int temperature; ioctl(fd, WDIOC_GETTEMP, &temperature); @@ -258,13 +258,13 @@ booke_wdt.c -- PowerPC BookE Watchdog Timer Timeout default varies according to frequency, supports SETTIMEOUT - Watchdog can not be turned off, CONFIG_WATCHDOG_NOWAYOUT + Watchdog cannot be turned off, CONFIG_WATCHDOG_NOWAYOUT does not make sense GETSUPPORT returns the watchdog_info struct, and GETSTATUS returns the supported options. GETBOOTSTATUS returns a 1 if the last reset was caused by the - watchdog and a 0 otherwise. This watchdog can not be + watchdog and a 0 otherwise. This watchdog cannot be disabled once it has been started. The wdt_period kernel parameter selects which bit of the time base changing from 0->1 will trigger the watchdog exception. Changing diff --git a/Documentation/x86_64/boot-options.txt b/Documentation/x86_64/boot-options.txt index 74b77f9..f3c57f4 100644 --- a/Documentation/x86_64/boot-options.txt +++ b/Documentation/x86_64/boot-options.txt @@ -109,7 +109,7 @@ Idle loop Rebooting reboot=b[ios] | t[riple] | k[bd] [, [w]arm | [c]old] - bios Use the CPU reboto vector for warm reset + bios Use the CPU reboot vector for warm reset warm Don't set the cold reboot flag cold Set the cold reboot flag triple Force a triple fault (init) diff --git a/arch/alpha/Kconfig b/arch/alpha/Kconfig index 2b36afd..7e55ea6 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/Kconfig +++ b/arch/alpha/Kconfig @@ -534,7 +534,7 @@ config ARCH_DISCONTIGMEM_ENABLE bool "Discontiguous Memory Support (EXPERIMENTAL)" depends on EXPERIMENTAL help - Say Y to upport efficient handling of discontiguous physical memory, + Say Y to support efficient handling of discontiguous physical memory, for architectures which are either NUMA (Non-Uniform Memory Access) or have huge holes in the physical address space for other reasons. See <file:Documentation/vm/numa> for more. diff --git a/arch/alpha/kernel/alpha_ksyms.c b/arch/alpha/kernel/alpha_ksyms.c index dbe327d..8b02420 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/kernel/alpha_ksyms.c +++ b/arch/alpha/kernel/alpha_ksyms.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/alpha/kernel/ksyms.c + * linux/arch/alpha/kernel/alpha_ksyms.c * * Export the alpha-specific functions that are needed for loadable * modules. diff --git a/arch/alpha/kernel/head.S b/arch/alpha/kernel/head.S index 1e2a62a..e27d23c 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/kernel/head.S +++ b/arch/alpha/kernel/head.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * alpha/boot/head.S + * arch/alpha/kernel/head.S * * initial boot stuff.. At this point, the bootloader has already * switched into OSF/1 PAL-code, and loaded us at the correct address diff --git a/arch/alpha/kernel/machvec_impl.h b/arch/alpha/kernel/machvec_impl.h index 08b8302..0caa45a 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/kernel/machvec_impl.h +++ b/arch/alpha/kernel/machvec_impl.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/alpha/kernel/machvec.h + * linux/arch/alpha/kernel/machvec_impl.h * * Copyright (C) 1997, 1998 Richard Henderson * diff --git a/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackcheck.S b/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackcheck.S index 3c1f3e6..78f6b92 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackcheck.S +++ b/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackcheck.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/alpha/lib/stackcheck.S + * arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackcheck.S * Contributed by Richard Henderson (rth@tamu.edu) * * Verify that we have not overflowed the stack. Oops if we have. diff --git a/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackkill.S b/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackkill.S index e9f6a9d..c1e40a1 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackkill.S +++ b/arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackkill.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/alpha/lib/killstack.S + * arch/alpha/lib/dbg_stackkill.S * Contributed by Richard Henderson (rth@cygnus.com) * * Clobber the balance of the kernel stack, hoping to catch diff --git a/arch/alpha/lib/memset.S b/arch/alpha/lib/memset.S index 8ff6e7e..311b8cf 100644 --- a/arch/alpha/lib/memset.S +++ b/arch/alpha/lib/memset.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/alpha/memset.S + * linux/arch/alpha/lib/memset.S * * This is an efficient (and small) implementation of the C library "memset()" * function for the alpha. diff --git a/arch/arm/Kconfig b/arch/arm/Kconfig index f9362ee..adb05de 100644 --- a/arch/arm/Kconfig +++ b/arch/arm/Kconfig @@ -629,7 +629,7 @@ config ALIGNMENT_TRAP depends on CPU_CP15_MMU default y if !ARCH_EBSA110 help - ARM processors can not fetch/store information which is not + ARM processors cannot fetch/store information which is not naturally aligned on the bus, i.e., a 4 byte fetch must start at an address divisible by 4. On 32-bit ARM processors, these non-aligned fetch/store instructions will be emulated in software if you say diff --git a/arch/arm/boot/compressed/head-clps7500.S b/arch/arm/boot/compressed/head-clps7500.S index 941c5f5..4f3c78a 100644 --- a/arch/arm/boot/compressed/head-clps7500.S +++ b/arch/arm/boot/compressed/head-clps7500.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/boot/compressed/head.S + * linux/arch/arm/boot/compressed/head-clps7500.S * * Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001 Nexus Electronics Ltd */ diff --git a/arch/arm/common/sa1111.c b/arch/arm/common/sa1111.c index 29818bd..30046ad 100644 --- a/arch/arm/common/sa1111.c +++ b/arch/arm/common/sa1111.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-sa1100/sa1111.c + * linux/arch/arm/common/sa1111.c * * SA1111 support * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.c b/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.c index 471c1db..cf30803 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.h + * linux/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.c * * Copyright (C) 2004 Sascha Hauer <sascha@saschahauer.de> * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.h b/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.h index 83fa21e..49dc1c1 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.h +++ b/arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-arm/arch-imx/leds.h + * arch/arm/mach-imx/leds.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Sascha Hauer <sascha@saschahauer.de> * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/coyote-pci.c b/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/coyote-pci.c index 2cebb28..7bc94f3 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/coyote-pci.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/coyote-pci.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/arch/mach-ixp4xx/coyote-pci.c + * arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/coyote-pci.c * * PCI setup routines for ADI Engineering Coyote platform * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/ixdpg425-pci.c b/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/ixdpg425-pci.c index ed52708..509a95a 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/ixdpg425-pci.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/ixdpg425-pci.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/arch/mach-ixp4xx/ixdpg425-pci.c + * arch/arm/mach-ixp4xx/ixdpg425-pci.c * * PCI setup routines for Intel IXDPG425 Platform * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-lh7a40x/arch-lpd7a40x.c b/arch/arm/mach-lh7a40x/arch-lpd7a40x.c index a691011..a21b12f 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-lh7a40x/arch-lpd7a40x.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-lh7a40x/arch-lpd7a40x.c @@ -164,7 +164,7 @@ static void lh7a40x_ack_cpld_irq (u32 irq) /* CPLD doesn't have ack capability, but some devices may */ #if defined (CPLD_INTMASK_TOUCH) - /* The touch control *must* mask the the interrupt because the + /* The touch control *must* mask the interrupt because the * interrupt bit is read by the driver to determine if the pen * is still down. */ if (irq == IRQ_TOUCH) diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap1/serial.c b/arch/arm/mach-omap1/serial.c index 976edfb8..c4b7902 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap1/serial.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap1/serial.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap1/id.c + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap1/serial.c * * OMAP1 CPU identification code * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-apollon.c b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-apollon.c index 2db6b73..c37b0e6 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-apollon.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-apollon.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap/omap2/board-apollon.c + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-apollon.c * * Copyright (C) 2005,2006 Samsung Electronics * Author: Kyungmin Park <kyungmin.park@samsung.com> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-generic.c b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-generic.c index eaecbf4..9093815 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-generic.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-generic.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap/omap2/board-generic.c + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-generic.c * * Copyright (C) 2005 Nokia Corporation * Author: Paul Mundt <paul.mundt@nokia.com> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-h4.c b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-h4.c index 996aeda..26a95a6 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-h4.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-h4.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap/omap2/board-h4.c + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/board-h4.c * * Copyright (C) 2005 Nokia Corporation * Author: Paul Mundt <paul.mundt@nokia.com> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/irq.c b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/irq.c index 1ed2fff..1187009 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/irq.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/irq.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap/omap2/irq.c + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/irq.c * * Interrupt handler for OMAP2 boards. * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/prcm-regs.h b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/prcm-regs.h index 22ac7be..5e1c4b5 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/prcm-regs.h +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/prcm-regs.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/prcm-reg.h + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/prcm-regs.h * * OMAP24XX Power Reset and Clock Management (PRCM) registers * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/serial.c b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/serial.c index 0884bc7..aaa5589 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/serial.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/serial.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/arm/mach-omap/omap2/serial.c + * arch/arm/mach-omap2/serial.c * * OMAP2 serial support. * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/sram-fn.S b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/sram-fn.S index a5ef7f6..b275766 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-omap2/sram-fn.S +++ b/arch/arm/mach-omap2/sram-fn.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/sram.S + * linux/arch/arm/mach-omap2/sram-fn.S * * Omap2 specific functions that need to be run in internal SRAM * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-pxa/corgi_lcd.c b/arch/arm/mach-pxa/corgi_lcd.c index d781549..a72476c 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-pxa/corgi_lcd.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-pxa/corgi_lcd.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/video/w100fb.c + * linux/arch/arm/mach-pxa/corgi_lcd.c * * Corgi/Spitz LCD Specific Code * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-pxa/leds.h b/arch/arm/mach-pxa/leds.h index 4f829b8..7f0dfe0 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-pxa/leds.h +++ b/arch/arm/mach-pxa/leds.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-arm/arch-pxa/leds.h + * arch/arm/mach-pxa/leds.h * * Copyright (c) 2001 Jeff Sutherland, Accelent Systems Inc. * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/Kconfig b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/Kconfig index df37594..63965c7 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/Kconfig +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/Kconfig @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ config MACH_ANUBIS bool "Simtec Electronics ANUBIS" select CPU_S3C2440 help - Say Y gere if you are using the Simtec Electronics ANUBIS + Say Y here if you are using the Simtec Electronics ANUBIS development system config MACH_OSIRIS diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2400-gpio.c b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2400-gpio.c index f2a7817..1576d01 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2400-gpio.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2400-gpio.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/gpio.c +/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2400-gpio.c * * Copyright (c) 2006 Lucas Correia Villa Real <lucasvr@gobolinux.org> * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-clock.c b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-clock.c index 9971866..00abe19 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-clock.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-clock.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/clock.c +/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-clock.c * * Copyright (c) 2006 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-gpio.c b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-gpio.c index 471a714..a2098f6 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-gpio.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-gpio.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/gpio.c +/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2410-gpio.c * * Copyright (c) 2004-2006 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2442.c b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2442.c index debae24..581667e 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2442.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2442.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2440.c +/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2442.c * * Copyright (c) 2006 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x-irq.c b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x-irq.c index 0d13546..ec702f8 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x-irq.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x-irq.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2440-irq.c +/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x-irq.c * * Copyright (c) 2003,2004 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x.h b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x.h index 3e7f5f7..1488c1e 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x.h +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c2440.h +/* arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/s3c244x.h * * Copyright (c) 2004-2005 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/usb-simtec.h b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/usb-simtec.h index 92c0cc83..d8aa612 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/usb-simtec.h +++ b/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/usb-simtec.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/usb-simtec.c +/* linux/arch/arm/mach-s3c2410/usb-simtec.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-sa1100/dma.c b/arch/arm/mach-sa1100/dma.c index 3c6441d..2ea2a65 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-sa1100/dma.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-sa1100/dma.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/arm/kernel/dma-sa1100.c + * arch/arm/mach-sa1100/dma.c * * Support functions for the SA11x0 internal DMA channels. * diff --git a/arch/arm/mach-shark/leds.c b/arch/arm/mach-shark/leds.c index 7cd86d3..5386a81f 100644 --- a/arch/arm/mach-shark/leds.c +++ b/arch/arm/mach-shark/leds.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/arm/kernel/leds-shark.c + * arch/arm/mach-shark/leds.c * by Alexander Schulz * * derived from: diff --git a/arch/arm/plat-omap/sram-fn.S b/arch/arm/plat-omap/sram-fn.S index 85cffe2..9e1813c 100644 --- a/arch/arm/plat-omap/sram-fn.S +++ b/arch/arm/plat-omap/sram-fn.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/plat-omap/sram.S + * linux/arch/arm/plat-omap/sram-fn.S * * Functions that need to be run in internal SRAM * diff --git a/arch/cris/arch-v10/drivers/Kconfig b/arch/cris/arch-v10/drivers/Kconfig index 8b50e84..734d5f3 100644 --- a/arch/cris/arch-v10/drivers/Kconfig +++ b/arch/cris/arch-v10/drivers/Kconfig @@ -550,7 +550,7 @@ config ETRAX_IDE select BLK_DEV_IDEDMA help Enable this to get support for ATA/IDE. - You can't use paralell ports or SCSI ports + You can't use parallel ports or SCSI ports at the same time. @@ -744,7 +744,7 @@ config ETRAX_PA_CHANGEABLE_BITS default "FF" help This is a bitmask with information of what bits in PA that a user - can change change the value on using ioctl's. + can change the value on using ioctl's. Bit set = changeable. You probably want 00 here. diff --git a/arch/cris/arch-v32/Kconfig b/arch/cris/arch-v32/Kconfig index 22f0ddc..4f79d8e 100644 --- a/arch/cris/arch-v32/Kconfig +++ b/arch/cris/arch-v32/Kconfig @@ -162,7 +162,7 @@ config ETRAX_SDRAM_GRP1_CONFIG depends on ETRAX_ARCH_V32 default "0" help - SDRAM configuration for group 1. The defult value is 0 + SDRAM configuration for group 1. The default value is 0 because group 1 is not used in the default configuration, described in the help for SDRAM_GRP0_CONFIG. diff --git a/arch/h8300/kernel/ints.c b/arch/h8300/kernel/ints.c index 1488b6a..1bfc77e 100644 --- a/arch/h8300/kernel/ints.c +++ b/arch/h8300/kernel/ints.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/h8300/platform/h8300h/ints.c + * linux/arch/h8300/kernel/ints.c * * Yoshinori Sato <ysato@users.sourceforge.jp> * diff --git a/arch/i386/Kconfig b/arch/i386/Kconfig index af219e5..8ff1c6f 100644 --- a/arch/i386/Kconfig +++ b/arch/i386/Kconfig @@ -682,7 +682,7 @@ config EFI depends on ACPI default n ---help--- - This enables the the kernel to boot on EFI platforms using + This enables the kernel to boot on EFI platforms using system configuration information passed to it from the firmware. This also enables the kernel to use any EFI runtime services that are available (such as the EFI variable services). diff --git a/arch/i386/kernel/cpu/common.c b/arch/i386/kernel/cpu/common.c index b2f24d5..d9f3e3c 100644 --- a/arch/i386/kernel/cpu/common.c +++ b/arch/i386/kernel/cpu/common.c @@ -669,8 +669,7 @@ old_gdt: */ atomic_inc(&init_mm.mm_count); current->active_mm = &init_mm; - if (current->mm) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(current->mm); enter_lazy_tlb(&init_mm, current); load_esp0(t, thread); diff --git a/arch/i386/kernel/efi.c b/arch/i386/kernel/efi.c index f943698..8b40648 100644 --- a/arch/i386/kernel/efi.c +++ b/arch/i386/kernel/efi.c @@ -498,8 +498,7 @@ void __init efi_enter_virtual_mode(void) check_range_for_systab(md); } - if (!efi.systab) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!efi.systab); status = phys_efi_set_virtual_address_map( memmap.desc_size * memmap.nr_map, diff --git a/arch/i386/kernel/ldt.c b/arch/i386/kernel/ldt.c index 983f957..445211e 100644 --- a/arch/i386/kernel/ldt.c +++ b/arch/i386/kernel/ldt.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/kernel/ldt.c + * linux/arch/i386/kernel/ldt.c * * Copyright (C) 1992 Krishna Balasubramanian and Linus Torvalds * Copyright (C) 1999 Ingo Molnar <mingo@redhat.com> diff --git a/arch/i386/mach-visws/visws_apic.c b/arch/i386/mach-visws/visws_apic.c index 8285225..5929f884 100644 --- a/arch/i386/mach-visws/visws_apic.c +++ b/arch/i386/mach-visws/visws_apic.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/i386/mach_visws/visws_apic.c + * linux/arch/i386/mach-visws/visws_apic.c * * Copyright (C) 1999 Bent Hagemark, Ingo Molnar * diff --git a/arch/i386/mm/discontig.c b/arch/i386/mm/discontig.c index 51e3739..455597d 100644 --- a/arch/i386/mm/discontig.c +++ b/arch/i386/mm/discontig.c @@ -153,8 +153,7 @@ static void __init find_max_pfn_node(int nid) */ if (node_start_pfn[nid] > max_pfn) node_start_pfn[nid] = max_pfn; - if (node_start_pfn[nid] > node_end_pfn[nid]) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(node_start_pfn[nid] > node_end_pfn[nid]); } /* diff --git a/arch/i386/mm/init.c b/arch/i386/mm/init.c index 90089c1..1674161 100644 --- a/arch/i386/mm/init.c +++ b/arch/i386/mm/init.c @@ -569,8 +569,7 @@ void __init mem_init(void) int bad_ppro; #ifdef CONFIG_FLATMEM - if (!mem_map) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!mem_map); #endif bad_ppro = ppro_with_ram_bug(); diff --git a/arch/i386/pci/fixup.c b/arch/i386/pci/fixup.c index 83c3645..b60d7e8 100644 --- a/arch/i386/pci/fixup.c +++ b/arch/i386/pci/fixup.c @@ -393,7 +393,7 @@ DECLARE_PCI_FIXUP_HEADER(PCI_ANY_ID, PCI_ANY_ID, pci_fixup_video); * We pretend to bring them out of full D3 state, and restore the proper * IRQ, PCI cache line size, and BARs, otherwise the device won't function * properly. In some cases, the device will generate an interrupt on - * the wrong IRQ line, causing any devices sharing the the line it's + * the wrong IRQ line, causing any devices sharing the line it's * *supposed* to use to be disabled by the kernel's IRQ debug code. */ static u16 toshiba_line_size; diff --git a/arch/ia64/kernel/acpi-processor.c b/arch/ia64/kernel/acpi-processor.c index e683630..4d4993a 100644 --- a/arch/ia64/kernel/acpi-processor.c +++ b/arch/ia64/kernel/acpi-processor.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/ia64/kernel/cpufreq/processor.c + * arch/ia64/kernel/acpi-processor.c * * Copyright (C) 2005 Intel Corporation * Venkatesh Pallipadi <venkatesh.pallipadi@intel.com> diff --git a/arch/ia64/kernel/entry.S b/arch/ia64/kernel/entry.S index e5b1be5..3390b7c 100644 --- a/arch/ia64/kernel/entry.S +++ b/arch/ia64/kernel/entry.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * ia64/kernel/entry.S + * arch/ia64/kernel/entry.S * * Kernel entry points. * diff --git a/arch/ia64/kernel/irq_ia64.c b/arch/ia64/kernel/irq_ia64.c index a041367..aafca18 100644 --- a/arch/ia64/kernel/irq_ia64.c +++ b/arch/ia64/kernel/irq_ia64.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/ia64/kernel/irq.c + * linux/arch/ia64/kernel/irq_ia64.c * * Copyright (C) 1998-2001 Hewlett-Packard Co * Stephane Eranian <eranian@hpl.hp.com> diff --git a/arch/ia64/sn/kernel/xpnet.c b/arch/ia64/sn/kernel/xpnet.c index 007703c..c8173db 100644 --- a/arch/ia64/sn/kernel/xpnet.c +++ b/arch/ia64/sn/kernel/xpnet.c @@ -225,7 +225,7 @@ xpnet_receive(partid_t partid, int channel, struct xpnet_message *msg) skb_put(skb, (msg->size - msg->leadin_ignore - msg->tailout_ignore)); /* - * Move the data over from the the other side. + * Move the data over from the other side. */ if ((XPNET_VERSION_MINOR(msg->version) == 1) && (msg->embedded_bytes != 0)) { diff --git a/arch/m68k/mm/motorola.c b/arch/m68k/mm/motorola.c index 49015e3..afcccdc 100644 --- a/arch/m68k/mm/motorola.c +++ b/arch/m68k/mm/motorola.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/m68k/motorola.c + * linux/arch/m68k/mm/motorola.c * * Routines specific to the Motorola MMU, originally from: * linux/arch/m68k/init.c diff --git a/arch/m68k/sun3/sun3dvma.c b/arch/m68k/sun3/sun3dvma.c index 6c26522..a2bc2da 100644 --- a/arch/m68k/sun3/sun3dvma.c +++ b/arch/m68k/sun3/sun3dvma.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/m68k/mm/sun3dvma.c + * linux/arch/m68k/sun3/sun3dvma.c * * Copyright (C) 2000 Sam Creasey * diff --git a/arch/m68knommu/Kconfig b/arch/m68knommu/Kconfig index e767f2d..6d920d4 100644 --- a/arch/m68knommu/Kconfig +++ b/arch/m68knommu/Kconfig @@ -161,8 +161,8 @@ config CLOCK_FREQ frequency, it may or may not be the same as the external clock crystal fitted to your board. Some processors have an internal PLL and can have their frequency programmed at run time, others - use internal dividers. In gernal the kernel won't setup a PLL - if it is fitted (there are some expections). This value will be + use internal dividers. In general the kernel won't setup a PLL + if it is fitted (there are some exceptions). This value will be specific to the exact CPU that you are using. config CLOCK_DIV @@ -495,7 +495,7 @@ config VECTORBASE hex "Address of the base of system vectors" default "0" help - Define the address of the the system vectors. Commonly this is + Define the address of the system vectors. Commonly this is put at the start of RAM, but it doesn't have to be. On ColdFire platforms this address is programmed into the VBR register, thus actually setting the address to use. diff --git a/arch/m68knommu/platform/68328/head-pilot.S b/arch/m68knommu/platform/68328/head-pilot.S index 9e07faa..aecff53 100644 --- a/arch/m68knommu/platform/68328/head-pilot.S +++ b/arch/m68knommu/platform/68328/head-pilot.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/m68knommu/platform/68328/head-rom.S + * linux/arch/m68knommu/platform/68328/head-pilot.S * - A startup file for the MC68328 * * Copyright (C) 1998 D. Jeff Dionne <jeff@ryeham.ee.ryerson.ca>, diff --git a/arch/mips/dec/prom/call_o32.S b/arch/mips/dec/prom/call_o32.S index 0dd56db..e523454 100644 --- a/arch/mips/dec/prom/call_o32.S +++ b/arch/mips/dec/prom/call_o32.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/mips/dec/call_o32.S + * arch/mips/dec/prom/call_o32.S * * O32 interface for the 64 (or N32) ABI. * diff --git a/arch/mips/mm/tlbex.c b/arch/mips/mm/tlbex.c index 375e099..6f8b25c 100644 --- a/arch/mips/mm/tlbex.c +++ b/arch/mips/mm/tlbex.c @@ -1211,7 +1211,7 @@ static void __init build_r4000_tlb_refill_handler(void) * Overflow check: For the 64bit handler, we need at least one * free instruction slot for the wrap-around branch. In worst * case, if the intended insertion point is a delay slot, we - * need three, with the the second nop'ed and the third being + * need three, with the second nop'ed and the third being * unused. */ #ifdef CONFIG_32BIT diff --git a/arch/mips/pci/fixup-vr4133.c b/arch/mips/pci/fixup-vr4133.c index 8e01d0c..597b897 100644 --- a/arch/mips/pci/fixup-vr4133.c +++ b/arch/mips/pci/fixup-vr4133.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/mips/vr41xx/nec-cmbvr4133/pci_fixup.c + * arch/mips/pci/fixup-vr4133.c * * The NEC CMB-VR4133 Board specific PCI fixups. * diff --git a/arch/mips/tx4938/common/irq.c b/arch/mips/tx4938/common/irq.c index dc30d66..cbfb342 100644 --- a/arch/mips/tx4938/common/irq.c +++ b/arch/mips/tx4938/common/irq.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/mps/tx4938/common/irq.c + * linux/arch/mips/tx4938/common/irq.c * * Common tx4938 irq handler * Copyright (C) 2000-2001 Toshiba Corporation diff --git a/arch/parisc/kernel/entry.S b/arch/parisc/kernel/entry.S index 95c1b8e..192357a 100644 --- a/arch/parisc/kernel/entry.S +++ b/arch/parisc/kernel/entry.S @@ -941,8 +941,8 @@ syscall_exit_rfi: * to "proper" values now (otherwise we'll wind up restoring * whatever was last stored in the task structure, which might * be inconsistent if an interrupt occured while on the gateway - * page) Note that we may be "trashing" values the user put in - * them, but we don't support the the user changing them. + * page). Note that we may be "trashing" values the user put in + * them, but we don't support the user changing them. */ STREG %r0,PT_SR2(%r16) diff --git a/arch/powerpc/Kconfig b/arch/powerpc/Kconfig index 032e6ab..96ef656 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/Kconfig +++ b/arch/powerpc/Kconfig @@ -1002,7 +1002,7 @@ config CONSISTENT_START_BOOL depends on ADVANCED_OPTIONS && NOT_COHERENT_CACHE help This option allows you to set the base virtual address - of the the consistent memory pool. This pool of virtual + of the consistent memory pool. This pool of virtual memory is used to make consistent memory allocations. config CONSISTENT_START @@ -1013,7 +1013,7 @@ config CONSISTENT_SIZE_BOOL bool "Set custom consistent memory pool size" depends on ADVANCED_OPTIONS && NOT_COHERENT_CACHE help - This option allows you to set the size of the the + This option allows you to set the size of the consistent memory pool. This pool of virtual memory is used to make consistent memory allocations. diff --git a/arch/powerpc/kernel/perfmon_fsl_booke.c b/arch/powerpc/kernel/perfmon_fsl_booke.c index bdc3977..e0dcf2b 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/kernel/perfmon_fsl_booke.c +++ b/arch/powerpc/kernel/perfmon_fsl_booke.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* kernel/perfmon_fsl_booke.c +/* arch/powerpc/kernel/perfmon_fsl_booke.c * Freescale Book-E Performance Monitor code * * Author: Andy Fleming diff --git a/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_7450.c b/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_7450.c index e0491c3..d8ee3ae 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_7450.c +++ b/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_7450.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * oprofile/op_model_7450.c + * arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_7450.c * * Freescale 745x/744x oprofile support, based on fsl_booke support * Copyright (C) 2004 Anton Blanchard <anton@au.ibm.com>, IBM diff --git a/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_fsl_booke.c b/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_fsl_booke.c index 93d63e6..e29dede 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_fsl_booke.c +++ b/arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_fsl_booke.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * oprofile/op_model_e500.c + * arch/powerpc/oprofile/op_model_fsl_booke.c * * Freescale Book-E oprofile support, based on ppc64 oprofile support * Copyright (C) 2004 Anton Blanchard <anton@au.ibm.com>, IBM diff --git a/arch/powerpc/platforms/83xx/mpc834x_sys.h b/arch/powerpc/platforms/83xx/mpc834x_sys.h index fedecb7..7d5bbef 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/platforms/83xx/mpc834x_sys.h +++ b/arch/powerpc/platforms/83xx/mpc834x_sys.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/powerppc/platforms/83xx/mpc834x_sys.h + * arch/powerpc/platforms/83xx/mpc834x_sys.h * * MPC834X SYS common board definitions * diff --git a/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc8540_ads.h b/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc8540_ads.h index c0d56d2..da82f4c 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc8540_ads.h +++ b/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc8540_ads.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/mpc8540_ads.h + * arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc8540_ads.h * * MPC8540ADS board definitions * diff --git a/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx.h b/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx.h index b44db62..83415db 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx.h +++ b/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx.h + * arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx.h * * MPC85xx soc definitions/function decls * diff --git a/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx_cds.h b/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx_cds.h index 671f54f..b251c9f 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx_cds.h +++ b/arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx_cds.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx_cds_common.h + * arch/powerpc/platforms/85xx/mpc85xx_cds.h * * MPC85xx CDS board definitions * diff --git a/arch/powerpc/sysdev/ipic.c b/arch/powerpc/sysdev/ipic.c index 0251b7c..6ebdae8 100644 --- a/arch/powerpc/sysdev/ipic.c +++ b/arch/powerpc/sysdev/ipic.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/ipic.c + * arch/powerpc/sysdev/ipic.c * * IPIC routines implementations. * diff --git a/arch/ppc/Kconfig b/arch/ppc/Kconfig index fdd9e7b..077711e 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/Kconfig +++ b/arch/ppc/Kconfig @@ -1345,7 +1345,7 @@ config CONSISTENT_START_BOOL depends on ADVANCED_OPTIONS && NOT_COHERENT_CACHE help This option allows you to set the base virtual address - of the the consistent memory pool. This pool of virtual + of the consistent memory pool. This pool of virtual memory is used to make consistent memory allocations. config CONSISTENT_START @@ -1356,7 +1356,7 @@ config CONSISTENT_SIZE_BOOL bool "Set custom consistent memory pool size" depends on ADVANCED_OPTIONS && NOT_COHERENT_CACHE help - This option allows you to set the size of the the + This option allows you to set the size of the consistent memory pool. This pool of virtual memory is used to make consistent memory allocations. diff --git a/arch/ppc/boot/include/mpsc_defs.h b/arch/ppc/boot/include/mpsc_defs.h index 2ce7bbb..9f37e13 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/boot/include/mpsc_defs.h +++ b/arch/ppc/boot/include/mpsc_defs.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/serial/mpsc/mpsc_defs.h + * arch/ppc/boot/include/mpsc_defs.h * * Register definitions for the Marvell Multi-Protocol Serial Controller (MPSC), * Serial DMA Controller (SDMA), and Baud Rate Generator (BRG). diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/4xx/xparameters/xparameters.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/4xx/xparameters/xparameters.h index cd7d0e7..66ec5f3 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/4xx/xparameters/xparameters.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/4xx/xparameters/xparameters.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/xparameters.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/4xx/xparameters/xparameters.h * * This file includes the correct xparameters.h for the CONFIG'ed board plus * fixups to translate board specific XPAR values to a common set of names diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/Kconfig b/arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/Kconfig index 7ddd331..6f2d0ad 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/Kconfig +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/85xx/Kconfig @@ -24,12 +24,12 @@ config MPC8540_ADS config MPC8548_CDS bool "Freescale MPC8548 CDS" help - This option enablese support for the MPC8548 CDS evaluation board. + This option enables support for the MPC8548 CDS evaluation board. config MPC8555_CDS bool "Freescale MPC8555 CDS" help - This option enablese support for the MPC8555 CDS evaluation board. + This option enables support for the MPC8555 CDS evaluation board. config MPC8560_ADS bool "Freescale MPC8560 ADS" @@ -51,22 +51,22 @@ config STX_GP3 config TQM8540 bool "TQ Components TQM8540" help - This option enablese support for the TQ Components TQM8540 board. + This option enables support for the TQ Components TQM8540 board. config TQM8541 bool "TQ Components TQM8541" help - This option enablese support for the TQ Components TQM8541 board. + This option enables support for the TQ Components TQM8541 board. config TQM8555 bool "TQ Components TQM8555" help - This option enablese support for the TQ Components TQM8555 board. + This option enables support for the TQ Components TQM8555 board. config TQM8560 bool "TQ Components TQM8560" help - This option enablese support for the TQ Components TQM8560 board. + This option enables support for the TQ Components TQM8560 board. endchoice @@ -94,7 +94,7 @@ config MPC8560 default y config 85xx_PCI2 - bool "Supprt for 2nd PCI host controller" + bool "Support for 2nd PCI host controller" depends on MPC8555_CDS default y diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/lopec.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/lopec.h index 5490edb..d597b68 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/lopec.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/lopec.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/lopec_serial.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/lopec.h * * Definitions for Motorola LoPEC board. * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc8272ads_setup.c b/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc8272ads_setup.c index d5d36c3..d7b3a6a 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc8272ads_setup.c +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc8272ads_setup.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/ppc/platforms/82xx/pq2ads_pd.c + * arch/ppc/platforms/mpc8272ads_setup.c * * MPC82xx Board-specific PlatformDevice descriptions * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc885ads_setup.c b/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc885ads_setup.c index bf388ed..0229314 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc885ads_setup.c +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/mpc885ads_setup.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/*arch/ppc/platforms/mpc885ads-setup.c +/*arch/ppc/platforms/mpc885ads_setup.c * * Platform setup for the Freescale mpc885ads board * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/mvme5100.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/mvme5100.h index edd4794..9e2a09e 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/mvme5100.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/mvme5100.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/platforms/mvme5100.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/mvme5100.h * * Definitions for Motorola MVME5100. * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/powerpmc250.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/powerpmc250.h index 41a6dc8..d33ad8dc 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/powerpmc250.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/powerpmc250.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/platforms/powerpmc250.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/powerpmc250.h * * Definitions for Force PowerPMC-250 board support * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc750.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc750.h index 015b4f5..4c7adcc 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc750.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc750.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/platforms/prpmc750.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc750.h * * Definitions for Motorola PrPMC750 board support * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc800.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc800.h index e53ec9b..26f604e 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc800.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc800.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/platforms/prpmc800.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/prpmc800.h * * Definitions for Motorola PrPMC800 board support * diff --git a/arch/ppc/platforms/spruce.h b/arch/ppc/platforms/spruce.h index a31ff7e..f1f96f1 100644 --- a/arch/ppc/platforms/spruce.h +++ b/arch/ppc/platforms/spruce.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/platforms/spruce.h + * arch/ppc/platforms/spruce.h * * Definitions for IBM Spruce reference board support * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/io.c b/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/io.c index 6835381..23071f9 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/io.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/io.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-sh/io_bigsur.c + * arch/sh/boards/bigsur/io.c * * By Dustin McIntire (dustin@sensoria.com) (c)2001 * Derived from io_hd64465.h, which bore the message: diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/led.c b/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/led.c index 6b08c0e..d221439 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/led.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/led_bigsur.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/bigsur/led.c * * By Dustin McIntire (dustin@sensoria.com) (c)2001 * Derived from led_se.c and led.c, which bore the message: diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/ec3104/io.c b/arch/sh/boards/ec3104/io.c index a70928c..2f86394 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/ec3104/io.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/ec3104/io.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/io_ec3104.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/ec3104/io.c * EC3104 companion chip support * * Copyright (C) 2000 Philipp Rumpf <prumpf@tux.org> diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/hp6xx/setup.c b/arch/sh/boards/hp6xx/setup.c index 60ab17a..2d3a5b4 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/hp6xx/setup.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/hp6xx/setup.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/boards/hp6xx/hp680/setup.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/hp6xx/setup.c * * Copyright (C) 2002 Andriy Skulysh * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/led.c b/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/led.c index 1fe3692..8df1591 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/led.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/led_mpc1211.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/led.c * * Copyright (C) 2001 Saito.K & Jeanne * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/setup.c b/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/setup.c index 8eb5d43..01c10fa 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/setup.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/setup.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/board/mpc1211/setup.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/mpc1211/setup.c * * Copyright (C) 2002 Saito.K & Jeanne, Fujii.Y * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/io.c b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/io.c index 9ea1136..51f3f65 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/io.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/io.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/io_hs7751rvoip.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/io.c * * Copyright (C) 2001 Ian da Silva, Jeremy Siegel * Based largely on io_se.c. diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/pci.c b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/pci.c index 7e5786b..1c0ddee 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/pci.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/pci.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/pci-hs7751rvoip.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/renesas/hs7751rvoip/pci.c * * Author: Ian DaSilva (idasilva@mvista.com) * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/rts7751r2d/led.c b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/rts7751r2d/led.c index e14a13d..a7ce66c 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/rts7751r2d/led.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/rts7751r2d/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/led_rts7751r2d.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/renesas/rts7751r2d/led.c * * Copyright (C) Atom Create Engineering Co., Ltd. * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/io.c b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/io.c index cde6e5d..1b767e1 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/io.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/io.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/boards/systemh/io.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/io.c * * Copyright (C) 2001 Ian da Silva, Jeremy Siegel * Based largely on io_se.c. diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/irq.c b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/irq.c index 8d016da..0ba2fe6 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/irq.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/irq.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/boards/systemh/irq.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/irq.c * * Copyright (C) 2000 Kazumoto Kojima * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/setup.c b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/setup.c index bab7d3c..9361176 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/setup.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/setup.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/boards/systemh/setup.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/renesas/systemh/setup.c * * Copyright (C) 2000 Kazumoto Kojima * Copyright (C) 2003 Paul Mundt diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/se/770x/led.c b/arch/sh/boards/se/770x/led.c index daf7b1e..d93dd83 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/se/770x/led.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/se/770x/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/led_se.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/se/770x/led.c * * Copyright (C) 2000 Stuart Menefy <stuart.menefy@st.com> * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/led.c b/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/led.c index ff0355d..de4194d 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/led.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/led_se.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/led.c * * Copyright (C) 2000 Stuart Menefy <stuart.menefy@st.com> * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/pci.c b/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/pci.c index 3ee0301..203b292 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/pci.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/pci.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/pci-7751se.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/se/7751/pci.c * * Author: Ian DaSilva (idasilva@mvista.com) * diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/io.c b/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/io.c index 4836b94..83419bf 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/io.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/io.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/io_microdev.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/io.c * * Copyright (C) 2003 Sean McGoogan (Sean.McGoogan@superh.com) * Copyright (C) 2003, 2004 SuperH, Inc. diff --git a/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/led.c b/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/led.c index a38f535..36e54b4 100644 --- a/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/led.c +++ b/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/led_microdev.c + * linux/arch/sh/boards/superh/microdev/led.c * * Copyright (C) 2002 Stuart Menefy <stuart.menefy@st.com> * Copyright (C) 2003 Richard Curnow (Richard.Curnow@superh.com) diff --git a/arch/sh/drivers/dma/dma-pvr2.c b/arch/sh/drivers/dma/dma-pvr2.c index 3b0b0f6..c1b6bc2 100644 --- a/arch/sh/drivers/dma/dma-pvr2.c +++ b/arch/sh/drivers/dma/dma-pvr2.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/boards/dreamcast/dma-pvr2.c + * arch/sh/drivers/dma/dma-pvr2.c * * NEC PowerVR 2 (Dreamcast) DMA support * diff --git a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/dma-dreamcast.c b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/dma-dreamcast.c index 6acf02b..230d6ec 100644 --- a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/dma-dreamcast.c +++ b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/dma-dreamcast.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/pci/dma-dreamcast.c + * arch/sh/drivers/pci/dma-dreamcast.c * * PCI DMA support for the Sega Dreamcast * diff --git a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/fixups-dreamcast.c b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/fixups-dreamcast.c index c0af5f7..6f53f82 100644 --- a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/fixups-dreamcast.c +++ b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/fixups-dreamcast.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/pci/fixups-dreamcast.c + * arch/sh/drivers/pci/fixups-dreamcast.c * * PCI fixups for the Sega Dreamcast * diff --git a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-bigsur.c b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-bigsur.c index 5da501b..eb31be7 100644 --- a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-bigsur.c +++ b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-bigsur.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/pci-bigsur.c + * linux/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-bigsur.c * * By Dustin McIntire (dustin@sensoria.com) (c)2001 * diff --git a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-dreamcast.c b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-dreamcast.c index 23d5279..381306c 100644 --- a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-dreamcast.c +++ b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-dreamcast.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/pci/ops-dreamcast.c + * arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-dreamcast.c * * PCI operations for the Sega Dreamcast * diff --git a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-rts7751r2d.c b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-rts7751r2d.c index 88f44e2..b68824c 100644 --- a/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-rts7751r2d.c +++ b/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-rts7751r2d.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sh/kernel/pci-rts7751r2d.c + * linux/arch/sh/drivers/pci/ops-rts7751r2d.c * * Author: Ian DaSilva (idasilva@mvista.com) * diff --git a/arch/sh/kernel/cpu/ubc.S b/arch/sh/kernel/cpu/ubc.S index 0c569b2..8192307 100644 --- a/arch/sh/kernel/cpu/ubc.S +++ b/arch/sh/kernel/cpu/ubc.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/kernel/ubc.S + * arch/sh/kernel/cpu/ubc.S * * Set of management routines for the User Break Controller (UBC) * diff --git a/arch/sh64/boot/compressed/misc.c b/arch/sh64/boot/compressed/misc.c index ee7a1b6..aea00c5 100644 --- a/arch/sh64/boot/compressed/misc.c +++ b/arch/sh64/boot/compressed/misc.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/shmedia/boot/compressed/misc.c + * arch/sh64/boot/compressed/misc.c * * This is a collection of several routines from gzip-1.0.3 * adapted for Linux. diff --git a/arch/sh64/kernel/alphanum.c b/arch/sh64/kernel/alphanum.c index 9079d1e..91707c1 100644 --- a/arch/sh64/kernel/alphanum.c +++ b/arch/sh64/kernel/alphanum.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh64/kernel/alpanum.c + * arch/sh64/kernel/alphanum.c * * Copyright (C) 2002 Stuart Menefy <stuart.menefy@st.com> * diff --git a/arch/sh64/lib/c-checksum.c b/arch/sh64/lib/c-checksum.c index 53c1cab..0e8a742 100644 --- a/arch/sh64/lib/c-checksum.c +++ b/arch/sh64/lib/c-checksum.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/lib/csum_parial.c + * arch/sh64/lib/c-checksum.c * * This file contains network checksum routines that are better done * in an architecture-specific manner due to speed.. diff --git a/arch/sh64/mach-cayman/led.c b/arch/sh64/mach-cayman/led.c index 8b3cc4c..b4e122f 100644 --- a/arch/sh64/mach-cayman/led.c +++ b/arch/sh64/mach-cayman/led.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh64/kernel/led_cayman.c + * arch/sh64/mach-cayman/led.c * * Copyright (C) 2002 Stuart Menefy <stuart.menefy@st.com> * diff --git a/arch/sh64/oprofile/op_model_null.c b/arch/sh64/oprofile/op_model_null.c index a845b08..a750ea1 100644 --- a/arch/sh64/oprofile/op_model_null.c +++ b/arch/sh64/oprofile/op_model_null.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/sh/oprofile/op_model_null.c + * arch/sh64/oprofile/op_model_null.c * * Copyright (C) 2003 Paul Mundt * diff --git a/arch/sparc/kernel/sys_solaris.c b/arch/sparc/kernel/sys_solaris.c index c09afd9..01b07bb 100644 --- a/arch/sparc/kernel/sys_solaris.c +++ b/arch/sparc/kernel/sys_solaris.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/sparc/sys_solaris.c + * linux/arch/sparc/kernel/sys_solaris.c * * Copyright (C) 1996 Miguel de Icaza (miguel@nuclecu.unam.mx) */ diff --git a/arch/um/Kconfig b/arch/um/Kconfig index 76e85bb..d753075 100644 --- a/arch/um/Kconfig +++ b/arch/um/Kconfig @@ -257,7 +257,7 @@ config UML_REAL_TIME_CLOCK UML and spend long times with UML stopped at a breakpoint. In this case, when UML is restarted, it will call the timer enough times to make up for the time spent at the breakpoint. This could result in a - noticable lag. If this is a problem, then disable this option. + noticeable lag. If this is a problem, then disable this option. endmenu diff --git a/arch/um/Makefile b/arch/um/Makefile index f6ad832..c8016a9 100644 --- a/arch/um/Makefile +++ b/arch/um/Makefile @@ -102,7 +102,7 @@ linux: vmlinux define archhelp echo '* linux - Binary kernel image (./linux) - for backward' echo ' compatibility only, this creates a hard link to the' - echo ' real kernel binary, the the "vmlinux" binary you' + echo ' real kernel binary, the "vmlinux" binary you' echo ' find in the kernel root.' endef diff --git a/arch/um/drivers/line.c b/arch/um/drivers/line.c index 24747a4..cfd9f01 100644 --- a/arch/um/drivers/line.c +++ b/arch/um/drivers/line.c @@ -497,7 +497,7 @@ void close_lines(struct line *lines, int nlines) } /* Common setup code for both startup command line and mconsole initialization. - * @lines contains the the array (of size @num) to modify; + * @lines contains the array (of size @num) to modify; * @init is the setup string; */ diff --git a/arch/um/include/sysdep-x86_64/ptrace_user.h b/arch/um/include/sysdep-x86_64/ptrace_user.h index 128faf0..4cd61a8 100644 --- a/arch/um/include/sysdep-x86_64/ptrace_user.h +++ b/arch/um/include/sysdep-x86_64/ptrace_user.h @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ #define PTRACE_OLDSETOPTIONS 21 #endif -/* These are before the system call, so the the system call number is RAX +/* These are before the system call, so the system call number is RAX * rather than ORIG_RAX, and arg4 is R10 rather than RCX */ #define REGS_SYSCALL_NR PT_INDEX(RAX) diff --git a/arch/v850/kernel/entry.S b/arch/v850/kernel/entry.S index d991e45..8bc521c 100644 --- a/arch/v850/kernel/entry.S +++ b/arch/v850/kernel/entry.S @@ -195,7 +195,7 @@ sst.w lp, PTO+PT_GPR(GPR_LP)[ep]; \ type ## _STATE_SAVER /* Pop a register state pushed by PUSH_STATE, except for the stack pointer, - from the the stack. */ + from the stack. */ #define POP_STATE(type) \ mov sp, ep; \ type ## _STATE_RESTORER; \ diff --git a/arch/x86_64/Kconfig b/arch/x86_64/Kconfig index 0a5d8e6..010d226 100644 --- a/arch/x86_64/Kconfig +++ b/arch/x86_64/Kconfig @@ -310,7 +310,7 @@ config K8_NUMA help Enable K8 NUMA node topology detection. You should say Y here if you have a multi processor AMD K8 system. This uses an old - method to read the NUMA configurtion directly from the builtin + method to read the NUMA configuration directly from the builtin Northbridge of Opteron. It is recommended to use X86_64_ACPI_NUMA instead, which also takes priority if both are compiled in. diff --git a/arch/xtensa/Kconfig b/arch/xtensa/Kconfig index 848f173..c1e69a1 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/Kconfig +++ b/arch/xtensa/Kconfig @@ -206,7 +206,7 @@ source "drivers/pci/hotplug/Kconfig" endmenu -menu "Exectuable file formats" +menu "Executable file formats" # only elf supported config KCORE_ELF @@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ menu "Xtensa initrd options" bool "Embed root filesystem ramdisk into the kernel" config EMBEDDED_RAMDISK_IMAGE - string "Filename of gziped ramdisk image" + string "Filename of gzipped ramdisk image" depends on EMBEDDED_RAMDISK default "ramdisk.gz" help diff --git a/arch/xtensa/kernel/module.c b/arch/xtensa/kernel/module.c index d1683cf..2ea1755 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/kernel/module.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/kernel/module.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/kernel/platform.c + * arch/xtensa/kernel/module.c * * Module support. * diff --git a/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci-dma.c b/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci-dma.c index 1ff8226..6648fa9 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci-dma.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci-dma.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/pci-dma.c + * arch/xtensa/kernel/pci-dma.c * * DMA coherent memory allocation. * diff --git a/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci.c b/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci.c index 8709f82..45571cc 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/kernel/pci.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/pcibios.c + * arch/xtensa/kernel/pci.c * * PCI bios-type initialisation for PCI machines * diff --git a/arch/xtensa/kernel/setup.c b/arch/xtensa/kernel/setup.c index 82684d0..c99ab72 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/kernel/setup.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/kernel/setup.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/setup.c + * arch/xtensa/kernel/setup.c * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/arch/xtensa/kernel/syscalls.c b/arch/xtensa/kernel/syscalls.c index d9285d4..f49cb23 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/kernel/syscalls.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/kernel/syscalls.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/kernel/syscall.c + * arch/xtensa/kernel/syscalls.c * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/arch/xtensa/lib/pci-auto.c b/arch/xtensa/lib/pci-auto.c index 90c790f..a71733a 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/lib/pci-auto.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/lib/pci-auto.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/kernel/pci-auto.c + * arch/xtensa/lib/pci-auto.c * * PCI autoconfiguration library * diff --git a/arch/xtensa/lib/usercopy.S b/arch/xtensa/lib/usercopy.S index 265db26..4641ef5 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/lib/usercopy.S +++ b/arch/xtensa/lib/usercopy.S @@ -5,10 +5,10 @@ * * DO NOT COMBINE this function with <arch/xtensa/lib/hal/memcopy.S>. * It needs to remain separate and distinct. The hal files are part - * of the the Xtensa link-time HAL, and those files may differ per + * of the Xtensa link-time HAL, and those files may differ per * processor configuration. Patching the kernel for another * processor configuration includes replacing the hal files, and we - * could loose the special functionality for accessing user-space + * could lose the special functionality for accessing user-space * memory during such a patch. We sacrifice a little code space here * in favor to simplify code maintenance. * diff --git a/arch/xtensa/mm/pgtable.c b/arch/xtensa/mm/pgtable.c index 7d28914..6979927 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/mm/pgtable.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/mm/pgtable.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/mm/fault.c + * arch/xtensa/mm/pgtable.c * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/arch/xtensa/mm/tlb.c b/arch/xtensa/mm/tlb.c index d3bd3bf..0fefb866 100644 --- a/arch/xtensa/mm/tlb.c +++ b/arch/xtensa/mm/tlb.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/xtensa/mm/mmu.c + * arch/xtensa/mm/tlb.c * * Logic that manipulates the Xtensa MMU. Derived from MIPS. * diff --git a/drivers/acorn/block/mfmhd.c b/drivers/acorn/block/mfmhd.c index 3dd6b7b..1bace29 100644 --- a/drivers/acorn/block/mfmhd.c +++ b/drivers/acorn/block/mfmhd.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/drivers/block/mfmhd.c + * linux/drivers/acorn/block/mfmhd.c * * Copyright (C) 1995, 1996 Russell King, Dave Alan Gilbert (gilbertd@cs.man.ac.uk) * diff --git a/drivers/acpi/Kconfig b/drivers/acpi/Kconfig index 56c5ba8..0f9d4be 100644 --- a/drivers/acpi/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/acpi/Kconfig @@ -253,7 +253,7 @@ config ACPI_CUSTOM_DSDT depends on !STANDALONE default n help - Thist option is to load a custom ACPI DSDT + This option is to load a custom ACPI DSDT If you don't know what that is, say N. config ACPI_CUSTOM_DSDT_FILE @@ -310,7 +310,7 @@ config X86_PM_TIMER The Power Management Timer is available on all ACPI-capable, in most cases even if ACPI is unusable or blacklisted. - This timing source is not affected by powermanagement features + This timing source is not affected by power management features like aggressive processor idling, throttling, frequency and/or voltage scaling, unlike the commonly used Time Stamp Counter (TSC) timing source. @@ -345,7 +345,7 @@ config ACPI_HOTPLUG_MEMORY Enabling this driver assumes that your platform hardware and firmware have support for hot-plugging physical memory. If your system does not support physically adding or ripping out - memory DIMMs at some platfrom defined granularity (individually + memory DIMMs at some platform defined granularity (individually or as a bank) at runtime, then you need not enable this driver. If one selects "m," this driver can be loaded using the following diff --git a/drivers/block/Kconfig b/drivers/block/Kconfig index 422e31d..17dc222 100644 --- a/drivers/block/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/block/Kconfig @@ -207,8 +207,7 @@ config BLK_DEV_UMEM module will be called umem. The umem driver has not yet been allocated a MAJOR number, so - one is chosen dynamically. Use "devfs" or look in /proc/devices - for the device number + one is chosen dynamically. config BLK_DEV_UBD bool "Virtual block device" @@ -407,7 +406,7 @@ config BLK_DEV_RAM_BLOCKSIZE depends on BLK_DEV_RAM default "1024" help - The default value is 1024 kilobytes. PAGE_SIZE is a much more + The default value is 1024 bytes. PAGE_SIZE is a much more efficient choice however. The default is kept to ensure initrd setups function - apparently needed by the rd_load_image routine that supposes the filesystem in the image uses a 1024 blocksize. diff --git a/drivers/cdrom/cdrom.c b/drivers/cdrom/cdrom.c index b38c84a..2a0c50d 100644 --- a/drivers/cdrom/cdrom.c +++ b/drivers/cdrom/cdrom.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/drivers/cdrom/cdrom.c. +/* linux/drivers/cdrom/cdrom.c Copyright (c) 1996, 1997 David A. van Leeuwen. Copyright (c) 1997, 1998 Erik Andersen <andersee@debian.org> Copyright (c) 1998, 1999 Jens Axboe <axboe@image.dk> diff --git a/drivers/char/hw_random/ixp4xx-rng.c b/drivers/char/hw_random/ixp4xx-rng.c index ef71022..3cf4d64 100644 --- a/drivers/char/hw_random/ixp4xx-rng.c +++ b/drivers/char/hw_random/ixp4xx-rng.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/char/rng/ixp4xx-rng.c + * drivers/char/hw_random/ixp4xx-rng.c * * RNG driver for Intel IXP4xx family of NPUs * diff --git a/drivers/char/hw_random/omap-rng.c b/drivers/char/hw_random/omap-rng.c index a01d796..e13dd18 100644 --- a/drivers/char/hw_random/omap-rng.c +++ b/drivers/char/hw_random/omap-rng.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * driver/char/hw_random/omap-rng.c + * drivers/char/hw_random/omap-rng.c * * RNG driver for TI OMAP CPU family * diff --git a/drivers/char/mwave/README b/drivers/char/mwave/README index 70f8d19..480251f 100644 --- a/drivers/char/mwave/README +++ b/drivers/char/mwave/README @@ -41,10 +41,7 @@ Example to enable the 3780i DSP using ttyS1 resources: Accessing the driver -------------------- -You must also create a node for the driver. Without devfs: +You must also create a node for the driver: mkdir -p /dev/modems mknod --mode=660 /dev/modems/mwave c 10 219 -With devfs: - mkdir -p /dev/modems - ln -s ../misc/mwave /dev/modems/mwave diff --git a/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp2000_wdt.c b/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp2000_wdt.c index c91d9a6..fd955db 100644 --- a/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp2000_wdt.c +++ b/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp2000_wdt.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/watchdog/ixp2000_wdt.c + * drivers/char/watchdog/ixp2000_wdt.c * * Watchdog driver for Intel IXP2000 network processors * diff --git a/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp4xx_wdt.c b/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp4xx_wdt.c index db477f7..5864bb8 100644 --- a/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp4xx_wdt.c +++ b/drivers/char/watchdog/ixp4xx_wdt.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/watchdog/ixp4xx_wdt.c + * drivers/char/watchdog/ixp4xx_wdt.c * * Watchdog driver for Intel IXP4xx network processors * diff --git a/drivers/firmware/Kconfig b/drivers/firmware/Kconfig index 731c3d5..88f4621 100644 --- a/drivers/firmware/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/firmware/Kconfig @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ config DELL_RBU help Say m if you want to have the option of updating the BIOS for your DELL system. Note you need a Dell OpenManage or Dell Update package (DUP) - supporting application to comunicate with the BIOS regarding the new + supporting application to communicate with the BIOS regarding the new image for the image update to take effect. See <file:Documentation/dell_rbu.txt> for more details on the driver. diff --git a/drivers/firmware/edd.c b/drivers/firmware/edd.c index b4502ed6..5c261e1 100644 --- a/drivers/firmware/edd.c +++ b/drivers/firmware/edd.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/i386/kernel/edd.c + * linux/drivers/firmware/edd.c * Copyright (C) 2002, 2003, 2004 Dell Inc. * by Matt Domsch <Matt_Domsch@dell.com> * disk signature by Matt Domsch, Andrew Wilks, and Sandeep K. Shandilya diff --git a/drivers/i2c/busses/Kconfig b/drivers/i2c/busses/Kconfig index 0d96679..510816c 100644 --- a/drivers/i2c/busses/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/i2c/busses/Kconfig @@ -333,10 +333,10 @@ config I2C_PARPORT_LIGHT This driver is a light version of i2c-parport. It doesn't depend on the parport driver, and uses direct I/O access instead. This - might be prefered on embedded systems where wasting memory for + might be preferred on embedded systems where wasting memory for the clean but heavy parport handling is not an option. The drawback is a reduced portability and the impossibility to - dasiy-chain other parallel port devices. + daisy-chain other parallel port devices. Don't say Y here if you said Y or M to i2c-parport. Saying M to both is possible but both modules should not be loaded at the same diff --git a/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.c b/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.c index 5bccb5d..80d4ba1 100644 --- a/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.c +++ b/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/i2c/i2c-ibm_iic.c + * drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.c * * Support for the IIC peripheral on IBM PPC 4xx * diff --git a/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.h b/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.h index 2b3219d..59d7b43 100644 --- a/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.h +++ b/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/i2c/i2c-ibm_iic.h + * drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ibm_iic.h * * Support for the IIC peripheral on IBM PPC 4xx * diff --git a/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ixp4xx.c b/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ixp4xx.c index ab57325..1ce01fb 100644 --- a/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ixp4xx.c +++ b/drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ixp4xx.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/i2c/i2c-adap-ixp4xx.c + * drivers/i2c/busses/i2c-ixp4xx.c * * Intel's IXP4xx XScale NPU chipsets (IXP420, 421, 422, 425) do not have * an on board I2C controller but provide 16 GPIO pins that are often diff --git a/drivers/i2c/busses/scx200_i2c.c b/drivers/i2c/busses/scx200_i2c.c index 8b65a5c..8ddbae4 100644 --- a/drivers/i2c/busses/scx200_i2c.c +++ b/drivers/i2c/busses/scx200_i2c.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/drivers/i2c/scx200_i2c.c +/* linux/drivers/i2c/busses/scx200_i2c.c Copyright (c) 2001,2002 Christer Weinigel <wingel@nano-system.com> diff --git a/drivers/ide/h8300/ide-h8300.c b/drivers/ide/h8300/ide-h8300.c index 1595599..608ca87 100644 --- a/drivers/ide/h8300/ide-h8300.c +++ b/drivers/ide/h8300/ide-h8300.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/ide/ide-h8300.c + * drivers/ide/h8300/ide-h8300.c * H8/300 generic IDE interface */ diff --git a/drivers/ide/ppc/pmac.c b/drivers/ide/ppc/pmac.c index 31ad79f..91c5344 100644 --- a/drivers/ide/ppc/pmac.c +++ b/drivers/ide/ppc/pmac.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/ide/ide-pmac.c + * linux/drivers/ide/ppc/pmac.c * * Support for IDE interfaces on PowerMacs. * These IDE interfaces are memory-mapped and have a DBDMA channel diff --git a/drivers/ieee1394/Kconfig b/drivers/ieee1394/Kconfig index 2769e50..672b92e 100644 --- a/drivers/ieee1394/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/ieee1394/Kconfig @@ -140,7 +140,7 @@ config IEEE1394_SBP2_PHYS_DMA help This builds sbp2 for use with non-OHCI host adapters which do not support physical DMA or for when ohci1394 is run with phys_dma=0. - Physical DMA is data movement without assistence of the drivers' + Physical DMA is data movement without assistance of the drivers' interrupt handlers. This option includes the interrupt handlers that are required in absence of this hardware feature. diff --git a/drivers/infiniband/ulp/ipoib/Kconfig b/drivers/infiniband/ulp/ipoib/Kconfig index d74653d..c75322d 100644 --- a/drivers/infiniband/ulp/ipoib/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/infiniband/ulp/ipoib/Kconfig @@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ config INFINIBAND_IPOIB_DEBUG_DATA bool "IP-over-InfiniBand data path debugging" depends on INFINIBAND_IPOIB_DEBUG ---help--- - This option compiles debugging code into the the data path + This option compiles debugging code into the data path of the IPoIB driver. The output can be turned on via the data_debug_level module parameter; however, even with output turned off, this debugging code will have some performance diff --git a/drivers/input/joystick/Kconfig b/drivers/input/joystick/Kconfig index 67519ef..2712634 100644 --- a/drivers/input/joystick/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/input/joystick/Kconfig @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ config JOYSTICK_ANALOG module will be called analog. config JOYSTICK_A3D - tristate "Assasin 3D and MadCatz Panther devices" + tristate "Assassin 3D and MadCatz Panther devices" select GAMEPORT help Say Y here if you have an FPGaming or MadCatz controller using the diff --git a/drivers/input/keyboard/Kconfig b/drivers/input/keyboard/Kconfig index c62e00c..679bde3 100644 --- a/drivers/input/keyboard/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/input/keyboard/Kconfig @@ -177,7 +177,7 @@ config KEYBOARD_HIL_OLD However, it has been thoroughly tested and is stable. If you want full HIL support including support for multiple - keyboards, mices and tablets, you have to enable the + keyboards, mice, and tablets, you have to enable the "HP System Device Controller i8042 Support" in the input/serio submenu. diff --git a/drivers/input/serio/Kconfig b/drivers/input/serio/Kconfig index 98acf17..8cdbfec 100644 --- a/drivers/input/serio/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/input/serio/Kconfig @@ -115,9 +115,9 @@ config HP_SDC depends on GSC && SERIO default y ---help--- - This option enables supports for the the "System Device + This option enables support for the "System Device Controller", an i8042 carrying microcode to manage a - few miscellanous devices on some Hewlett Packard systems. + few miscellaneous devices on some Hewlett Packard systems. The SDC itself contains a 10ms resolution timer/clock capable of delivering interrupts on a periodic and one-shot basis. The SDC may also be connected to a battery-backed real-time diff --git a/drivers/isdn/hardware/eicon/Kconfig b/drivers/isdn/hardware/eicon/Kconfig index 51e66bc..01d4afd 100644 --- a/drivers/isdn/hardware/eicon/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/isdn/hardware/eicon/Kconfig @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ config ISDN_DIVAS_MAINT tristate "DIVA Maint driver support" depends on ISDN_DIVAS && m help - Enable Divas Maintainance driver. + Enable Divas Maintenance driver. endmenu diff --git a/drivers/isdn/hisax/Kconfig b/drivers/isdn/hisax/Kconfig index 6dfc941..eb57a98 100644 --- a/drivers/isdn/hisax/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/isdn/hisax/Kconfig @@ -321,7 +321,7 @@ config HISAX_HFC_PCI help This enables HiSax support for the HFC-S PCI 2BDS0 based cards. - For more informations see under + For more information see under <file:Documentation/isdn/README.hfc-pci>. config HISAX_W6692 diff --git a/drivers/isdn/hisax/amd7930_fn.h b/drivers/isdn/hisax/amd7930_fn.h index e039c3a..1f4d80c 100644 --- a/drivers/isdn/hisax/amd7930_fn.h +++ b/drivers/isdn/hisax/amd7930_fn.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* 2001/10/02 +/* drivers/isdn/hisax/amd7930_fn.h * * gerdes_amd7930.h Header-file included by * gerdes_amd7930.c diff --git a/drivers/leds/led-class.c b/drivers/leds/led-class.c index d424b44..aecbbe2 100644 --- a/drivers/leds/led-class.c +++ b/drivers/leds/led-class.c @@ -125,7 +125,7 @@ EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(led_classdev_register); /** * led_classdev_unregister - unregisters a object of led_properties class. - * @led_cdev: the led device to unreigister + * @led_cdev: the led device to unregister * * Unregisters a previously registered via led_classdev_register object. */ diff --git a/drivers/leds/leds-locomo.c b/drivers/leds/leds-locomo.c index 3b87951..6f2d449 100644 --- a/drivers/leds/leds-locomo.c +++ b/drivers/leds/leds-locomo.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/leds/locomo.c + * linux/drivers/leds/leds-locomo.c * * Copyright (C) 2005 John Lenz <lenz@cs.wisc.edu> * diff --git a/drivers/macintosh/Kconfig b/drivers/macintosh/Kconfig index d5d649f..7f8477d 100644 --- a/drivers/macintosh/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/macintosh/Kconfig @@ -186,7 +186,7 @@ config THERM_ADT746X depends on I2C && I2C_POWERMAC && PPC_PMAC && !PPC_PMAC64 help This driver provides some thermostat and fan control for the - iBook G4, and the ATI based aluminium PowerBooks, allowing slighlty + iBook G4, and the ATI based aluminium PowerBooks, allowing slightly better fan behaviour by default, and some manual control. config THERM_PM72 diff --git a/drivers/macintosh/adbhid.c b/drivers/macintosh/adbhid.c index efd51e0..b7fb367 100644 --- a/drivers/macintosh/adbhid.c +++ b/drivers/macintosh/adbhid.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/input/adbhid.c + * drivers/macintosh/adbhid.c * * ADB HID driver for Power Macintosh computers. * diff --git a/drivers/md/md.c b/drivers/md/md.c index 38a0a57..cb82816 100644 --- a/drivers/md/md.c +++ b/drivers/md/md.c @@ -4438,8 +4438,7 @@ static int md_release(struct inode *inode, struct file * file) { mddev_t *mddev = inode->i_bdev->bd_disk->private_data; - if (!mddev) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!mddev); mddev_put(mddev); return 0; diff --git a/drivers/md/raid5.c b/drivers/md/raid5.c index 37e4ff6..e14f457 100644 --- a/drivers/md/raid5.c +++ b/drivers/md/raid5.c @@ -1105,7 +1105,7 @@ static void compute_parity6(struct stripe_head *sh, int method) if (test_and_clear_bit(R5_Overlap, &sh->dev[i].flags)) wake_up(&conf->wait_for_overlap); - if (sh->dev[i].written) BUG(); + BUG_ON(sh->dev[i].written); sh->dev[i].written = chosen; } break; diff --git a/drivers/media/dvb/cinergyT2/Kconfig b/drivers/media/dvb/cinergyT2/Kconfig index b5cdd57..3d778c5 100644 --- a/drivers/media/dvb/cinergyT2/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/media/dvb/cinergyT2/Kconfig @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ config DVB_CINERGYT2_QUERY_INTERVAL measurements. Please keep in mind that these updates cause traffic on the tuner - control bus and thus may or may not affect receiption sensitivity. + control bus and thus may or may not affect reception sensitivity. The default value should be a safe choice for common applications. diff --git a/drivers/media/radio/Kconfig b/drivers/media/radio/Kconfig index 7015517..6d96b17 100644 --- a/drivers/media/radio/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/media/radio/Kconfig @@ -195,8 +195,7 @@ config RADIO_MIROPCM20_RDS ---help--- Choose Y here if you want to see RDS/RBDS information like RadioText, Programme Service name, Clock Time and date, Programme - TYpe and Traffic Announcement/Programme identification. You also - need to say Y to "miroSOUND PCM20 radio" and devfs! + Type and Traffic Announcement/Programme identification. It's not possible to read the raw RDS packets from the device, so the driver cant provide an V4L interface for this. But the diff --git a/drivers/media/video/Kconfig b/drivers/media/video/Kconfig index 5c53fe6..afb734d 100644 --- a/drivers/media/video/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/media/video/Kconfig @@ -353,7 +353,7 @@ config VIDEO_SAA6588 help Support for Radio Data System (RDS) decoder. This allows seeing radio station identification transmitted using this standard. - Currentlly, it works only with bt8x8 chips. + Currently, it works only with bt8x8 chips. To compile this driver as a module, choose M here: the module will be called saa6588. diff --git a/drivers/media/video/cx88/Kconfig b/drivers/media/video/cx88/Kconfig index 51d68f3..0f9d969 100644 --- a/drivers/media/video/cx88/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/media/video/cx88/Kconfig @@ -69,6 +69,6 @@ config VIDEO_CX88_VP3054 depends on VIDEO_CX88_DVB && DVB_MT352 ---help--- This adds DVB-T support for cards based on the - Connexant 2388x chip and the MT352 demodulator, + Conexant 2388x chip and the MT352 demodulator, which also require support for the VP-3054 Secondary I2C bus, such at DNTV Live! DVB-T Pro. diff --git a/drivers/media/video/pwc/philips.txt b/drivers/media/video/pwc/philips.txt index 11f751a..f5e8484 100644 --- a/drivers/media/video/pwc/philips.txt +++ b/drivers/media/video/pwc/philips.txt @@ -175,8 +175,8 @@ dev_hint - If a device node is already occupied, registration will fail and the webcam is not available. - You can have up to 64 video devices; be sure to make enough device - nodes in /dev if you want to spread the numbers (this does not apply - to devfs). After /dev/video9 comes /dev/video10 (not /dev/videoA). + nodes in /dev if you want to spread the numbers. + After /dev/video9 comes /dev/video10 (not /dev/videoA). - If a camera does not match any dev_hint, it will simply get assigned the first available device node, just as it used to be. diff --git a/drivers/mtd/chips/Kconfig b/drivers/mtd/chips/Kconfig index 6d8f30d..72e6d73 100644 --- a/drivers/mtd/chips/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/mtd/chips/Kconfig @@ -270,7 +270,7 @@ config MTD_JEDEC tristate "JEDEC device support" depends on MTD && MTD_OBSOLETE_CHIPS && BROKEN help - Enable older older JEDEC flash interface devices for self + Enable older JEDEC flash interface devices for self programming flash. It is commonly used in older AMD chips. It is only called JEDEC because the JEDEC association <http://www.jedec.org/> distributes the identification codes for the diff --git a/drivers/mtd/maps/bast-flash.c b/drivers/mtd/maps/bast-flash.c index 51f962d..e074bb6 100644 --- a/drivers/mtd/maps/bast-flash.c +++ b/drivers/mtd/maps/bast-flash.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/drivers/mtd/maps/bast_flash.c +/* linux/drivers/mtd/maps/bast-flash.c * * Copyright (c) 2004-2005 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/drivers/mtd/maps/dmv182.c b/drivers/mtd/maps/dmv182.c index a43c499..e0558b0 100644 --- a/drivers/mtd/maps/dmv182.c +++ b/drivers/mtd/maps/dmv182.c @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ /* - * drivers/mtd/maps/svme182.c + * drivers/mtd/maps/dmv182.c * * Flash map driver for the Dy4 SVME182 board * diff --git a/drivers/mtd/nand/Kconfig b/drivers/mtd/nand/Kconfig index c99302e..1831340 100644 --- a/drivers/mtd/nand/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/mtd/nand/Kconfig @@ -21,7 +21,7 @@ config MTD_NAND_VERIFY_WRITE NAND flash device internally checks only bits transitioning from 1 to 0. There is a rare possibility that even though the device thinks the write was successful, a bit could have been - flipped accidentaly due to device wear or something else. + flipped accidentally due to device wear or something else. config MTD_NAND_ECC_SMC bool "NAND ECC Smart Media byte order" diff --git a/drivers/mtd/onenand/Kconfig b/drivers/mtd/onenand/Kconfig index 465961b..373bddc 100644 --- a/drivers/mtd/onenand/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/mtd/onenand/Kconfig @@ -21,7 +21,7 @@ config MTD_ONENAND_VERIFY_WRITE OneNAND flash device internally checks only bits transitioning from 1 to 0. There is a rare possibility that even though the device thinks the write was successful, a bit could have been - flipped accidentaly due to device wear or something else. + flipped accidentally due to device wear or something else. config MTD_ONENAND_GENERIC tristate "OneNAND Flash device via platform device driver" diff --git a/drivers/net/Kconfig b/drivers/net/Kconfig index ff8a8c0..ab92cc7 100644 --- a/drivers/net/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/net/Kconfig @@ -2115,7 +2115,7 @@ config SKY2 depends on PCI && EXPERIMENTAL select CRC32 ---help--- - This driver supports Gigabit Ethernet adapters based on the the + This driver supports Gigabit Ethernet adapters based on the Marvell Yukon 2 chipset: Marvell 88E8021/88E8022/88E8035/88E8036/88E8038/88E8050/88E8052/ 88E8053/88E8055/88E8061/88E8062, SysKonnect SK-9E21D/SK-9S21 diff --git a/drivers/net/arm/am79c961a.h b/drivers/net/arm/am79c961a.h index 6a49ac7..483009f 100644 --- a/drivers/net/arm/am79c961a.h +++ b/drivers/net/arm/am79c961a.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/net/am79c961.h + * linux/drivers/net/arm/am79c961a.h * * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version 2 as diff --git a/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_debug.h b/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_debug.h index 5761389..6c7dccc 100644 --- a/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_debug.h +++ b/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_debug.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_ocp_debug.h + * drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_debug.h * * Driver for PowerPC 4xx on-chip ethernet controller, debug print routines. * diff --git a/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_rgmii.h b/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_rgmii.h index 94abde5..117ea48 100644 --- a/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_rgmii.h +++ b/drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_rgmii.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_rgmii.c + * drivers/net/ibm_emac/ibm_emac_rgmii.h * * Driver for PowerPC 4xx on-chip ethernet controller, RGMII bridge support. * diff --git a/drivers/net/tokenring/tmspci.c b/drivers/net/tokenring/tmspci.c index 7d3e270..3b2f00b 100644 --- a/drivers/net/tokenring/tmspci.c +++ b/drivers/net/tokenring/tmspci.c @@ -224,8 +224,7 @@ static void __devexit tms_pci_detach (struct pci_dev *pdev) { struct net_device *dev = pci_get_drvdata(pdev); - if (!dev) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!dev); unregister_netdev(dev); release_region(dev->base_addr, TMS_PCI_IO_EXTENT); free_irq(dev->irq, dev); diff --git a/drivers/net/wireless/Kconfig b/drivers/net/wireless/Kconfig index bd4a68c..ece3d9c 100644 --- a/drivers/net/wireless/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/net/wireless/Kconfig @@ -301,7 +301,7 @@ config HERMES tristate "Hermes chipset 802.11b support (Orinoco/Prism2/Symbol)" depends on NET_RADIO && (PPC_PMAC || PCI || PCMCIA) ---help--- - A driver for 802.11b wireless cards based based on the "Hermes" or + A driver for 802.11b wireless cards based on the "Hermes" or Intersil HFA384x (Prism 2) MAC controller. This includes the vast majority of the PCMCIA 802.11b cards (which are nearly all rebadges) - except for the Cisco/Aironet cards. Cards supported include the diff --git a/drivers/parisc/power.c b/drivers/parisc/power.c index 4a9f025..2eb3577 100644 --- a/drivers/parisc/power.c +++ b/drivers/parisc/power.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/parisc/kernel/power.c + * linux/drivers/parisc/power.c * HP PARISC soft power switch support driver * * Copyright (c) 2001-2005 Helge Deller <deller@gmx.de> diff --git a/drivers/parport/daisy.c b/drivers/parport/daisy.c index fd41e28..83ee095 100644 --- a/drivers/parport/daisy.c +++ b/drivers/parport/daisy.c @@ -30,7 +30,7 @@ #undef DEBUG #ifdef DEBUG -#define DPRINTK(stuff...) printk (stuff) +#define DPRINTK(stuff...) printk(stuff) #else #define DPRINTK(stuff...) #endif @@ -46,16 +46,16 @@ static DEFINE_SPINLOCK(topology_lock); static int numdevs = 0; /* Forward-declaration of lower-level functions. */ -static int mux_present (struct parport *port); -static int num_mux_ports (struct parport *port); -static int select_port (struct parport *port); -static int assign_addrs (struct parport *port); +static int mux_present(struct parport *port); +static int num_mux_ports(struct parport *port); +static int select_port(struct parport *port); +static int assign_addrs(struct parport *port); /* Add a device to the discovered topology. */ -static void add_dev (int devnum, struct parport *port, int daisy) +static void add_dev(int devnum, struct parport *port, int daisy) { struct daisydev *newdev, **p; - newdev = kmalloc (sizeof (struct daisydev), GFP_KERNEL); + newdev = kmalloc(sizeof(struct daisydev), GFP_KERNEL); if (newdev) { newdev->port = port; newdev->daisy = daisy; @@ -70,9 +70,9 @@ static void add_dev (int devnum, struct parport *port, int daisy) } /* Clone a parport (actually, make an alias). */ -static struct parport *clone_parport (struct parport *real, int muxport) +static struct parport *clone_parport(struct parport *real, int muxport) { - struct parport *extra = parport_register_port (real->base, + struct parport *extra = parport_register_port(real->base, real->irq, real->dma, real->ops); @@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ static struct parport *clone_parport (struct parport *real, int muxport) /* Discover the IEEE1284.3 topology on a port -- muxes and daisy chains. * Return value is number of devices actually detected. */ -int parport_daisy_init (struct parport *port) +int parport_daisy_init(struct parport *port) { int detected = 0; char *deviceid; @@ -103,26 +103,26 @@ again: /* If mux present on normal port, need to create new * parports for each extra port. */ - if (port->muxport < 0 && mux_present (port) && + if (port->muxport < 0 && mux_present(port) && /* don't be fooled: a mux must have 2 or 4 ports. */ - ((num_ports = num_mux_ports (port)) == 2 || num_ports == 4)) { + ((num_ports = num_mux_ports(port)) == 2 || num_ports == 4)) { /* Leave original as port zero. */ port->muxport = 0; - printk (KERN_INFO + printk(KERN_INFO "%s: 1st (default) port of %d-way multiplexor\n", port->name, num_ports); for (i = 1; i < num_ports; i++) { /* Clone the port. */ - struct parport *extra = clone_parport (port, i); + struct parport *extra = clone_parport(port, i); if (!extra) { - if (signal_pending (current)) + if (signal_pending(current)) break; - schedule (); + schedule(); continue; } - printk (KERN_INFO + printk(KERN_INFO "%s: %d%s port of %d-way multiplexor on %s\n", extra->name, i + 1, th[i + 1], num_ports, port->name); @@ -135,34 +135,34 @@ again: } if (port->muxport >= 0) - select_port (port); + select_port(port); - parport_daisy_deselect_all (port); - detected += assign_addrs (port); + parport_daisy_deselect_all(port); + detected += assign_addrs(port); /* Count the potential legacy device at the end. */ - add_dev (numdevs++, port, -1); + add_dev(numdevs++, port, -1); /* Find out the legacy device's IEEE 1284 device ID. */ - deviceid = kmalloc (1024, GFP_KERNEL); + deviceid = kmalloc(1024, GFP_KERNEL); if (deviceid) { - if (parport_device_id (numdevs - 1, deviceid, 1024) > 2) + if (parport_device_id(numdevs - 1, deviceid, 1024) > 2) detected++; - kfree (deviceid); + kfree(deviceid); } if (!detected && !last_try) { /* No devices were detected. Perhaps they are in some funny state; let's try to reset them and see if they wake up. */ - parport_daisy_fini (port); - parport_write_control (port, PARPORT_CONTROL_SELECT); - udelay (50); - parport_write_control (port, + parport_daisy_fini(port); + parport_write_control(port, PARPORT_CONTROL_SELECT); + udelay(50); + parport_write_control(port, PARPORT_CONTROL_SELECT | PARPORT_CONTROL_INIT); - udelay (50); + udelay(50); last_try = 1; goto again; } @@ -171,7 +171,7 @@ again: } /* Forget about devices on a physical port. */ -void parport_daisy_fini (struct parport *port) +void parport_daisy_fini(struct parport *port) { struct daisydev **p; @@ -214,7 +214,7 @@ void parport_daisy_fini (struct parport *port) * for parport_register_device(). **/ -struct pardevice *parport_open (int devnum, const char *name, +struct pardevice *parport_open(int devnum, const char *name, int (*pf) (void *), void (*kf) (void *), void (*irqf) (int, void *, struct pt_regs *), int flags, void *handle) @@ -237,7 +237,7 @@ struct pardevice *parport_open (int devnum, const char *name, port = parport_get_port(p->port); spin_unlock(&topology_lock); - dev = parport_register_device (port, name, pf, kf, + dev = parport_register_device(port, name, pf, kf, irqf, flags, handle); parport_put_port(port); if (!dev) @@ -248,13 +248,13 @@ struct pardevice *parport_open (int devnum, const char *name, /* Check that there really is a device to select. */ if (daisy >= 0) { int selected; - parport_claim_or_block (dev); + parport_claim_or_block(dev); selected = port->daisy; - parport_release (dev); + parport_release(dev); if (selected != daisy) { /* No corresponding device. */ - parport_unregister_device (dev); + parport_unregister_device(dev); return NULL; } } @@ -270,9 +270,9 @@ struct pardevice *parport_open (int devnum, const char *name, * parport_register_device(). **/ -void parport_close (struct pardevice *dev) +void parport_close(struct pardevice *dev) { - parport_unregister_device (dev); + parport_unregister_device(dev); } /** @@ -287,7 +287,7 @@ void parport_close (struct pardevice *dev) * exists. **/ -int parport_device_num (int parport, int mux, int daisy) +int parport_device_num(int parport, int mux, int daisy) { int res = -ENXIO; struct daisydev *dev; @@ -305,16 +305,16 @@ int parport_device_num (int parport, int mux, int daisy) } /* Send a daisy-chain-style CPP command packet. */ -static int cpp_daisy (struct parport *port, int cmd) +static int cpp_daisy(struct parport *port, int cmd) { unsigned char s; - parport_data_forward (port); - parport_write_data (port, 0xaa); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x55); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x00); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0xff); udelay (2); - s = parport_read_status (port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY + parport_data_forward(port); + parport_write_data(port, 0xaa); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x55); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x00); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0xff); udelay(2); + s = parport_read_status(port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY | PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT | PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); @@ -322,54 +322,54 @@ static int cpp_daisy (struct parport *port, int cmd) | PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT | PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR)) { - DPRINTK (KERN_DEBUG "%s: cpp_daisy: aa5500ff(%02x)\n", + DPRINTK(KERN_DEBUG "%s: cpp_daisy: aa5500ff(%02x)\n", port->name, s); return -ENXIO; } - parport_write_data (port, 0x87); udelay (2); - s = parport_read_status (port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY + parport_write_data(port, 0x87); udelay(2); + s = parport_read_status(port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY | PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT | PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); if (s != (PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR)) { - DPRINTK (KERN_DEBUG "%s: cpp_daisy: aa5500ff87(%02x)\n", + DPRINTK(KERN_DEBUG "%s: cpp_daisy: aa5500ff87(%02x)\n", port->name, s); return -ENXIO; } - parport_write_data (port, 0x78); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, cmd); udelay (2); - parport_frob_control (port, + parport_write_data(port, 0x78); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, cmd); udelay(2); + parport_frob_control(port, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE); - udelay (1); - s = parport_read_status (port); - parport_frob_control (port, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE, 0); - udelay (1); - parport_write_data (port, 0xff); udelay (2); + udelay(1); + s = parport_read_status(port); + parport_frob_control(port, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE, 0); + udelay(1); + parport_write_data(port, 0xff); udelay(2); return s; } /* Send a mux-style CPP command packet. */ -static int cpp_mux (struct parport *port, int cmd) +static int cpp_mux(struct parport *port, int cmd) { unsigned char s; int rc; - parport_data_forward (port); - parport_write_data (port, 0xaa); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x55); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0xf0); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x0f); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x52); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0xad); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, cmd); udelay (2); + parport_data_forward(port); + parport_write_data(port, 0xaa); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x55); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0xf0); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x0f); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x52); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0xad); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, cmd); udelay(2); - s = parport_read_status (port); + s = parport_read_status(port); if (!(s & PARPORT_STATUS_ACK)) { - DPRINTK (KERN_DEBUG "%s: cpp_mux: aa55f00f52ad%02x(%02x)\n", + DPRINTK(KERN_DEBUG "%s: cpp_mux: aa55f00f52ad%02x(%02x)\n", port->name, cmd, s); return -EIO; } @@ -382,12 +382,12 @@ static int cpp_mux (struct parport *port, int cmd) return rc; } -void parport_daisy_deselect_all (struct parport *port) +void parport_daisy_deselect_all(struct parport *port) { - cpp_daisy (port, 0x30); + cpp_daisy(port, 0x30); } -int parport_daisy_select (struct parport *port, int daisy, int mode) +int parport_daisy_select(struct parport *port, int daisy, int mode) { switch (mode) { @@ -395,14 +395,14 @@ int parport_daisy_select (struct parport *port, int daisy, int mode) case IEEE1284_MODE_EPP: case IEEE1284_MODE_EPPSL: case IEEE1284_MODE_EPPSWE: - return !(cpp_daisy (port, 0x20 + daisy) & + return !(cpp_daisy(port, 0x20 + daisy) & PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); // For these modes we should switch to ECP mode: case IEEE1284_MODE_ECP: case IEEE1284_MODE_ECPRLE: case IEEE1284_MODE_ECPSWE: - return !(cpp_daisy (port, 0xd0 + daisy) & + return !(cpp_daisy(port, 0xd0 + daisy) & PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); // Nothing was told for BECP in Daisy chain specification. @@ -413,28 +413,28 @@ int parport_daisy_select (struct parport *port, int daisy, int mode) case IEEE1284_MODE_BYTE: case IEEE1284_MODE_COMPAT: default: - return !(cpp_daisy (port, 0xe0 + daisy) & + return !(cpp_daisy(port, 0xe0 + daisy) & PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); } } -static int mux_present (struct parport *port) +static int mux_present(struct parport *port) { - return cpp_mux (port, 0x51) == 3; + return cpp_mux(port, 0x51) == 3; } -static int num_mux_ports (struct parport *port) +static int num_mux_ports(struct parport *port) { - return cpp_mux (port, 0x58); + return cpp_mux(port, 0x58); } -static int select_port (struct parport *port) +static int select_port(struct parport *port) { int muxport = port->muxport; - return cpp_mux (port, 0x60 + muxport) == muxport; + return cpp_mux(port, 0x60 + muxport) == muxport; } -static int assign_addrs (struct parport *port) +static int assign_addrs(struct parport *port) { unsigned char s; unsigned char daisy; @@ -442,12 +442,12 @@ static int assign_addrs (struct parport *port) int detected; char *deviceid; - parport_data_forward (port); - parport_write_data (port, 0xaa); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x55); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0x00); udelay (2); - parport_write_data (port, 0xff); udelay (2); - s = parport_read_status (port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY + parport_data_forward(port); + parport_write_data(port, 0xaa); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x55); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0x00); udelay(2); + parport_write_data(port, 0xff); udelay(2); + s = parport_read_status(port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY | PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT | PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); @@ -455,40 +455,40 @@ static int assign_addrs (struct parport *port) | PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT | PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR)) { - DPRINTK (KERN_DEBUG "%s: assign_addrs: aa5500ff(%02x)\n", + DPRINTK(KERN_DEBUG "%s: assign_addrs: aa5500ff(%02x)\n", port->name, s); return 0; } - parport_write_data (port, 0x87); udelay (2); - s = parport_read_status (port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY + parport_write_data(port, 0x87); udelay(2); + s = parport_read_status(port) & (PARPORT_STATUS_BUSY | PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT | PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR); if (s != (PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT | PARPORT_STATUS_ERROR)) { - DPRINTK (KERN_DEBUG "%s: assign_addrs: aa5500ff87(%02x)\n", + DPRINTK(KERN_DEBUG "%s: assign_addrs: aa5500ff87(%02x)\n", port->name, s); return 0; } - parport_write_data (port, 0x78); udelay (2); - s = parport_read_status (port); + parport_write_data(port, 0x78); udelay(2); + s = parport_read_status(port); for (daisy = 0; (s & (PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT|PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT)) == (PARPORT_STATUS_PAPEROUT|PARPORT_STATUS_SELECT) && daisy < 4; ++daisy) { - parport_write_data (port, daisy); - udelay (2); - parport_frob_control (port, + parport_write_data(port, daisy); + udelay(2); + parport_frob_control(port, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE); - udelay (1); - parport_frob_control (port, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE, 0); - udelay (1); + udelay(1); + parport_frob_control(port, PARPORT_CONTROL_STROBE, 0); + udelay(1); - add_dev (numdevs++, port, daisy); + add_dev(numdevs++, port, daisy); /* See if this device thought it was the last in the * chain. */ @@ -499,21 +499,21 @@ static int assign_addrs (struct parport *port) last_dev from next device or if last_dev does not work status lines from some non-daisy chain device. */ - s = parport_read_status (port); + s = parport_read_status(port); } - parport_write_data (port, 0xff); udelay (2); + parport_write_data(port, 0xff); udelay(2); detected = numdevs - thisdev; - DPRINTK (KERN_DEBUG "%s: Found %d daisy-chained devices\n", port->name, + DPRINTK(KERN_DEBUG "%s: Found %d daisy-chained devices\n", port->name, detected); /* Ask the new devices to introduce themselves. */ - deviceid = kmalloc (1024, GFP_KERNEL); + deviceid = kmalloc(1024, GFP_KERNEL); if (!deviceid) return 0; for (daisy = 0; thisdev < numdevs; thisdev++, daisy++) - parport_device_id (thisdev, deviceid, 1024); + parport_device_id(thisdev, deviceid, 1024); - kfree (deviceid); + kfree(deviceid); return detected; } diff --git a/drivers/pci/hotplug/Kconfig b/drivers/pci/hotplug/Kconfig index 8a60f39..6e780db 100644 --- a/drivers/pci/hotplug/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/pci/hotplug/Kconfig @@ -157,7 +157,7 @@ config HOTPLUG_PCI_RPA tristate "RPA PCI Hotplug driver" depends on HOTPLUG_PCI && PPC_PSERIES && PPC64 && !HOTPLUG_PCI_FAKE help - Say Y here if you have a a RPA system that supports PCI Hotplug. + Say Y here if you have a RPA system that supports PCI Hotplug. To compile this driver as a module, choose M here: the module will be called rpaphp. diff --git a/drivers/rapidio/Kconfig b/drivers/rapidio/Kconfig index 0b2d2c3..4142115 100644 --- a/drivers/rapidio/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/rapidio/Kconfig @@ -15,4 +15,4 @@ config RAPIDIO_DISC_TIMEOUT default "30" ---help--- Amount of time a discovery node waits for a host to complete - enumeration beforing giving up. + enumeration before giving up. diff --git a/drivers/rtc/rtc-max6902.c b/drivers/rtc/rtc-max6902.c index 9eeef96..2f0b777 100644 --- a/drivers/rtc/rtc-max6902.c +++ b/drivers/rtc/rtc-max6902.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* drivers/char/max6902.c +/* drivers/rtc/rtc-max6902.c * * Copyright (C) 2006 8D Technologies inc. * Copyright (C) 2004 Compulab Ltd. diff --git a/drivers/sbus/char/cpwatchdog.c b/drivers/sbus/char/cpwatchdog.c index 836a58b..40b6fc86 100644 --- a/drivers/sbus/char/cpwatchdog.c +++ b/drivers/sbus/char/cpwatchdog.c @@ -10,8 +10,6 @@ * timer interrupts. We use a timer to periodically * reset 'stopped' watchdogs on affected platforms. * - * TODO: DevFS support (/dev/watchdogs/0 ... /dev/watchdogs/2) - * * Copyright (c) 2000 Eric Brower (ebrower@usa.net) */ diff --git a/drivers/scsi/Kconfig b/drivers/scsi/Kconfig index dab0820..c6dfb6fa 100644 --- a/drivers/scsi/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/scsi/Kconfig @@ -40,10 +40,10 @@ config SCSI_PROC_FS default y ---help--- This option enables support for the various files in - /proc/scsi. In Linux 2.6 this has been superceeded by + /proc/scsi. In Linux 2.6 this has been superseded by files in sysfs but many legacy applications rely on this. - If unusure say Y. + If unsure say Y. comment "SCSI support type (disk, tape, CD-ROM)" depends on SCSI @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ config CHR_DEV_OSST tristate "SCSI OnStream SC-x0 tape support" depends on SCSI ---help--- - The OnStream SC-x0 SCSI tape drives can not be driven by the + The OnStream SC-x0 SCSI tape drives cannot be driven by the standard st driver, but instead need this special osst driver and use the /dev/osstX char device nodes (major 206). Via usb-storage and ide-scsi, you may be able to drive the USB-x0 and DI-x0 drives diff --git a/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic79xx b/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic79xx index 7955ebe..911ea17 100644 --- a/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic79xx +++ b/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic79xx @@ -22,12 +22,12 @@ config AIC79XX_CMDS_PER_DEVICE to be used for any device. The aic7xxx driver will automatically vary this number based on device behavior. For devices with a fixed maximum, the driver will eventually lock to this maximum - and display a console message inidicating this value. + and display a console message indicating this value. Due to resource allocation issues in the Linux SCSI mid-layer, using a high number of commands per device may result in memory allocation failures when many devices are attached to the system. For this reason, - the default is set to 32. Higher values may result in higer performance + the default is set to 32. Higher values may result in higher performance on some devices. The upper bound is 253. 0 disables tagged queueing. Per device tag depth can be controlled via the kernel command line diff --git a/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic7xxx b/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic7xxx index 5517da5..cd93f9a 100644 --- a/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic7xxx +++ b/drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/Kconfig.aic7xxx @@ -27,12 +27,12 @@ config AIC7XXX_CMDS_PER_DEVICE to be used for any device. The aic7xxx driver will automatically vary this number based on device behavior. For devices with a fixed maximum, the driver will eventually lock to this maximum - and display a console message inidicating this value. + and display a console message indicating this value. Due to resource allocation issues in the Linux SCSI mid-layer, using a high number of commands per device may result in memory allocation failures when many devices are attached to the system. For this reason, - the default is set to 32. Higher values may result in higer performance + the default is set to 32. Higher values may result in higher performance on some devices. The upper bound is 253. 0 disables tagged queueing. Per device tag depth can be controlled via the kernel command line diff --git a/drivers/scsi/arm/arxescsi.c b/drivers/scsi/arm/arxescsi.c index a289401..4385e9e 100644 --- a/drivers/scsi/arm/arxescsi.c +++ b/drivers/scsi/arm/arxescsi.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/drivers/scsi/arxescsi.c + * linux/drivers/scsi/arm/arxescsi.c * * Copyright (C) 1997-2000 Russell King, Stefan Hanske * diff --git a/drivers/serial/21285.c b/drivers/serial/21285.c index 5743832..76d83ad 100644 --- a/drivers/serial/21285.c +++ b/drivers/serial/21285.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/char/21285.c + * linux/drivers/serial/21285.c * * Driver for the serial port on the 21285 StrongArm-110 core logic chip. * diff --git a/drivers/serial/Kconfig b/drivers/serial/Kconfig index d926272..653098b 100644 --- a/drivers/serial/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/serial/Kconfig @@ -121,7 +121,7 @@ config SERIAL_8250_RUNTIME_UARTS default "4" help Set this to the maximum number of serial ports you want - the kernel to register at boot time. This can be overriden + the kernel to register at boot time. This can be overridden with the module parameter "nr_uarts", or boot-time parameter 8250.nr_uarts @@ -205,7 +205,7 @@ config SERIAL_8250_BOCA depends on SERIAL_8250 != n && ISA && SERIAL_8250_MANY_PORTS help Say Y here if you have a Boca serial board. Please read the Boca - mini-HOWTO, avaialble from <http://www.tldp.org/docs.html#howto> + mini-HOWTO, available from <http://www.tldp.org/docs.html#howto> To compile this driver as a module, choose M here: the module will be called 8250_boca. @@ -667,7 +667,7 @@ config SERIAL_68328 depends on M68328 || M68EZ328 || M68VZ328 help This driver supports the built-in serial port of the Motorola 68328 - (standard, EZ and VZ varities). + (standard, EZ and VZ varieties). config SERIAL_68328_RTS_CTS bool "Support RTS/CTS on 68328 serial port" diff --git a/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm1.h b/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm1.h index 5d867ab..5eb49ea 100644 --- a/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm1.h +++ b/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm1.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/serial/cpm_uart_cpm1.h + * linux/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm1.h * * Driver for CPM (SCC/SMC) serial ports * diff --git a/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm2.h b/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm2.h index a663300..4b77911 100644 --- a/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm2.h +++ b/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm2.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/serial/cpm_uart_cpm2.h + * linux/drivers/serial/cpm_uart/cpm_uart_cpm2.h * * Driver for CPM (SCC/SMC) serial ports * diff --git a/drivers/usb/atm/Kconfig b/drivers/usb/atm/Kconfig index 550ddfa7..b450cba 100644 --- a/drivers/usb/atm/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/usb/atm/Kconfig @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ config USB_XUSBATM Say Y here if you have a DSL USB modem not explicitly supported by another USB DSL drivers. In order to use your modem you will need to pass the vendor ID, product ID, and endpoint numbers for transmission - and reception as module parameters. You may need to initialize the + and reception as module parameters. You may need to initialize the modem using a user space utility (a firmware loader for example). To compile this driver as a module, choose M here: the diff --git a/drivers/usb/core/file.c b/drivers/usb/core/file.c index c376c65..f794f07 100644 --- a/drivers/usb/core/file.c +++ b/drivers/usb/core/file.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/usb/file.c + * drivers/usb/core/file.c * * (C) Copyright Linus Torvalds 1999 * (C) Copyright Johannes Erdfelt 1999-2001 diff --git a/drivers/usb/core/usb.c b/drivers/usb/core/usb.c index e4df9ed..467cb02 100644 --- a/drivers/usb/core/usb.c +++ b/drivers/usb/core/usb.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * drivers/usb/usb.c + * drivers/usb/core/usb.c * * (C) Copyright Linus Torvalds 1999 * (C) Copyright Johannes Erdfelt 1999-2001 diff --git a/drivers/usb/gadget/Kconfig b/drivers/usb/gadget/Kconfig index 8e5dd6f..bbbc82a 100644 --- a/drivers/usb/gadget/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/usb/gadget/Kconfig @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ # # - Host systems (like PCs) need CONFIG_USB (with "A" jacks). # - Peripherals (like PDAs) need CONFIG_USB_GADGET (with "B" jacks). -# - Some systems have both kinds of of controller. +# - Some systems have both kinds of controllers. # # With help from a special transceiver and a "Mini-AB" jack, systems with # both kinds of controller can also support "USB On-the-Go" (CONFIG_USB_OTG). diff --git a/drivers/usb/storage/Kconfig b/drivers/usb/storage/Kconfig index 422a4b2..fe2c4cd 100644 --- a/drivers/usb/storage/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/usb/storage/Kconfig @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ config USB_STORAGE_ALAUDA Say Y here to include additional code to support the Olympus MAUSB-10 and Fujifilm DPC-R1 USB Card reader/writer devices. - These devices are based on the Alauda chip and support support both + These devices are based on the Alauda chip and support both XD and SmartMedia cards. config USB_STORAGE_ONETOUCH diff --git a/drivers/video/Kconfig b/drivers/video/Kconfig index a1c8923..daaa486 100644 --- a/drivers/video/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/video/Kconfig @@ -188,7 +188,7 @@ config FB_ARMCLCD_SHARP_LQ035Q7DB02_HRTFT bool "LogicPD LCD 3.5\" QVGA w/HRTFT IC" help This is an implementation of the Sharp LQ035Q7DB02, a 3.5" - color QVGA, HRTFT panel. The LogicPD device includes an + color QVGA, HRTFT panel. The LogicPD device includes an integrated HRTFT controller IC. The native resolution is 240x320. @@ -403,7 +403,7 @@ config FB_ARC is based on the KS-108 lcd controller and is typically a matrix of 2*n chips. This driver was tested with a 128x64 panel. This driver supports it for use with x86 SBCs through a 16 bit GPIO - interface (8 bit data, 8 bit control). If you anticpate using + interface (8 bit data, 8 bit control). If you anticipate using this driver, say Y or M; otherwise say N. You must specify the GPIO IO address to be used for setting control and data. @@ -771,7 +771,7 @@ config FB_RIVA_DEBUG default n help Say Y here if you want the Riva driver to output all sorts - of debugging informations to provide to the maintainer when + of debugging information to provide to the maintainer when something goes wrong. config FB_RIVA_BACKLIGHT @@ -865,7 +865,7 @@ config FB_INTEL_DEBUG depends on FB_INTEL ---help--- Say Y here if you want the Intel driver to output all sorts - of debugging informations to provide to the maintainer when + of debugging information to provide to the maintainer when something goes wrong. config FB_INTEL_I2C @@ -1062,7 +1062,7 @@ config FB_RADEON_DEBUG default n help Say Y here if you want the Radeon driver to output all sorts - of debugging informations to provide to the maintainer when + of debugging information to provide to the maintainer when something goes wrong. config FB_ATY128 diff --git a/drivers/video/s3c2410fb.h b/drivers/video/s3c2410fb.h index be40968..f3f8a8e 100644 --- a/drivers/video/s3c2410fb.h +++ b/drivers/video/s3c2410fb.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/s3c2410fb.h + * linux/drivers/video/s3c2410fb.h * Copyright (c) Arnaud Patard * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public diff --git a/drivers/w1/Kconfig b/drivers/w1/Kconfig index 8b3d0f0..27c9d05 100644 --- a/drivers/w1/Kconfig +++ b/drivers/w1/Kconfig @@ -21,7 +21,7 @@ config W1_CON There are three types of messages between w1 core and userspace: 1. Events. They are generated each time new master or slave device found either due to automatic or requested search. - 2. Userspace commands. Includes read/write and search/alarm search comamnds. + 2. Userspace commands. Includes read/write and search/alarm search commands. 3. Replies to userspace commands. source drivers/w1/masters/Kconfig @@ -74,11 +74,11 @@ config EXT3_FS tristate "Ext3 journalling file system support" select JBD help - This is the journaling version of the Second extended file system + This is the journalling version of the Second extended file system (often called ext3), the de facto standard Linux file system (method to organize files on a storage device) for hard disks. - The journaling code included in this driver means you do not have + The journalling code included in this driver means you do not have to run e2fsck (file system checker) on your file systems after a crash. The journal keeps track of any changes that were being made at the time the system crashed, and can ensure that your file system @@ -143,7 +143,7 @@ config EXT3_FS_SECURITY config JBD tristate help - This is a generic journaling layer for block devices. It is + This is a generic journalling layer for block devices. It is currently used by the ext3 and OCFS2 file systems, but it could also be used to add journal support to other file systems or block devices such as RAID or LVM. @@ -183,7 +183,7 @@ config REISERFS_FS tristate "Reiserfs support" help Stores not just filenames but the files themselves in a balanced - tree. Uses journaling. + tree. Uses journalling. Balanced trees are more efficient than traditional file system architectural foundations. @@ -1032,7 +1032,7 @@ config BEFS_FS on files and directories, and database-like indeces on selected attributes. (Also note that this driver doesn't make those features available at this time). It is a 64 bit filesystem, so it supports - extremly large volumes and files. + extremely large volumes and files. If you use this filesystem, you should also say Y to at least one of the NLS (native language support) options below. @@ -1090,7 +1090,7 @@ config JFFS_FS tristate "Journalling Flash File System (JFFS) support" depends on MTD && BLOCK help - JFFS is the Journaling Flash File System developed by Axis + JFFS is the Journalling Flash File System developed by Axis Communications in Sweden, aimed at providing a crash/powerdown-safe file system for disk-less embedded devices. Further information is available at (<http://developer.axis.com/software/jffs/>). @@ -1260,7 +1260,7 @@ config JFFS2_CMODE_NONE config JFFS2_CMODE_PRIORITY bool "priority" help - Tries the compressors in a predefinied order and chooses the first + Tries the compressors in a predefined order and chooses the first successful one. config JFFS2_CMODE_SIZE @@ -1365,7 +1365,7 @@ config SYSV_FS If you have floppies or hard disk partitions like that, it is likely that they contain binaries from those other Unix systems; in order - to run these binaries, you will want to install linux-abi which is a + to run these binaries, you will want to install linux-abi which is a set of kernel modules that lets you run SCO, Xenix, Wyse, UnixWare, Dell Unix and System V programs under Linux. It is available via FTP (user: ftp) from @@ -1950,7 +1950,7 @@ config AFS_FS If you say Y here, you will get an experimental Andrew File System driver. It currently only supports unsecured read-only AFS access. - See <file:Documentation/filesystems/afs.txt> for more intormation. + See <file:Documentation/filesystems/afs.txt> for more information. If unsure, say N. diff --git a/fs/befs/befs_fs_types.h b/fs/befs/befs_fs_types.h index 9095518..63ef1e1 100644 --- a/fs/befs/befs_fs_types.h +++ b/fs/befs/befs_fs_types.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/linux/befs_fs_types.h + * fs/befs/befs_fs_types.h * * Copyright (C) 2001 Will Dyson (will@cs.earlham.edu) * diff --git a/fs/cifs/README b/fs/cifs/README index 5f0e1bd..432e515 100644 --- a/fs/cifs/README +++ b/fs/cifs/README @@ -269,7 +269,7 @@ A partial list of the supported mount options follows: (gid) mount option is specified. For the uid (gid) of newly created files and directories, ie files created since the last mount of the server share, the expected uid - (gid) is cached as as long as the inode remains in + (gid) is cached as long as the inode remains in memory on the client. Also note that permission checks (authorization checks) on accesses to a file occur at the server, but there are cases in which an administrator @@ -375,7 +375,7 @@ A partial list of the supported mount options follows: the local process on newly created files, directories, and devices (create, mkdir, mknod). If the CIFS Unix Extensions are not negotiated, for newly created files and directories - instead of using the default uid and gid specified on the + instead of using the default uid and gid specified on the mount, cache the new file's uid and gid locally which means that the uid for the file can change when the inode is reloaded (or the user remounts the share). @@ -440,7 +440,7 @@ A partial list of the supported mount options follows: create device files and fifos in a format compatible with Services for Unix (SFU). In addition retrieve bits 10-12 of the mode via the SETFILEBITS extended attribute (as - SFU does). In the future the bottom 9 bits of the mode + SFU does). In the future the bottom 9 bits of the mode also will be emulated using queries of the security descriptor (ACL). sign Must use packet signing (helps avoid unwanted data modification diff --git a/fs/debugfs/inode.c b/fs/debugfs/inode.c index ecf3da9e..e77676d 100644 --- a/fs/debugfs/inode.c +++ b/fs/debugfs/inode.c @@ -252,7 +252,7 @@ EXPORT_SYMBOL_GPL(debugfs_create_dir); * * This function removes a file or directory in debugfs that was previously * created with a call to another debugfs function (like - * debufs_create_file() or variants thereof.) + * debugfs_create_file() or variants thereof.) * * This function is required to be called in order for the file to be * removed, no automatic cleanup of files will happen when a module is diff --git a/fs/hfsplus/part_tbl.c b/fs/hfsplus/part_tbl.c index ae78306..1528a6f 100644 --- a/fs/hfsplus/part_tbl.c +++ b/fs/hfsplus/part_tbl.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/hfs/part_tbl.c + * linux/fs/hfsplus/part_tbl.c * * Copyright (C) 1996-1997 Paul H. Hargrove * This file may be distributed under the terms of the GNU General Public License. diff --git a/fs/jbd/commit.c b/fs/jbd/commit.c index 32a8caf..10be512 100644 --- a/fs/jbd/commit.c +++ b/fs/jbd/commit.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/commit.c + * linux/fs/jbd/commit.c * * Written by Stephen C. Tweedie <sct@redhat.com>, 1998 * diff --git a/fs/jbd/journal.c b/fs/jbd/journal.c index 7af6099..c518dd8 100644 --- a/fs/jbd/journal.c +++ b/fs/jbd/journal.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/journal.c + * linux/fs/jbd/journal.c * * Written by Stephen C. Tweedie <sct@redhat.com>, 1998 * diff --git a/fs/nfsd/nfs2acl.c b/fs/nfsd/nfs2acl.c index fc95c4d..fe56b38 100644 --- a/fs/nfsd/nfs2acl.c +++ b/fs/nfsd/nfs2acl.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nfsd/nfsacl.c + * linux/fs/nfsd/nfs2acl.c * * Process version 2 NFSACL requests. * diff --git a/fs/nfsd/nfs4xdr.c b/fs/nfsd/nfs4xdr.c index 5446a08..5be0043 100644 --- a/fs/nfsd/nfs4xdr.c +++ b/fs/nfsd/nfs4xdr.c @@ -198,8 +198,7 @@ static char *savemem(struct nfsd4_compoundargs *argp, u32 *p, int nbytes) p = new; memcpy(p, argp->tmp, nbytes); } else { - if (p != argp->tmpp) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(p != argp->tmpp); argp->tmpp = NULL; } if (defer_free(argp, kfree, p)) { diff --git a/fs/nfsd/nfsxdr.c b/fs/nfsd/nfsxdr.c index e3a0797..3f14a17 100644 --- a/fs/nfsd/nfsxdr.c +++ b/fs/nfsd/nfsxdr.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nfsd/xdr.c + * linux/fs/nfsd/nfsxdr.c * * XDR support for nfsd * diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_ascii.c b/fs/nls/nls_ascii.c index b83381c..6993fae 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_ascii.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_ascii.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_ascii.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_ascii.c * * Charset ascii translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_base.c b/fs/nls/nls_base.c index b1317ad..7dfdab9 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_base.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_base.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_base.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_base.c * * Native language support--charsets and unicode translations. * By Gordon Chaffee 1996, 1997 diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp1250.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp1250.c index 32e78cf..570aa69 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp1250.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp1250.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp1250.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp1250.c * * Charset cp1250 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp1251.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp1251.c index cb41c8a..f114afa 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp1251.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp1251.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp1251.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp1251.c * * Charset cp1251 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp1255.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp1255.c index efdeefe..e57f2cb 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp1255.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp1255.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp1255.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp1255.c * * Charset cp1255 translation tables. * The Unicode to charset table has only exact mappings. diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp437.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp437.c index 5c4a1cd..d41930c 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp437.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp437.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp437.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp437.c * * Charset cp437 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp737.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp737.c index e8b3ca8..d21f879 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp737.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp737.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp737.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp737.c * * Charset cp737 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp775.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp775.c index bdb290e..c97714c 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp775.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp775.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp775.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp775.c * * Charset cp775 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp850.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp850.c index 25deaa4..843b7d9 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp850.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp850.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp850.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp850.c * * Charset cp850 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp852.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp852.c index b822a7b..83cfd84 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp852.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp852.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp852.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp852.c * * Charset cp852 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp855.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp855.c index e8641b7..9190b7b 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp855.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp855.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp855.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp855.c * * Charset cp855 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp857.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp857.c index 7ba589e..ef3d36d 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp857.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp857.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp857.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp857.c * * Charset cp857 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp860.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp860.c index 3b9e49c..7e2fb66 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp860.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp860.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp860.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp860.c * * Charset cp860 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp861.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp861.c index 959ff64..66d8d80 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp861.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp861.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp861.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp861.c * * Charset cp861 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp862.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp862.c index b96928f..360ba38 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp862.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp862.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp862.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp862.c * * Charset cp862 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp863.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp863.c index baa6e0e..656a931 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp863.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp863.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp863.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp863.c * * Charset cp863 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp864.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp864.c index f4dabb0..01ca730 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp864.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp864.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp864.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp864.c * * Charset cp864 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp865.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp865.c index 4caeafa..5ba6ee1 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp865.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp865.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp865.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp865.c * * Charset cp865 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp866.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp866.c index f2b4a9a..c5f8222 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp866.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp866.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp866.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp866.c * * Charset cp866 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp869.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp869.c index 12b436f..8d40151 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp869.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp869.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp869.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp869.c * * Charset cp869 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp874.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp874.c index b5766a0..df04205 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp874.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp874.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp874.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp874.c * * Charset cp874 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp932.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp932.c index 2c1a17c..2a9ccf3 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp932.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp932.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp932.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp932.c * * Charset cp932 translation tables. * This translation table was generated automatically, the diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp936.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp936.c index ef4cef4..046fde8 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp936.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp936.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp936.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp936.c * * Charset cp936 translation tables. * This translation table was generated automatically, the diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp949.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp949.c index 4351ae2..92ae193 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp949.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp949.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp949.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp949.c * * Charset cp949 translation tables. * This translation table was generated automatically, the diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_cp950.c b/fs/nls/nls_cp950.c index 8167a28..5665945 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_cp950.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_cp950.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_cp950.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_cp950.c * * Charset cp950 translation tables. * This translation table was generated automatically, the diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_euc-jp.c b/fs/nls/nls_euc-jp.c index 06640c3..7329351 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_euc-jp.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_euc-jp.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_euc-jp.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_euc-jp.c * * Added `OSF/JVC Recommended Code Set Conversion Specification * between Japanese EUC and Shift-JIS' support: <hirofumi@mail.parknet.co.jp> diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-1.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-1.c index 70a2c19..2483c3c 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-1.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-1.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-1.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-1.c * * Charset iso8859-1 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-13.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-13.c index 4547035..7b8721d 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-13.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-13.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-13.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-13.c * * Charset iso8859-13 translation tables. * The Unicode to charset table has only exact mappings. diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-14.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-14.c index 13628d0..2e895e6 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-14.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-14.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-14.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-14.c * * Charset iso8859-14 translation tables. * diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-15.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-15.c index 88b924b..5c91592 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-15.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-15.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-15.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-15.c * * Charset iso8859-15 translation tables. * The Unicode to charset table has only exact mappings. diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-2.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-2.c index 372528a..892d38f 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-2.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-2.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-2.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-2.c * * Charset iso8859-2 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-3.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-3.c index 81b45a2..49317bc 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-3.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-3.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-3.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-3.c * * Charset iso8859-3 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-4.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-4.c index 101b87f..9f3b936 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-4.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-4.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-4.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-4.c * * Charset iso8859-4 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-5.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-5.c index 83b0084..001a2bb 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-5.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-5.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-5.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-5.c * * Charset iso8859-5 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-6.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-6.c index 0c519d6..8cec03d 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-6.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-6.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-6.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-6.c * * Charset iso8859-6 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-7.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-7.c index bd08546..1be707d 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-7.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-7.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-7.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-7.c * * Charset iso8859-7 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-9.c b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-9.c index 988eff7..8c0146f 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-9.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-9.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_iso8859-9.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_iso8859-9.c * * Charset iso8859-9 translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_koi8-r.c b/fs/nls/nls_koi8-r.c index 0ad22c2..fefbe08 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_koi8-r.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_koi8-r.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_koi8-r.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_koi8-r.c * * Charset koi8-r translation tables. * Generated automatically from the Unicode and charset diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_koi8-ru.c b/fs/nls/nls_koi8-ru.c index 5db83ef..e7bc1d7 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_koi8-ru.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_koi8-ru.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_koi8-ru.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_koi8-ru.c * * Charset koi8-ru translation based on charset koi8-u. * The Unicode to charset table has only exact mappings. diff --git a/fs/nls/nls_koi8-u.c b/fs/nls/nls_koi8-u.c index 9d30fd6..0150702 100644 --- a/fs/nls/nls_koi8-u.c +++ b/fs/nls/nls_koi8-u.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/fs/nls_koi8-u.c + * linux/fs/nls/nls_koi8-u.c * * Charset koi8-u translation tables. * The Unicode to charset table has only exact mappings. diff --git a/fs/reiserfs/file.c b/fs/reiserfs/file.c index 41f2436..c093642 100644 --- a/fs/reiserfs/file.c +++ b/fs/reiserfs/file.c @@ -38,8 +38,7 @@ static int reiserfs_file_release(struct inode *inode, struct file *filp) int err; int jbegin_failure = 0; - if (!S_ISREG(inode->i_mode)) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!S_ISREG(inode->i_mode)); /* fast out for when nothing needs to be done */ if ((atomic_read(&inode->i_count) > 1 || @@ -125,8 +124,7 @@ static int reiserfs_sync_file(struct file *p_s_filp, int n_err; int barrier_done; - if (!S_ISREG(p_s_inode->i_mode)) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!S_ISREG(p_s_inode->i_mode)); n_err = sync_mapping_buffers(p_s_inode->i_mapping); reiserfs_write_lock(p_s_inode->i_sb); barrier_done = reiserfs_commit_for_inode(p_s_inode); diff --git a/fs/reiserfs/item_ops.c b/fs/reiserfs/item_ops.c index 7a88adb..b9b423b 100644 --- a/fs/reiserfs/item_ops.c +++ b/fs/reiserfs/item_ops.c @@ -75,8 +75,7 @@ static int sd_create_vi(struct virtual_node *vn, static int sd_check_left(struct virtual_item *vi, int free, int start_skip, int end_skip) { - if (start_skip || end_skip) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(start_skip || end_skip); return -1; } @@ -87,8 +86,7 @@ static int sd_check_right(struct virtual_item *vi, int free) static int sd_part_size(struct virtual_item *vi, int first, int count) { - if (count) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(count); return 0; } @@ -476,8 +474,7 @@ static int direntry_create_vi(struct virtual_node *vn, vi->vi_index = TYPE_DIRENTRY; - if (!(vi->vi_ih) || !vi->vi_item) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!(vi->vi_ih) || !vi->vi_item); dir_u->flags = 0; if (le_ih_k_offset(vi->vi_ih) == DOT_OFFSET) @@ -575,8 +572,7 @@ static int direntry_check_right(struct virtual_item *vi, int free) free -= dir_u->entry_sizes[i]; entries++; } - if (entries == dir_u->entry_count) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(entries == dir_u->entry_count); /* "." and ".." can not be separated from each other */ if ((dir_u->flags & DIRENTRY_VI_FIRST_DIRENTRY_ITEM) diff --git a/fs/reiserfs/journal.c b/fs/reiserfs/journal.c index e6b5ccf..ad8cbc4 100644 --- a/fs/reiserfs/journal.c +++ b/fs/reiserfs/journal.c @@ -718,8 +718,7 @@ static int add_to_chunk(struct buffer_chunk *chunk, struct buffer_head *bh, spinlock_t * lock, void (fn) (struct buffer_chunk *)) { int ret = 0; - if (chunk->nr >= CHUNK_SIZE) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(chunk->nr >= CHUNK_SIZE); chunk->bh[chunk->nr++] = bh; if (chunk->nr >= CHUNK_SIZE) { ret = 1; @@ -788,8 +787,7 @@ static inline int __add_jh(struct reiserfs_journal *j, struct buffer_head *bh, /* buffer must be locked for __add_jh, should be able to have * two adds at the same time */ - if (bh->b_private) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(bh->b_private); jh->bh = bh; bh->b_private = jh; } @@ -2967,8 +2965,7 @@ static int do_journal_begin_r(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, int retval; reiserfs_check_lock_depth(p_s_sb, "journal_begin"); - if (nblocks > journal->j_trans_max) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(nblocks > journal->j_trans_max); PROC_INFO_INC(p_s_sb, journal.journal_being); /* set here for journal_join */ @@ -3084,9 +3081,8 @@ struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *reiserfs_persistent_transaction(struct if (reiserfs_transaction_running(s)) { th = current->journal_info; th->t_refcount++; - if (th->t_refcount < 2) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(th->t_refcount < 2); + return th; } th = kmalloc(sizeof(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle), GFP_NOFS); @@ -3126,9 +3122,7 @@ static int journal_join(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, ** pointer */ th->t_handle_save = cur_th; - if (cur_th && cur_th->t_refcount > 1) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(cur_th && cur_th->t_refcount > 1); return do_journal_begin_r(th, p_s_sb, nblocks, JBEGIN_JOIN); } @@ -3141,9 +3135,7 @@ int journal_join_abort(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, ** pointer */ th->t_handle_save = cur_th; - if (cur_th && cur_th->t_refcount > 1) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(cur_th && cur_th->t_refcount > 1); return do_journal_begin_r(th, p_s_sb, nblocks, JBEGIN_ABORT); } @@ -3178,8 +3170,7 @@ int journal_begin(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, current->journal_info = th; } ret = do_journal_begin_r(th, p_s_sb, nblocks, JBEGIN_REG); - if (current->journal_info != th) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(current->journal_info != th); /* I guess this boils down to being the reciprocal of clm-2100 above. * If do_journal_begin_r fails, we need to put it back, since journal_end @@ -3324,8 +3315,7 @@ int journal_end(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, /* we aren't allowed to close a nested transaction on a different ** filesystem from the one in the task struct */ - if (cur_th->t_super != th->t_super) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(cur_th->t_super != th->t_super); if (th != cur_th) { memcpy(current->journal_info, th, sizeof(*th)); @@ -3444,9 +3434,7 @@ int journal_end_sync(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, BUG_ON(!th->t_trans_id); /* you can sync while nested, very, very bad */ - if (th->t_refcount > 1) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(th->t_refcount > 1); if (journal->j_len == 0) { reiserfs_prepare_for_journal(p_s_sb, SB_BUFFER_WITH_SB(p_s_sb), 1); @@ -3556,9 +3544,8 @@ static int check_journal_end(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, ** will be dealt with by next transaction that actually writes something, but should be taken ** care of in this trans */ - if (journal->j_len == 0) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(journal->j_len == 0); + /* if wcount > 0, and we are called to with flush or commit_now, ** we wait on j_join_wait. We will wake up when the last writer has ** finished the transaction, and started it on its way to the disk. @@ -3592,9 +3579,8 @@ static int check_journal_end(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, unlock_journal(p_s_sb); } } - if (journal->j_trans_id == trans_id) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(journal->j_trans_id == trans_id); + if (commit_now && journal_list_still_alive(p_s_sb, trans_id) && wait_on_commit) { @@ -4074,9 +4060,7 @@ static int do_journal_end(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, set_commit_trans_len(commit, journal->j_len); /* special check in case all buffers in the journal were marked for not logging */ - if (journal->j_len == 0) { - BUG(); - } + BUG_ON(journal->j_len == 0); /* we're about to dirty all the log blocks, mark the description block * dirty now too. Don't mark the commit block dirty until all the @@ -4173,8 +4157,7 @@ static int do_journal_end(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, journal, jl, &jl->j_tail_bh_list); lock_kernel(); } - if (!list_empty(&jl->j_tail_bh_list)) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(!list_empty(&jl->j_tail_bh_list)); up(&jl->j_commit_lock); /* honor the flush wishes from the caller, simple commits can diff --git a/fs/reiserfs/namei.c b/fs/reiserfs/namei.c index 16e9cff..abde1ed 100644 --- a/fs/reiserfs/namei.c +++ b/fs/reiserfs/namei.c @@ -67,8 +67,7 @@ inline void set_de_name_and_namelen(struct reiserfs_dir_entry *de) { struct reiserfs_de_head *deh = de->de_deh + de->de_entry_num; - if (de->de_entry_num >= ih_entry_count(de->de_ih)) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(de->de_entry_num >= ih_entry_count(de->de_ih)); de->de_entrylen = entry_length(de->de_bh, de->de_ih, de->de_entry_num); de->de_namelen = de->de_entrylen - (de_with_sd(deh) ? SD_SIZE : 0); @@ -80,8 +79,7 @@ inline void set_de_name_and_namelen(struct reiserfs_dir_entry *de) // what entry points to static inline void set_de_object_key(struct reiserfs_dir_entry *de) { - if (de->de_entry_num >= ih_entry_count(de->de_ih)) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(de->de_entry_num >= ih_entry_count(de->de_ih)); de->de_dir_id = deh_dir_id(&(de->de_deh[de->de_entry_num])); de->de_objectid = deh_objectid(&(de->de_deh[de->de_entry_num])); } @@ -90,8 +88,7 @@ static inline void store_de_entry_key(struct reiserfs_dir_entry *de) { struct reiserfs_de_head *deh = de->de_deh + de->de_entry_num; - if (de->de_entry_num >= ih_entry_count(de->de_ih)) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(de->de_entry_num >= ih_entry_count(de->de_ih)); /* store key of the found entry */ de->de_entry_key.version = KEY_FORMAT_3_5; diff --git a/fs/reiserfs/stree.c b/fs/reiserfs/stree.c index 8b9b131..5240abe 100644 --- a/fs/reiserfs/stree.c +++ b/fs/reiserfs/stree.c @@ -1476,9 +1476,7 @@ static int maybe_indirect_to_direct(struct reiserfs_transaction_handle *th, int n_block_size = p_s_sb->s_blocksize; int cut_bytes; BUG_ON(!th->t_trans_id); - - if (n_new_file_size != p_s_inode->i_size) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(n_new_file_size != p_s_inode->i_size); /* the page being sent in could be NULL if there was an i/o error ** reading in the last block. The user will hit problems trying to diff --git a/fs/xfs/support/debug.c b/fs/xfs/support/debug.c index 36fbecc..c75f683 100644 --- a/fs/xfs/support/debug.c +++ b/fs/xfs/support/debug.c @@ -53,8 +53,7 @@ cmn_err(register int level, char *fmt, ...) va_end(ap); spin_unlock_irqrestore(&xfs_err_lock,flags); - if (level == CE_PANIC) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(level == CE_PANIC); } void @@ -72,8 +71,7 @@ icmn_err(register int level, char *fmt, va_list ap) strcat(message, "\n"); spin_unlock_irqrestore(&xfs_err_lock,flags); printk("%s%s", err_level[level], message); - if (level == CE_PANIC) - BUG(); + BUG_ON(level == CE_PANIC); } void diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-clps711x/entry-macro.S b/include/asm-arm/arch-clps711x/entry-macro.S index 21f6ee4..de4481d 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-clps711x/entry-macro.S +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-clps711x/entry-macro.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-arm/arch-CLPS711x/entry-macro.S + * include/asm-arm/arch-clps711x/entry-macro.S * * Low-level IRQ helper macros for CLPS711X-based platforms * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-ebsa285/entry-macro.S b/include/asm-arm/arch-ebsa285/entry-macro.S index cf10ac9..ce812d4 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-ebsa285/entry-macro.S +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-ebsa285/entry-macro.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-arm/arch-footbridge/entry-macro.S + * include/asm-arm/arch-ebsa285/entry-macro.S * * Low-level IRQ helper macros for footbridge-based platforms * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-h720x/system.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-h720x/system.h index 09eda84..8dc1460 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-h720x/system.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-h720x/system.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/arch/arm/mach-h720x/system.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-h720x/system.h * * Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Jungjun Kim, Hynix Semiconductor Inc. * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-ixp4xx/system.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-ixp4xx/system.h index 73589aa..8e1db42 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-ixp4xx/system.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-ixp4xx/system.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-arm/arch-ixp4x//system.h + * include/asm-arm/arch-ixp4xx/system.h * * Copyright (C) 2002 Intel Corporation. * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/dmtimer.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/dmtimer.h index b5f3a71..fefb276 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/dmtimer.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/dmtimer.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/arm/arch-omap/dmtimer.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/dmtimer.h * * OMAP Dual-Mode Timers * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/mcbsp.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/mcbsp.h index ed0dde4..c7a0cc1 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/mcbsp.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/mcbsp.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/gpio.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/mcbsp.h * * Defines for Multi-Channel Buffered Serial Port * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/pm.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/pm.h index e46623c..1458805 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/pm.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/pm.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm/arch-omap/pm.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-omap/pm.h * * Header file for OMAP Power Management Routines * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-pnx4008/platform.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-pnx4008/platform.h index 485a365..2613c7c 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-pnx4008/platform.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-pnx4008/platform.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-arm/arch-pnx4008/platfrom.h + * include/asm-arm/arch-pnx4008/platform.h * * PNX4008 Base addresses - header file * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/fb.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/fb.h index 7116179..9089421 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/fb.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/fb.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/fb.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/fb.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org> * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-adc.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-adc.h index c7b90b3..3196a28 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-adc.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-adc.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-adc.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-adc.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Shannon Holland <holland@loser.net> * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-clock.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-clock.h index b2f4690..e39656b 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-clock.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-clock.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-clock.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-clock.h * * Copyright (c) 2003,2004,2005,2006 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://armlinux.simtec.co.uk/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-dsc.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-dsc.h index a0a1248..c074851 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-dsc.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-dsc.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/hardware/s3c2410/regs-dsc.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-dsc.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpio.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpio.h index 93c4943..b2893e3 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpio.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpio.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/hardware/s3c2410/regs-gpio.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpio.h * * Copyright (c) 2003,2004 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpioj.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpioj.h index 91cefa2..02131a5 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpioj.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpioj.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/hardware/s3c2410/regs-gpioj.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-gpioj.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-iis.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-iis.h index 72cd250..eaf7791 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-iis.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-iis.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-iis.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-iis.h * * Copyright (c) 2003 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-irq.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-irq.h index 29fb8ef..498184c 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-irq.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-irq.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-irq.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-irq.h * * Copyright (c) 2003 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-lcd.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-lcd.h index 6d7881c..b7faeb0 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-lcd.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-lcd.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-lcd.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-lcd.h * * Copyright (c) 2003 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-rtc.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-rtc.h index cd88fd6..93b03c4 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-rtc.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-rtc.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-rtc.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-rtc.h * * Copyright (c) 2003 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-sdi.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-sdi.h index 06e716e..bb9d30b 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-sdi.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-sdi.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-sdi.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-sdi.h * * Copyright (c) 2004 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-timer.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-timer.h index 731918e..6f8fe43 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-timer.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-timer.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-timer.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-timer.h * * Copyright (c) 2003 Simtec Electronics <linux@simtec.co.uk> * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-udc.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-udc.h index 3aa31a2..487861d 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-udc.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-udc.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm/arch-s3c2410/regs-udc.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/regs-udc.h * * Copyright (C) 2004 Herbert Poetzl <herbert@13thfloor.at> * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/spi-gpio.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/spi-gpio.h index 258c00b..c1e4db7 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/spi-gpio.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/spi-gpio.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/spi.h +/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-s3c2410/spi-gpio.h * * Copyright (c) 2006 Simtec Electronics * Ben Dooks <ben@simtec.co.uk> diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/neponset.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/neponset.h index 8051fd7..09ec9e2 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/neponset.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/neponset.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/assabet.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/neponset.h * * Created 2000/06/05 by Nicolas Pitre <nico@cam.org> * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/uncompress.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/uncompress.h index 2601a77..17e64d2 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/uncompress.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/uncompress.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-brutus/uncompress.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-sa1100/uncompress.h * * (C) 1999 Nicolas Pitre <nico@cam.org> * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/arch-shark/vmalloc.h b/include/asm-arm/arch-shark/vmalloc.h index 10db5d1..fac37c63 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/arch-shark/vmalloc.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/arch-shark/vmalloc.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-rpc/vmalloc.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/arch-shark/vmalloc.h */ #define VMALLOC_END (PAGE_OFFSET + 0x10000000) diff --git a/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-8250.S b/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-8250.S index 4594fea..07c97fb 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-8250.S +++ b/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-8250.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-8250.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-8250.S * * Copyright (C) 1994-1999 Russell King * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-pl01x.S b/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-pl01x.S index db0d0f7..23c541a 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-pl01x.S +++ b/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-pl01x.S @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-integrator/debug-macro.S +/* linux/include/asm-arm/hardware/debug-pl01x.S * * Debugging macro include header * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/hardware/entry-macro-iomd.S b/include/asm-arm/hardware/entry-macro-iomd.S index 30c7b92..fbed08f 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/hardware/entry-macro-iomd.S +++ b/include/asm-arm/hardware/entry-macro-iomd.S @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * arch/arm/commond/entry-macro-iomd.S + * include/asm-arm/hardware/entry-macro-iomd.S * * Low-level IRQ helper macros for IOC/IOMD based platforms * diff --git a/include/asm-arm/hardware/sa1111.h b/include/asm-arm/hardware/sa1111.h index 319aea0..6aa0a5b 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm/hardware/sa1111.h +++ b/include/asm-arm/hardware/sa1111.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/hardware/SA-1111.h + * linux/include/asm-arm/hardware/sa1111.h * * Copyright (C) 2000 John G Dorsey <john+@cs.cmu.edu> * diff --git a/include/asm-arm26/assembler.h b/include/asm-arm26/assembler.h index 83f9aec..bb507a9 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm26/assembler.h +++ b/include/asm-arm26/assembler.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/asm/assembler.h + * linux/include/asm-arm26/assembler.h * * This file contains arm architecture specific defines * for the different processors. diff --git a/include/asm-arm26/namei.h b/include/asm-arm26/namei.h index a402d3b..3f5d340 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm26/namei.h +++ b/include/asm-arm26/namei.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/namei.h + * linux/include/asm-arm26/namei.h * * Routines to handle famous /usr/gnemul * Derived from the Sparc version of this file diff --git a/include/asm-arm26/semaphore.h b/include/asm-arm26/semaphore.h index ccf15e7..1fda543 100644 --- a/include/asm-arm26/semaphore.h +++ b/include/asm-arm26/semaphore.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-arm/semaphore.h + * linux/include/asm-arm26/semaphore.h */ #ifndef __ASM_ARM_SEMAPHORE_H #define __ASM_ARM_SEMAPHORE_H diff --git a/include/asm-frv/namei.h b/include/asm-frv/namei.h index 84ddd64..4ea5717 100644 --- a/include/asm-frv/namei.h +++ b/include/asm-frv/namei.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * asm/namei.h + * include/asm-frv/namei.h * * Included from linux/fs/namei.c */ diff --git a/include/asm-generic/mutex-dec.h b/include/asm-generic/mutex-dec.h index 29c6ac3..0134151 100644 --- a/include/asm-generic/mutex-dec.h +++ b/include/asm-generic/mutex-dec.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * asm-generic/mutex-dec.h + * include/asm-generic/mutex-dec.h * * Generic implementation of the mutex fastpath, based on atomic * decrement/increment. diff --git a/include/asm-generic/mutex-null.h b/include/asm-generic/mutex-null.h index 254a126..e1bbbc7 100644 --- a/include/asm-generic/mutex-null.h +++ b/include/asm-generic/mutex-null.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * asm-generic/mutex-null.h + * include/asm-generic/mutex-null.h * * Generic implementation of the mutex fastpath, based on NOP :-) * diff --git a/include/asm-generic/mutex-xchg.h b/include/asm-generic/mutex-xchg.h index 32a2100..6a7e8c1 100644 --- a/include/asm-generic/mutex-xchg.h +++ b/include/asm-generic/mutex-xchg.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * asm-generic/mutex-xchg.h + * include/asm-generic/mutex-xchg.h * * Generic implementation of the mutex fastpath, based on xchg(). * diff --git a/include/asm-generic/rtc.h b/include/asm-generic/rtc.h index 4087037..d3238f1f 100644 --- a/include/asm-generic/rtc.h +++ b/include/asm-generic/rtc.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * inclue/asm-generic/rtc.h + * include/asm-generic/rtc.h * * Author: Tom Rini <trini@mvista.com> * diff --git a/include/asm-generic/tlb.h b/include/asm-generic/tlb.h index 867d900..f490e43 100644 --- a/include/asm-generic/tlb.h +++ b/include/asm-generic/tlb.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* asm-generic/tlb.h +/* include/asm-generic/tlb.h * * Generic TLB shootdown code * diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/m32104ut/m32104ut_pld.h b/include/asm-m32r/m32104ut/m32104ut_pld.h index 6ba4ddf..cbdbc58 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/m32104ut/m32104ut_pld.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/m32104ut/m32104ut_pld.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/m32104ut/m32104ut_pld.h + * include/asm-m32r/m32104ut/m32104ut_pld.h * * Definitions for Programable Logic Device(PLD) on M32104UT board. * Based on m32700ut_pld.h diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lan.h b/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lan.h index c050b19..f1e47ae 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lan.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lan.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/m32700ut_lan.h + * include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lan.h * * M32700UT-LAN board * diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lcd.h b/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lcd.h index 4da4e82..e41c4aa 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lcd.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lcd.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/m32700ut_lcd.h + * include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_lcd.h * * M32700UT-LCD board * diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_pld.h b/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_pld.h index f35f915..a48c22c 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_pld.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_pld.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/m32700ut/m32700ut_pld.h + * include/asm-m32r/m32700ut/m32700ut_pld.h * * Definitions for Programable Logic Device(PLD) on M32700UT board. * diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/mappi2/mappi2_pld.h b/include/asm-m32r/mappi2/mappi2_pld.h index 01dcdd1..56a2b12 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/mappi2/mappi2_pld.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/mappi2/mappi2_pld.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/mappi2/mappi2_pld.h + * include/asm-m32r/mappi2/mappi2_pld.h * * Definitions for Extended IO Logic on MAPPI2 board. * based on m32700ut_pld.h by diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/mappi3/mappi3_pld.h b/include/asm-m32r/mappi3/mappi3_pld.h index 031369a..92f10de 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/mappi3/mappi3_pld.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/mappi3/mappi3_pld.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/mappi3/mappi3_pld.h + * include/asm-m32r/mappi3/mappi3_pld.h * * Definitions for Extended IO Logic on MAPPI3 board. * based on m32700ut_pld.h diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lan.h b/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lan.h index 6194829..f53e101 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lan.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lan.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/opsput_lan.h + * include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lan.h * * OPSPUT-LAN board * diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lcd.h b/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lcd.h index 44cfd7f..99f296e 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lcd.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lcd.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/opsput_lcd.h + * include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_lcd.h * * OPSPUT-LCD board * diff --git a/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_pld.h b/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_pld.h index 46296fe..a8d6452 100644 --- a/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_pld.h +++ b/include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_pld.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm/opsput/opsput_pld.h + * include/asm-m32r/opsput/opsput_pld.h * * Definitions for Programable Logic Device(PLD) on OPSPUT board. * diff --git a/include/asm-m68k/rtc.h b/include/asm-m68k/rtc.h index 71406fc..5d3e038 100644 --- a/include/asm-m68k/rtc.h +++ b/include/asm-m68k/rtc.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* asm-m68k/rtc.h +/* include/asm-m68k/rtc.h * * Copyright Richard Zidlicky * implementation details for genrtc/q40rtc driver diff --git a/include/asm-m68knommu/processor.h b/include/asm-m68knommu/processor.h index 9d3a1bf..91cba18 100644 --- a/include/asm-m68knommu/processor.h +++ b/include/asm-m68knommu/processor.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-m68k/processor.h + * include/asm-m68knommu/processor.h * * Copyright (C) 1995 Hamish Macdonald */ diff --git a/include/asm-mips/tx4938/tx4938_mips.h b/include/asm-mips/tx4938/tx4938_mips.h index cf89b20..5f8498f 100644 --- a/include/asm-mips/tx4938/tx4938_mips.h +++ b/include/asm-mips/tx4938/tx4938_mips.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-mips/tx4938/tx4938_bitmask.h + * linux/include/asm-mips/tx4938/tx4938_mips.h * Generic bitmask definitions * * 2003-2005 (c) MontaVista Software, Inc. This file is licensed under the diff --git a/include/asm-parisc/rtc.h b/include/asm-parisc/rtc.h index f3d3d6b..f4ebff1 100644 --- a/include/asm-parisc/rtc.h +++ b/include/asm-parisc/rtc.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * inclue/asm-parisc/rtc.h + * include/asm-parisc/rtc.h * * Copyright 2002 Randolph CHung <tausq@debian.org> * diff --git a/include/asm-powerpc/ipic.h b/include/asm-powerpc/ipic.h index 53079ec..1ce09a3 100644 --- a/include/asm-powerpc/ipic.h +++ b/include/asm-powerpc/ipic.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/ipic.h + * include/asm-powerpc/ipic.h * * IPIC external definitions and structure. * diff --git a/include/asm-ppc/mv64x60_defs.h b/include/asm-ppc/mv64x60_defs.h index f8f7f16..5b0704a 100644 --- a/include/asm-ppc/mv64x60_defs.h +++ b/include/asm-ppc/mv64x60_defs.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/gt64260_defs.h + * include/asm-ppc/mv64x60_defs.h * * Register definitions for the Marvell/Galileo GT64260, MV64360, etc. * host bridges. diff --git a/include/asm-ppc/rheap.h b/include/asm-ppc/rheap.h index 65b9322..39a10d8 100644 --- a/include/asm-ppc/rheap.h +++ b/include/asm-ppc/rheap.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-ppc/rheap.c + * include/asm-ppc/rheap.h * * Header file for the implementation of a remote heap. * diff --git a/include/asm-ppc/rtc.h b/include/asm-ppc/rtc.h index 05fbf91..6025b46 100644 --- a/include/asm-ppc/rtc.h +++ b/include/asm-ppc/rtc.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * inclue/asm-ppc/rtc.h + * include/asm-ppc/rtc.h * * Author: Tom Rini <trini@mvista.com> * diff --git a/include/asm-s390/qdio.h b/include/asm-s390/qdio.h index a2f37a9..7189c79 100644 --- a/include/asm-s390/qdio.h +++ b/include/asm-s390/qdio.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm/qdio.h + * linux/include/asm-s390/qdio.h * * Linux for S/390 QDIO base support, Hipersocket base support * version 2 diff --git a/include/asm-sh/bigsur/io.h b/include/asm-sh/bigsur/io.h index 939735e..1470ac8 100644 --- a/include/asm-sh/bigsur/io.h +++ b/include/asm-sh/bigsur/io.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-sh/io_bigsur.h + * include/asm-sh/bigsur/io.h * * By Dustin McIntire (dustin@sensoria.com) (c)2001 * Derived from io_hd64465.h, which bore the message: diff --git a/include/asm-sh/bigsur/serial.h b/include/asm-sh/bigsur/serial.h index 7233af4..a08fa82 100644 --- a/include/asm-sh/bigsur/serial.h +++ b/include/asm-sh/bigsur/serial.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-sh/serial-bigsur.h + * include/asm-sh/bigsur/serial.h * * Configuration details for Big Sur 16550 based serial ports * i.e. HD64465, PCMCIA, etc. diff --git a/include/asm-sh/dreamcast/sysasic.h b/include/asm-sh/dreamcast/sysasic.h index c885853..7874e3d 100644 --- a/include/asm-sh/dreamcast/sysasic.h +++ b/include/asm-sh/dreamcast/sysasic.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* include/asm-sh/dc_sysasic.h +/* include/asm-sh/dreamcast/sysasic.h * * Definitions for the Dreamcast System ASIC and related peripherals. * diff --git a/include/asm-sh/hd64465/io.h b/include/asm-sh/hd64465/io.h index 1100bcf..139f147 100644 --- a/include/asm-sh/hd64465/io.h +++ b/include/asm-sh/hd64465/io.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-sh/io_hd64465.h + * include/asm-sh/hd64465/io.h * * By Greg Banks <gbanks@pocketpenguins.com> * (c) 2000 PocketPenguins Inc. diff --git a/include/asm-sh/mpc1211/io.h b/include/asm-sh/mpc1211/io.h index eba8a0b..6298370 100644 --- a/include/asm-sh/mpc1211/io.h +++ b/include/asm-sh/mpc1211/io.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-sh/io_mpc1211.h + * include/asm-sh/mpc1211/io.h * * Copyright 2001 Saito.K & Jeanne * diff --git a/include/asm-sh64/serial.h b/include/asm-sh64/serial.h index 29c9be1..e8d7b3f 100644 --- a/include/asm-sh64/serial.h +++ b/include/asm-sh64/serial.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-sh/serial.h + * include/asm-sh64/serial.h * * Configuration details for 8250, 16450, 16550, etc. serial ports */ diff --git a/include/asm-sparc/reg.h b/include/asm-sparc/reg.h index ed60ebe..ea0a7e5 100644 --- a/include/asm-sparc/reg.h +++ b/include/asm-sparc/reg.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/asm-sparc/reg.h + * linux/include/asm-sparc/reg.h * Layout of the registers as expected by gdb on the Sparc * we should replace the user.h definitions with those in * this file, we don't even use the other diff --git a/include/asm-x86_64/cache.h b/include/asm-x86_64/cache.h index ed8a9d25..052df75 100644 --- a/include/asm-x86_64/cache.h +++ b/include/asm-x86_64/cache.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-x8664/cache.h + * include/asm-x86_64/cache.h */ #ifndef __ARCH_X8664_CACHE_H #define __ARCH_X8664_CACHE_H diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/a.out.h b/include/asm-xtensa/a.out.h index 3be701d..ffc4dcf 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/a.out.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/a.out.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-xtensa/addrspace.h + * include/asm-xtensa/a.out.h * * Dummy a.out file. Xtensa does not support the a.out format, but the kernel * seems to depend on it. diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/cache.h b/include/asm-xtensa/cache.h index 5aae3f1..1e79c0e 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/cache.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/cache.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-xtensa/cacheflush.h + * include/asm-xtensa/cache.h * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/coprocessor.h b/include/asm-xtensa/coprocessor.h index a91b96d..5093034 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/coprocessor.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/coprocessor.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-xtensa/cpextra.h + * include/asm-xtensa/coprocessor.h * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/dma-mapping.h b/include/asm-xtensa/dma-mapping.h index c425f10..c39c91d 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/dma-mapping.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/dma-mapping.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-xtensa/dma_mapping.h + * include/asm-xtensa/dma-mapping.h * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/ioctls.h b/include/asm-xtensa/ioctls.h index 3b89a77..39e6f23 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/ioctls.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/ioctls.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-xtensa/ioctl.h + * include/asm-xtensa/ioctls.h * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/pgtable.h b/include/asm-xtensa/pgtable.h index a47cc73..b431893 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/pgtable.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/pgtable.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/asm-xtensa/page.h + * linux/include/asm-xtensa/pgtable.h * * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version2 as diff --git a/include/asm-xtensa/siginfo.h b/include/asm-xtensa/siginfo.h index 44f0ae7..6916248 100644 --- a/include/asm-xtensa/siginfo.h +++ b/include/asm-xtensa/siginfo.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/asm-xtensa/processor.h + * include/asm-xtensa/siginfo.h * * This file is subject to the terms and conditions of the GNU General Public * License. See the file "COPYING" in the main directory of this archive diff --git a/include/linux/aio_abi.h b/include/linux/aio_abi.h index 3466b1d..e3ca0a4 100644 --- a/include/linux/aio_abi.h +++ b/include/linux/aio_abi.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/aio_abi.h +/* include/linux/aio_abi.h * * Copyright 2000,2001,2002 Red Hat. * diff --git a/include/linux/awe_voice.h b/include/linux/awe_voice.h index 4bf9f33..bf33f17 100644 --- a/include/linux/awe_voice.h +++ b/include/linux/awe_voice.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/awe_voice.h + * include/linux/awe_voice.h * * Voice information definitions for the low level driver for the * AWE32/SB32/AWE64 wave table synth. diff --git a/include/linux/harrier_defs.h b/include/linux/harrier_defs.h index 685b252..efef11d 100644 --- a/include/linux/harrier_defs.h +++ b/include/linux/harrier_defs.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * asm-ppc/harrier_defs.h + * include/linux/harrier_defs.h * * Definitions for Motorola MCG Harrier North Bridge & Memory controller * diff --git a/include/linux/lockd/xdr4.h b/include/linux/lockd/xdr4.h index cee36e7..3cc1ae2 100644 --- a/include/linux/lockd/xdr4.h +++ b/include/linux/lockd/xdr4.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/linux/lockd/xdr.h + * linux/include/linux/lockd/xdr4.h * * XDR types for the NLM protocol * diff --git a/include/linux/mtd/plat-ram.h b/include/linux/mtd/plat-ram.h index 2332eda..9667863 100644 --- a/include/linux/mtd/plat-ram.h +++ b/include/linux/mtd/plat-ram.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/include/mtd/plat-ram.h +/* linux/include/linux/mtd/plat-ram.h * * (c) 2004 Simtec Electronics * http://www.simtec.co.uk/products/SWLINUX/ diff --git a/include/linux/nfsd/stats.h b/include/linux/nfsd/stats.h index 28a82fd..7678cfb 100644 --- a/include/linux/nfsd/stats.h +++ b/include/linux/nfsd/stats.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/nfsd/stats.h + * linux/include/linux/nfsd/stats.h * * Statistics for NFS server. * diff --git a/include/linux/nfsd/xdr.h b/include/linux/nfsd/xdr.h index 3f4f714..a38f9d7 100644 --- a/include/linux/nfsd/xdr.h +++ b/include/linux/nfsd/xdr.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/inxlude/linux/nfsd/xdr.h + * linux/include/linux/nfsd/xdr.h * * XDR types for nfsd. This is mainly a typing exercise. */ diff --git a/include/linux/ppdev.h b/include/linux/ppdev.h index f376a75..dc18c5d 100644 --- a/include/linux/ppdev.h +++ b/include/linux/ppdev.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/char/ppdev.h + * linux/include/linux/ppdev.h * * User-space parallel port device driver (header file). * diff --git a/include/linux/slab.h b/include/linux/slab.h index a96fd93..70be57d 100644 --- a/include/linux/slab.h +++ b/include/linux/slab.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/mm/slab.h + * linux/include/linux/slab.h * Written by Mark Hemment, 1996. * (markhe@nextd.demon.co.uk) */ diff --git a/include/linux/sunrpc/auth_gss.h b/include/linux/sunrpc/auth_gss.h index 03084dc..97b62e9 100644 --- a/include/linux/sunrpc/auth_gss.h +++ b/include/linux/sunrpc/auth_gss.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/linux/auth_gss.h + * linux/include/linux/sunrpc/auth_gss.h * * Declarations for RPCSEC_GSS * diff --git a/include/linux/sunrpc/gss_api.h b/include/linux/sunrpc/gss_api.h index 6e112cc..5eca9e4 100644 --- a/include/linux/sunrpc/gss_api.h +++ b/include/linux/sunrpc/gss_api.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/linux/gss_api.h + * linux/include/linux/sunrpc/gss_api.h * * Somewhat simplified version of the gss api. * diff --git a/include/linux/sunrpc/msg_prot.h b/include/linux/sunrpc/msg_prot.h index d9f5934..8d10d14 100644 --- a/include/linux/sunrpc/msg_prot.h +++ b/include/linux/sunrpc/msg_prot.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/net/sunrpc/msg_prot.h + * linux/include/linux/sunrpc/msg_prot.h * * Copyright (C) 1996, Olaf Kirch <okir@monad.swb.de> */ diff --git a/include/linux/sunrpc/svcauth_gss.h b/include/linux/sunrpc/svcauth_gss.h index 3a2206f..5a5db16 100644 --- a/include/linux/sunrpc/svcauth_gss.h +++ b/include/linux/sunrpc/svcauth_gss.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/include/linux/svcauth_gss.h + * linux/include/linux/sunrpc/svcauth_gss.h * * Bruce Fields <bfields@umich.edu> * Copyright (c) 2002 The Regents of the Unviersity of Michigan diff --git a/include/linux/writeback.h b/include/linux/writeback.h index 4f4d98a..a341c80 100644 --- a/include/linux/writeback.h +++ b/include/linux/writeback.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * include/linux/writeback.h. + * include/linux/writeback.h */ #ifndef WRITEBACK_H #define WRITEBACK_H diff --git a/include/video/s1d13xxxfb.h b/include/video/s1d13xxxfb.h index f06cc88..c99d261 100644 --- a/include/video/s1d13xxxfb.h +++ b/include/video/s1d13xxxfb.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* drivers/video/s1d3xxxfb.h +/* include/video/s1d13xxxfb.h * * (c) 2004 Simtec Electronics * (c) 2005 Thibaut VARENE <varenet@parisc-linux.org> diff --git a/ipc/mqueue.c b/ipc/mqueue.c index c45ae86..7c27400 100644 --- a/ipc/mqueue.c +++ b/ipc/mqueue.c @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ * POSIX message queues filesystem for Linux. * * Copyright (C) 2003,2004 Krzysztof Benedyczak (golbi@mat.uni.torun.pl) - * Michal Wronski (Michal.Wronski@motorola.com) + * Michal Wronski (michal.wronski@gmail.com) * * Spinlocks: Mohamed Abbas (abbas.mohamed@intel.com) * Lockless receive & send, fd based notify: diff --git a/ipc/msgutil.c b/ipc/msgutil.c index 66cfb87..0992616 100644 --- a/ipc/msgutil.c +++ b/ipc/msgutil.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/ipc/util.c + * linux/ipc/msgutil.c * Copyright (C) 1999, 2004 Manfred Spraul * * This file is released under GNU General Public Licence version 2 or diff --git a/kernel/posix-timers.c b/kernel/posix-timers.c index e5ebcc1..9cbb5d1 100644 --- a/kernel/posix-timers.c +++ b/kernel/posix-timers.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/kernel/posix_timers.c + * linux/kernel/posix-timers.c * * * 2002-10-15 Posix Clocks & timers diff --git a/kernel/rcutorture.c b/kernel/rcutorture.c index 4f2c427..23446e9 100644 --- a/kernel/rcutorture.c +++ b/kernel/rcutorture.c @@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ MODULE_LICENSE("GPL"); -static int nreaders = -1; /* # reader threads, defaults to 4*ncpus */ +static int nreaders = -1; /* # reader threads, defaults to 2*ncpus */ static int stat_interval; /* Interval between stats, in seconds. */ /* Defaults to "only at end of test". */ static int verbose; /* Print more debug info. */ diff --git a/kernel/workqueue.c b/kernel/workqueue.c index 835fe28..cfc737b 100644 --- a/kernel/workqueue.c +++ b/kernel/workqueue.c @@ -34,7 +34,7 @@ * possible cpu). * * The sequence counters are for flush_scheduled_work(). It wants to wait - * until until all currently-scheduled works are completed, but it doesn't + * until all currently-scheduled works are completed, but it doesn't * want to be livelocked by new, incoming ones. So it waits until * remove_sequence is >= the insert_sequence which pertained when * flush_scheduled_work() was called. diff --git a/lib/reed_solomon/reed_solomon.c b/lib/reed_solomon/reed_solomon.c index 2cc11fa..a4b730a 100644 --- a/lib/reed_solomon/reed_solomon.c +++ b/lib/reed_solomon/reed_solomon.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * lib/reed_solomon/rslib.c + * lib/reed_solomon/reed_solomon.c * * Overview: * Generic Reed Solomon encoder / decoder library @@ -92,7 +92,7 @@ config HAVE_MEMORY_PRESENT # # SPARSEMEM_EXTREME (which is the default) does some bootmem -# allocations when memory_present() is called. If this can not +# allocations when memory_present() is called. If this cannot # be done on your architecture, select this option. However, # statically allocating the mem_section[] array can potentially # consume vast quantities of .bss, so be careful. @@ -104,7 +104,7 @@ config SPARSEMEM_STATIC def_bool n # -# Architectecture platforms which require a two level mem_section in SPARSEMEM +# Architecture platforms which require a two level mem_section in SPARSEMEM # must select this option. This is usually for architecture platforms with # an extremely sparse physical address space. # @@ -221,7 +221,7 @@ long vwrite(char *buf, char *addr, unsigned long count) * Allocate enough pages to cover @size from the page level * allocator and map them into continguos kernel virtual space. * - * For tight cotrol over page level allocator and protection flags + * For tight control over page level allocator and protection flags * use __vmalloc() instead. */ void *vmalloc(unsigned long size) diff --git a/mm/page-writeback.c b/mm/page-writeback.c index c0d4ce1..a0f3390 100644 --- a/mm/page-writeback.c +++ b/mm/page-writeback.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * mm/page-writeback.c. + * mm/page-writeback.c * * Copyright (C) 2002, Linus Torvalds. * diff --git a/mm/vmalloc.c b/mm/vmalloc.c index 1ac191c..750ab6e 100644 --- a/mm/vmalloc.c +++ b/mm/vmalloc.c @@ -503,7 +503,7 @@ EXPORT_SYMBOL(__vmalloc); * Allocate enough pages to cover @size from the page level * allocator and map them into contiguous kernel virtual space. * - * For tight cotrol over page level allocator and protection flags + * For tight control over page level allocator and protection flags * use __vmalloc() instead. */ void *vmalloc(unsigned long size) @@ -542,7 +542,7 @@ EXPORT_SYMBOL(vmalloc_user); * Allocate enough pages to cover @size from the page level * allocator and map them into contiguous kernel virtual space. * - * For tight cotrol over page level allocator and protection flags + * For tight control over page level allocator and protection flags * use __vmalloc() instead. */ void *vmalloc_node(unsigned long size, int node) @@ -563,7 +563,7 @@ EXPORT_SYMBOL(vmalloc_node); * the page level allocator and map them into contiguous and * executable kernel virtual space. * - * For tight cotrol over page level allocator and protection flags + * For tight control over page level allocator and protection flags * use __vmalloc() instead. */ diff --git a/net/ipv4/Kconfig b/net/ipv4/Kconfig index 30af4a4..d172a98 100644 --- a/net/ipv4/Kconfig +++ b/net/ipv4/Kconfig @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ config ASK_IP_FIB_HASH config IP_FIB_TRIE bool "FIB_TRIE" ---help--- - Use new experimental LC-trie as FIB lookup algoritm. + Use new experimental LC-trie as FIB lookup algorithm. This improves lookup performance if you have a large number of routes. @@ -526,7 +526,7 @@ config TCP_CONG_HYBLA ---help--- TCP-Hybla is a sender-side only change that eliminates penalization of long-RTT, large-bandwidth connections, like when satellite legs are - involved, expecially when sharing a common bottleneck with normal + involved, especially when sharing a common bottleneck with normal terrestrial connections. config TCP_CONG_VEGAS @@ -556,7 +556,7 @@ config TCP_CONG_LP default n ---help--- TCP Low Priority (TCP-LP), a distributed algorithm whose goal is - to utiliza only the excess network bandwidth as compared to the + to utilize only the excess network bandwidth as compared to the ``fair share`` of bandwidth as targeted by TCP. See http://www-ece.rice.edu/networks/TCP-LP/ diff --git a/net/ipv4/arp.c b/net/ipv4/arp.c index cfe5c84..cfb5d3d 100644 --- a/net/ipv4/arp.c +++ b/net/ipv4/arp.c @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/* linux/net/inet/arp.c +/* linux/net/ipv4/arp.c * * Version: $Id: arp.c,v 1.99 2001/08/30 22:55:42 davem Exp $ * diff --git a/net/ipv4/ipvs/Kconfig b/net/ipv4/ipvs/Kconfig index c9820bf..891b935 100644 --- a/net/ipv4/ipvs/Kconfig +++ b/net/ipv4/ipvs/Kconfig @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ config IP_VS_PROTO_ESP bool "ESP load balancing support" depends on IP_VS ---help--- - This option enables support for load balancing ESP (Encapsultion + This option enables support for load balancing ESP (Encapsulation Security Payload) transport protocol. Say Y if unsure. config IP_VS_PROTO_AH @@ -204,7 +204,7 @@ config IP_VS_SED connections to the server with the shortest expected delay. The expected delay that the job will experience is (Ci + 1) / Ui if sent to the ith server, in which Ci is the number of connections - on the the ith server and Ui is the fixed service rate (weight) + on the ith server and Ui is the fixed service rate (weight) of the ith server. If you want to compile it in kernel, say Y. To compile it as a diff --git a/net/ipv4/netfilter/Kconfig b/net/ipv4/netfilter/Kconfig index a55b8ff..d88c292 100644 --- a/net/ipv4/netfilter/Kconfig +++ b/net/ipv4/netfilter/Kconfig @@ -373,7 +373,7 @@ config IP_NF_TARGET_ULOG daemon using netlink multicast sockets; unlike the LOG target which can only be viewed through syslog. - The apropriate userspace logging daemon (ulogd) may be obtained from + The appropriate userspace logging daemon (ulogd) may be obtained from <http://www.gnumonks.org/projects/ulogd/> To compile it as a module, choose M here. If unsure, say N. diff --git a/net/sunrpc/auth_gss/auth_gss.c b/net/sunrpc/auth_gss/auth_gss.c index a6ed2d2..b36b946 100644 --- a/net/sunrpc/auth_gss/auth_gss.c +++ b/net/sunrpc/auth_gss/auth_gss.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/net/sunrpc/auth_gss.c + * linux/net/sunrpc/auth_gss/auth_gss.c * * RPCSEC_GSS client authentication. * diff --git a/scripts/kernel-doc b/scripts/kernel-doc index c9ca0c2..00d1ad1 100755 --- a/scripts/kernel-doc +++ b/scripts/kernel-doc @@ -57,8 +57,8 @@ use strict; # other functions are ignored. # # -nofunction funcname -# If set, then only generate documentation for the other function(s). All -# other functions are ignored. Cannot be used with -function together +# If set, then only generate documentation for the other function(s). +# Cannot be used together with -function # (yes, that's a bug -- perl hackers can fix it 8)) # # c files - list of 'c' files to process diff --git a/security/selinux/Kconfig b/security/selinux/Kconfig index 293dbd6..23b5104 100644 --- a/security/selinux/Kconfig +++ b/security/selinux/Kconfig @@ -112,7 +112,7 @@ config SECURITY_SELINUX_ENABLE_SECMARK_DEFAULT your distribution will provide these and enable the new controls in the kernel they also distribute. - Note that this option can be overriden at boot with the + Note that this option can be overridden at boot with the selinux_compat_net parameter, and after boot via /selinux/compat_net. See Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt for details on this parameter. @@ -122,7 +122,7 @@ config SECURITY_SELINUX_ENABLE_SECMARK_DEFAULT well as any conntrack helpers for protocols which you wish to control. - If you are unsure what do do here, select N. + If you are unsure what to do here, select N. config SECURITY_SELINUX_POLICYDB_VERSION_MAX bool "NSA SELinux maximum supported policy format version" diff --git a/sound/oss/Kconfig b/sound/oss/Kconfig index f3b3530..cc2b9ab 100644 --- a/sound/oss/Kconfig +++ b/sound/oss/Kconfig @@ -643,7 +643,7 @@ config SOUND_PSS command line. config PSS_MIXER - bool "Enable PSS mixer (Beethoven ADSP-16 and other compatibile)" + bool "Enable PSS mixer (Beethoven ADSP-16 and other compatible)" depends on SOUND_PSS help Answer Y for Beethoven ADSP-16. You may try to say Y also for other diff --git a/sound/oss/ad1848.c b/sound/oss/ad1848.c index 3b45e11..f6b6b88 100644 --- a/sound/oss/ad1848.c +++ b/sound/oss/ad1848.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/ad1848.c + * sound/oss/ad1848.c * * The low level driver for the AD1848/CS4248 codec chip which * is used for example in the MS Sound System. diff --git a/sound/oss/ad1848_mixer.h b/sound/oss/ad1848_mixer.h index f9231c6..2cf719b 100644 --- a/sound/oss/ad1848_mixer.h +++ b/sound/oss/ad1848_mixer.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/ad1848_mixer.h + * sound/oss/ad1848_mixer.h * * Definitions for the mixer of AD1848 and compatible codecs. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/adlib_card.c b/sound/oss/adlib_card.c index 6414ceb..c9a7c9b 100644 --- a/sound/oss/adlib_card.c +++ b/sound/oss/adlib_card.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/adlib_card.c + * sound/oss/adlib_card.c * * Detection routine for the AdLib card. * diff --git a/sound/oss/audio.c b/sound/oss/audio.c index 22dd63c..89bd27a 100644 --- a/sound/oss/audio.c +++ b/sound/oss/audio.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/audio.c + * sound/oss/audio.c * * Device file manager for /dev/audio */ diff --git a/sound/oss/awe_hw.h b/sound/oss/awe_hw.h index 7e403ad..ab00c3c 100644 --- a/sound/oss/awe_hw.h +++ b/sound/oss/awe_hw.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/awe_hw.h + * sound/oss/awe_hw.h * * Access routines and definitions for the low level driver for the * Creative AWE32/SB32/AWE64 wave table synth. diff --git a/sound/oss/awe_wave.c b/sound/oss/awe_wave.c index d1a0eb2..01c592c 100644 --- a/sound/oss/awe_wave.c +++ b/sound/oss/awe_wave.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/awe_wave.c + * sound/oss/awe_wave.c * * The low level driver for the AWE32/SB32/AWE64 wave table synth. * version 0.4.4; Jan. 4, 2000 diff --git a/sound/oss/awe_wave.h b/sound/oss/awe_wave.h index a3aa018..fe58481 100644 --- a/sound/oss/awe_wave.h +++ b/sound/oss/awe_wave.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/awe_config.h + * sound/oss/awe_wave.h * * Configuration of AWE32/SB32/AWE64 wave table synth driver. * version 0.4.4; Jan. 4, 2000 diff --git a/sound/oss/dev_table.c b/sound/oss/dev_table.c index f65a904..fb64279 100644 --- a/sound/oss/dev_table.c +++ b/sound/oss/dev_table.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/dev_table.c + * sound/oss/dev_table.c * * Device call tables. * diff --git a/sound/oss/dmabuf.c b/sound/oss/dmabuf.c index 15ce711..6c1cf74 100644 --- a/sound/oss/dmabuf.c +++ b/sound/oss/dmabuf.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/dmabuf.c + * sound/oss/dmabuf.c * * The DMA buffer manager for digitized voice applications */ diff --git a/sound/oss/gus_card.c b/sound/oss/gus_card.c index dbb2977..a3d6ae3 100644 --- a/sound/oss/gus_card.c +++ b/sound/oss/gus_card.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/gus_card.c + * sound/oss/gus_card.c * * Detection routine for the Gravis Ultrasound. * diff --git a/sound/oss/gus_midi.c b/sound/oss/gus_midi.c index b48f57c..d1997a4 100644 --- a/sound/oss/gus_midi.c +++ b/sound/oss/gus_midi.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/gus2_midi.c + * sound/oss/gus_midi.c * * The low level driver for the GUS Midi Interface. * diff --git a/sound/oss/gus_wave.c b/sound/oss/gus_wave.c index 942d518..597db7a 100644 --- a/sound/oss/gus_wave.c +++ b/sound/oss/gus_wave.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/gus_wave.c + * sound/oss/gus_wave.c * * Driver for the Gravis UltraSound wave table synth. * diff --git a/sound/oss/harmony.c b/sound/oss/harmony.c index 591683c..6601b28 100644 --- a/sound/oss/harmony.c +++ b/sound/oss/harmony.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - drivers/sound/harmony.c + sound/oss/harmony.c This is a sound driver for ASP's and Lasi's Harmony sound chip and is unlikely to be used for anything other than on a HP PA-RISC. diff --git a/sound/oss/ics2101.c b/sound/oss/ics2101.c index d5f3be8..45918df 100644 --- a/sound/oss/ics2101.c +++ b/sound/oss/ics2101.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/ics2101.c + * sound/oss/ics2101.c * * Driver for the ICS2101 mixer of GUS v3.7. * diff --git a/sound/oss/iwmem.h b/sound/oss/iwmem.h index 84745fbc..48d333c 100644 --- a/sound/oss/iwmem.h +++ b/sound/oss/iwmem.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/iwmem.h + * sound/oss/iwmem.h * * DRAM size encoding table for AMD Interwave chip. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/maui.c b/sound/oss/maui.c index 05cf194..317f225 100644 --- a/sound/oss/maui.c +++ b/sound/oss/maui.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/maui.c + * sound/oss/maui.c * * The low level driver for Turtle Beach Maui and Tropez. * diff --git a/sound/oss/midi_synth.c b/sound/oss/midi_synth.c index 972edc6..d2ab5c0 100644 --- a/sound/oss/midi_synth.c +++ b/sound/oss/midi_synth.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/midi_synth.c + * sound/oss/midi_synth.c * * High level midi sequencer manager for dumb MIDI interfaces. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/midibuf.c b/sound/oss/midibuf.c index 6982556..c0e4bbc 100644 --- a/sound/oss/midibuf.c +++ b/sound/oss/midibuf.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/midibuf.c + * sound/oss/midibuf.c * * Device file manager for /dev/midi# */ diff --git a/sound/oss/mpu401.c b/sound/oss/mpu401.c index 0aac54c..321f4c4 100644 --- a/sound/oss/mpu401.c +++ b/sound/oss/mpu401.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/mpu401.c + * sound/oss/mpu401.c * * The low level driver for Roland MPU-401 compatible Midi cards. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/opl3.c b/sound/oss/opl3.c index a31734b..4799bc7 100644 --- a/sound/oss/opl3.c +++ b/sound/oss/opl3.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/opl3.c + * sound/oss/opl3.c * * A low level driver for Yamaha YM3812 and OPL-3 -chips * diff --git a/sound/oss/opl3sa.c b/sound/oss/opl3sa.c index fe4907c..2535ed0 100644 --- a/sound/oss/opl3sa.c +++ b/sound/oss/opl3sa.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/opl3sa.c + * sound/oss/opl3sa.c * * Low level driver for Yamaha YMF701B aka OPL3-SA chip * diff --git a/sound/oss/opl3sa2.c b/sound/oss/opl3sa2.c index aec05a2..e20051f 100644 --- a/sound/oss/opl3sa2.c +++ b/sound/oss/opl3sa2.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/opl3sa2.c + * sound/oss/opl3sa2.c * * A low level driver for Yamaha OPL3-SA2 and SA3 cards. * NOTE: All traces of the name OPL3-SAx have now (December 2000) been diff --git a/sound/oss/pas2_card.c b/sound/oss/pas2_card.c index 9766600..4ebb963 100644 --- a/sound/oss/pas2_card.c +++ b/sound/oss/pas2_card.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/pas2_card.c + * sound/oss/pas2_card.c * * Detection routine for the Pro Audio Spectrum cards. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/pas2_midi.c b/sound/oss/pas2_midi.c index 79d6a58..1122d10 100644 --- a/sound/oss/pas2_midi.c +++ b/sound/oss/pas2_midi.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/pas2_midi.c + * sound/oss/pas2_midi.c * * The low level driver for the PAS Midi Interface. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/pas2_mixer.c b/sound/oss/pas2_mixer.c index 4aade53..a0bcb85 100644 --- a/sound/oss/pas2_mixer.c +++ b/sound/oss/pas2_mixer.c @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ /* - * sound/pas2_mixer.c + * sound/oss/pas2_mixer.c * * Mixer routines for the Pro Audio Spectrum cards. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/pss.c b/sound/oss/pss.c index 37ee234..ece428b 100644 --- a/sound/oss/pss.c +++ b/sound/oss/pss.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/pss.c + * sound/oss/pss.c * * The low level driver for the Personal Sound System (ECHO ESC614). * diff --git a/sound/oss/sb_audio.c b/sound/oss/sb_audio.c index 75e54f6..733b014 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sb_audio.c +++ b/sound/oss/sb_audio.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sb_audio.c + * sound/oss/sb_audio.c * * Audio routines for Sound Blaster compatible cards. * diff --git a/sound/oss/sb_common.c b/sound/oss/sb_common.c index 35bab6e..bbe5b75 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sb_common.c +++ b/sound/oss/sb_common.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sb_common.c + * sound/oss/sb_common.c * * Common routines for Sound Blaster compatible cards. * diff --git a/sound/oss/sb_midi.c b/sound/oss/sb_midi.c index ed3bd06..2e3bc04 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sb_midi.c +++ b/sound/oss/sb_midi.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sb_dsp.c + * sound/oss/sb_midi.c * * The low level driver for the Sound Blaster DS chips. * diff --git a/sound/oss/sb_mixer.c b/sound/oss/sb_mixer.c index ccb21d4..238e2cf 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sb_mixer.c +++ b/sound/oss/sb_mixer.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sb_mixer.c + * sound/oss/sb_mixer.c * * The low level mixer driver for the Sound Blaster compatible cards. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/sb_mixer.h b/sound/oss/sb_mixer.h index ab74426..4b9425f 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sb_mixer.h +++ b/sound/oss/sb_mixer.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sb_mixer.h + * sound/oss/sb_mixer.h * * Definitions for the SB Pro and SB16 mixers */ diff --git a/sound/oss/sequencer.c b/sound/oss/sequencer.c index 6815c30..0ce4e4e 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sequencer.c +++ b/sound/oss/sequencer.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sequencer.c + * sound/oss/sequencer.c * * The sequencer personality manager. */ diff --git a/sound/oss/sgalaxy.c b/sound/oss/sgalaxy.c index 3f32d46..0bcff67 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sgalaxy.c +++ b/sound/oss/sgalaxy.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sgalaxy.c + * sound/oss/sgalaxy.c * * Low level driver for Aztech Sound Galaxy cards. * Copyright 1998 Artur Skawina <skawina@geocities.com> diff --git a/sound/oss/sound_timer.c b/sound/oss/sound_timer.c index bc2777d..146bf85 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sound_timer.c +++ b/sound/oss/sound_timer.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sound_timer.c + * sound/oss/sound_timer.c */ /* * Copyright (C) by Hannu Savolainen 1993-1997 diff --git a/sound/oss/soundcard.c b/sound/oss/soundcard.c index 0860d67..683dc00 100644 --- a/sound/oss/soundcard.c +++ b/sound/oss/soundcard.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/sound/soundcard.c + * linux/sound/oss/soundcard.c * * Sound card driver for Linux * diff --git a/sound/oss/sscape.c b/sound/oss/sscape.c index 9ed5211..51f2fa6 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sscape.c +++ b/sound/oss/sscape.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sscape.c + * sound/oss/sscape.c * * Low level driver for Ensoniq SoundScape * diff --git a/sound/oss/sys_timer.c b/sound/oss/sys_timer.c index c9d0451..1075344 100644 --- a/sound/oss/sys_timer.c +++ b/sound/oss/sys_timer.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/sys_timer.c + * sound/oss/sys_timer.c * * The default timer for the Level 2 sequencer interface * Uses the (1/HZ sec) timer of kernel. diff --git a/sound/oss/trix.c b/sound/oss/trix.c index d1f1f15..e04169e 100644 --- a/sound/oss/trix.c +++ b/sound/oss/trix.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/trix.c + * sound/oss/trix.c * * Low level driver for the MediaTrix AudioTrix Pro * (MT-0002-PC Control Chip) diff --git a/sound/oss/uart401.c b/sound/oss/uart401.c index a3d75ba..8e18b6e 100644 --- a/sound/oss/uart401.c +++ b/sound/oss/uart401.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/uart401.c + * sound/oss/uart401.c * * MPU-401 UART driver (formerly uart401_midi.c) * diff --git a/sound/oss/uart6850.c b/sound/oss/uart6850.c index 74ae75f..501d3e6 100644 --- a/sound/oss/uart6850.c +++ b/sound/oss/uart6850.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/uart6850.c + * sound/oss/uart6850.c * * * Copyright (C) by Hannu Savolainen 1993-1997 diff --git a/sound/oss/v_midi.c b/sound/oss/v_midi.c index a7ef04f..d952b22 100644 --- a/sound/oss/v_midi.c +++ b/sound/oss/v_midi.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/v_midi.c + * sound/oss/v_midi.c * * The low level driver for the Sound Blaster DS chips. * diff --git a/sound/oss/waveartist.c b/sound/oss/waveartist.c index 22d2662..59a2f28 100644 --- a/sound/oss/waveartist.c +++ b/sound/oss/waveartist.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/sound/waveartist.c + * linux/sound/oss/waveartist.c * * The low level driver for the RWA010 Rockwell Wave Artist * codec chip used in the Rebel.com NetWinder. diff --git a/sound/oss/waveartist.h b/sound/oss/waveartist.h index 2033fb8..dac4ca9 100644 --- a/sound/oss/waveartist.h +++ b/sound/oss/waveartist.h @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * linux/drivers/sound/waveartist.h + * linux/sound/oss/waveartist.h * * def file for Rockwell RWA010 chip set, as installed in Rebel.com NetWinder */ diff --git a/sound/oss/wf_midi.c b/sound/oss/wf_midi.c index 3f3a390..75c0c14 100644 --- a/sound/oss/wf_midi.c +++ b/sound/oss/wf_midi.c @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ /* - * sound/wf_midi.c + * sound/oss/wf_midi.c * * The low level driver for the WaveFront ICS2115 MIDI interface(s) * Note that there is also an MPU-401 emulation (actually, a UART-401 |